Quarterlytics / Real Estate / Real Estate - Development / Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI

Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI

lre · LSE Real Estate
Claim this profile
Ticker lre
Exchange LSE
Sector Real Estate
Industry Real Estate - Development
Employees 201-500
← All annual reports
FY2017 Annual Report · Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
L

a

n

c

a

s

h

i

r

e

H

o

l

d

i

n

g

s

L

i

m

i

t

e

d

A

n

n

u

a

l

R

e

p

o

r

t

&

A

c

c

o

u

n

t

s

2

0

1

7

Responsive in  
every environment

Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Strategic report

Governance

Overview
2  Our investment 
proposition

8  Chairman’s statement
10  Business model

Strategy
12   Chief Executive’s review
14   Strategy

Performance
16   Financial review
18   Key performance  

indicators

20   Underwriting review
24   Business review
31   Enterprise risk 

management
34   Principal risks
36   Corporate responsibility

42   Chairman’s introduction
44   Board of Directors
46  Our Board’s year
47   Corporate governance 

report

50   Committee reports
60   Directors’ remuneration 

report

80   Directors’ report
84   Statement of Directors’ 

responsibilities

Consolidated 
Financial Statements
85  Independent auditors’ 

report

90  Consolidated primary 
financial statements
94  Accounting policies
100  Risk disclosures
126  Notes to the accounts

Additional information
152  Shareholder information
153  Glossary
157  Contact information

Return on  
equity 

Combined  
ratio 

(Loss) Profit  
after tax 

-5.9%

(2016: 13.5%)

124.9%

(2016: 76.5%)

$-71.1m

(2016: $153.8m)

Total  
investment 
return

2.5%

(2016: 2.1%)

Dividend  
yield 

1.6%

(2016: 10.5%)

Total  
shareholder 
return

9.4%

(2016: 2.4%)

2017

2017

-5.9

2017

124.9

2017

-71.1

2017

2017
2.5

1.6

2016

2016

13.5

2016

76.5

2016

153.8

2016

2.1

2016

10.5

2015

2015

13.5*

2015

72.1

2014

2014

14.7*

2014

68.7

2013

2013

18.9*

2013

70.2

2015

2014

2013

181.1

2015

0.7

229.3

2014

1.0

222.5

2013

0.3

2015

2014

2013

*  RoE including the impact of warrants was 10.9% in 2015, 13.9% in 2014 and 18.9% in 2013.

2017

2016

9.4

2.4

17.3

2015

25.9

17.8

2014

-24.2

12.3

2013

21.3

Lancashire is a provider of 
global specialty insurance and 
reinsurance products operating 
in Bermuda and London across 
three platforms: rated company, 
Lloyd’s and collateralised security.

The Group focuses on  
short-tail, mostly specialty  
(re)insurance risks under five 
general segments: Property, 
Energy, Marine, Aviation  
and Lloyd’s.

Please refer to our glossary  
on pages 153 to 156 for  
key definitions.

The consistency and 
adaptability of our core 
principles enable us to  
deliver strong returns  
across the market cycle.

Whatever conditions  
the market brings, we are 
disciplined in the risks that  
we underwrite and manage, 
staying nimble to seize 
opportunities wherever  
they present themselves.

NASA Earth Observatory images by Joshua Stevens and Jesse Allen, using VIIRS day-night band data from the Suomi National Polar-orbiting 
Partnership and Terra MODIS data from the Land Atmosphere Near real-time Capability for EOS (LANCE)

www.lancashiregroup.com

1

2017 has proven to be a challenging  
year but no matter what environment  
we find ourselves in, underwriting comes 
first. This focus on our core principle has 
allowed us to deliver sector-leading 
returns across the cycle.

We are  
guided by  
our core 
strategic 
principles

2

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Our investment proposition: Underwriting comes first

Delivering superior returns across the cycle 
and moderating downside risk

Ten-year Return on Equity1

)

%

(
y
t
i
u
q
E
n
o
n
r
u
t
e
R

30

25

20

15

10

5

0

-5

-10

2008

2009

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

Description
Our strategy is designed to  
cope with hard and soft markets, 
managing capital and exposures  
to maximise risk-adjusted returns 
across the cycle whilst moderating 
our exposures according to  
market conditions.

Our strategic cross-cycle aim is to  
be profitable four years out of five, 
acknowledging there will be years 
when we incur losses. 2017 is the 
first full year we have incurred a  
loss since inception.

(1) RoE excluding the impact of warrants.

Experienced underwriters produce higher 
returns across the cycle

Ten-year combined ratio

)

%

(
o
i
t
a
r
d
e
n
b
m
o
C

i

140

120

100

80

60

40

20

0

2008

2009

2010

2011

Lancashire

Lancashire – 10-year average1

2012

2013
Sector2 average

2014
Sector average – 10-year average1

2016

2015

Description
Group management and our 
underwriters have decades of 
experience in rated companies, 
Lloyd’s and collateralised security 
markets. Across the cycle our 
combined ratio outperformed  
the sector average.

(1) Ten-year average based on 2008 to  
2017 reporting periods. Lancashire 
ratios weighted by annual net  
premiums earned. Annual sector  
ratios are weighted by annual  
net premiums earned.

(2) Sector includes Arch, Argo, Aspen,  

Axis, Beazley, Everest, Hanover, Hiscox, 
RenaissanceRe, Validus and XL Catlin. 
The 2017 result for Hiscox is not 
available at the time of the report.

Source: Company reports.

2017

www.lancashiregroup.com

3

 
 
 
 
 
This year has shown why it is critical to 
balance risk and return and to understand 
the implications of over exposure in  
the market. The comprehensive risk 
management procedures our teams 
undertake every day allow us to strike  
the right balance of risk and return.  
In particular, we expect volatility in the 
occurrence of the catastrophe events  
to which our products respond.

We  
navigate  
risk 
confidently

4

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Our investment proposition: Effectively balance risk and return

Managing our exposures across segments and geographies

Gross premiums written by class and region

Property 
Energy 
Marine 
Aviation 
Lloyd’s 

33.5%
17.2%
11.4%
2.9%
35.0%

        30.0%
U.S. and Canada 
Worldwide offshore 
27.5%
Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada  16.7%
6.6%
Europe 
Far East 
4.7%
Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada  1.9%
Middle East 
1.2%
11.4%
Rest of the world 

Protecting our assets

Investment asset allocation

Duration
1.7 years

Cash                   
Short-term investments                   
Fixed maturity funds  
Government debt  
Agency debt  
Agency MBS, CMBS  
Non-agency RMBS, ABS, CMBS  
Corporate bonds  
Bank loans  
Fixed maturity – at FVTPL  
Equity securities  
Hedge funds – at FVTPL  

 10.2%
 6.0%
1.7%
17.0%
3.8%
7.7%
8.5%
28.2%
5.8%
1.4%
1.3%
8.4%

Total portfolio at 31 December 2017 $1,842.7m 
Credit quality AA-.

Description
A well-diversified portfolio across 
multiple lines and geographies 
operates as a base to trade across 
the cycle.

During 2017, Lancashire  
has balanced the needs of its 
shareholders, wider stakeholders 
and importantly met the needs 
of its clients following the impact 
of the multiple catastrophe events.

Description
We hedge our interest rate  
risk with risk assets and aim  
to minimise the downside  
on our investment portfolio.

www.lancashiregroup.com

5

In volatile and harsh conditions, we 
operate nimbly to achieve the maximum 
return for our shareholders across the 
market cycle. As new opportunities 
emerge in the future, our focused yet 
diversified books will give us the ability to 
capitalise on opportunities and deliver our 
cross-cycle strategic goal of maximising 
risk-adjusted returns across the cycle.

We are  
able to  
react quickly 
to seize 
opportunities

6

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Our investment proposition: Operating nimbly through the cycle

Managing our capital proactively in volatile markets

Proven record of active capital management

500

400

)

m
$
(

300

200

100

0

2008

2009

Share repurchases

2010

2011
Special dividend

2012

2013
Ordinary dividends

2014

Description
Despite the difficult market  
and a significant number of 
catastrophe events in the year, 
Lancashire’s capital base  
remains strong and positions  
us to remain relevant in the 
current market environment.

300

250

200

150

)

%

(

100

50

2015
Percentage of IPO capital returned

2016

2017

0

Managing the cycle by reducing net exposures

Net PMLs by key catastrophe perils

500

400

300

200

100

0

)

m
$
(

L
M
P
t
e
n
p
u
o
r
G

300

250

200

150

100

50

0

Pan-European 
windstorm 
(1/100)

Japan 
earthquake 
(1/250)

California 
earthquake 
(1/250)

Gulf of Mexico 
hurricane 
(1/100)

Non-Gulf of 
Mexico hurricane 
(1/100)

01/01/14

01/01/15

01/01/16

01/01/17

01/01/18

Description
We continued to modify our 
exposure to key catastrophe 
perils as the market became 
more competitive, demonstrating 
our discipline and nimbleness 
across the market cycle.

www.lancashiregroup.com

7

 
 
 
Chairman’s statement
Chairman’s statement

Responding to challenge 

For Lancashire the recent catastrophe events have 
afforded a real world ‘stress test’ to our strategy  
and business model, and one which has validated  
our strategic decision to moderate our risk exposures 
during the softer part of the insurance cycle.

How did Lancashire respond to the 
sequence of natural catastrophes  
during 2017?
One of the central challenges for any board 
or management team is to understand the 
principal factors which can stress a business. 
What are they, where do the risks and 
opportunities lie and how best to respond?

In recent years, Lancashire had faced  
the challenge of a relatively benign loss 
environment (subject to exceptions in 
certain lines of business) resulting in the 
accumulation of capital across the global  
(re)insurance sector and a gradual decline  
in premium rates. In general terms, the  
(re)insurance sector has tended to be paid 
less for the risks underwritten. Put simply, 
the business has been operating in the softer 
part of the (re)insurance cycle. Lancashire’s 
strategic response has been to focus on 
maintaining market-leading underwriting 
and to carefully manage risk exposures, 
through the disciplined underwriting of 
inwards insurance and reinsurance risks and 
through careful planning and purchasing  
of outwards reinsurance protections.

Insurance (and reinsurance), as a product,  
is designed to help insured businesses plan 
for and respond to damage and disruption 
arising from fortuitous and unpredictable 
events, in particular natural catastrophes. 
Events such as hurricanes and earthquakes 
are the result of natural processes which  
are certain to occur as part of the cycles  
of nature. However, in the short term, their 
location, frequency and severity cannot  
be accurately predicted, although human 
ingenuity has produced probability models 

which have enhanced our understanding of 
the risks and, combined with the benefits of 
practical underwriting experience, helped 
inform our commercial assumptions.

Please see my introduction to the 
Governance Report on page 42 for an 
account of the work of the Board and our 
governance arrangements for the year.

Will strategy change in 2018?
I do not expect Lancashire’s strategic 
priorities to change in 2018. We will continue 
to focus on underwriting expertise and 
discipline, to effectively balance the equation 
of risk and return, and to operate nimbly 
through the cycle. What we do cautiously 
hope to see in this post-loss environment  
is an improvement in general pricing 
conditions, which may lead to greater 
opportunity in the underwriting space  
and a rebalancing of the risk and return 
equation. Alex discusses these dynamics  
in greater detail in his review on page 12. 
From a Board perspective our job is to 
ensure that we afford the business the capital 
and human resources necessary to develop 
any opportunities whilst ensuring that we 
establish and operate within appropriate  
risk tolerances. Predicting the future is never 
straightforward, but on the assumption that 
pricing improves and that the catastrophe 
loss environment is less extreme in 2018 than 
it proved to be in 2017, the Board would 
hope to see returns improving and more 
aligned with our cross-cycle expectations.

In the second half of 2017, we witnessed  
the occurrence of three major hurricanes: 
Harvey, Irma and Maria, two earthquakes  
in Mexico as well as wildfires in California. 
These catastrophes impacted upon areas  
of higher asset values and insurance market 
penetration, in particular in the U.S. and  
the Caribbean. For Lancashire, these recent 
catastrophe events have afforded a real world 
‘stress test’ to our strategy and business 
model, and one which has validated our 
strategic decision to moderate our risk 
exposures during the softer part of the 
insurance cycle.

The Board was pleased at the way in  
which Lancashire proved itself capable  
of balancing the expectations of all its 
significant stakeholders in the face of  
the recent loss events. Most importantly, 
Lancashire has addressed the insurance 
needs of its clients within a transparent and 
robust risk framework. We have operated a 
business which has met the expectations of 
the Group’s regulators whilst ensuring that, 
in a year which has seen a higher than usual 
sequence of natural catastrophe events, the 
Group’s investors and capital providers have 
not been subject to outsize or unexpected 
losses. All this has been made possible 
through the contributions of our skilled 
employees. On behalf of the Board I would 
like to thank Alex, his management team 
and all our employees for a job well done.

8

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

“Predicting the future is 
never straightforward, 
but on the assumption 
that pricing improves 
and that the catastrophe 
loss environment is less 
extreme in 2018 …, the 
Board would hope to see 
returns improving and 
more aligned with  
our cross-cycle 
expectations.”

Dividend  
Yield 

1.6%

Total investment 
return 

2.5%

As a business we carefully consider the 
balance of risk and return when setting our 
capital levels. In previous years this approach 
enabled us to return capital that we did not 
need to support our underwriting. As we 
enter 2018, we believe there is a realistic 
prospect that the balance of risk and return 
will change in the current market. In the 
current fluid environment, the Board has 
decided to retain more of the Group’s capital 
to best support our underwriting strategy  
and to position the business to take a lead  
in establishing improved pricing and  
terms of coverage following a period  
of market dislocation.

An important element to Lancashire’s  
active capital management strategy is the 
flexibility afforded to us by shareholders 
during the last six years to issue up to  
15 per cent of Lancashire’s shares on a non 
pre-emptive basis. The best opportunities  
in the insurance and reinsurance sectors 
typically arise following major loss events, 
and the flexibility to issue shares and raise 
capital quickly is a central pillar of our 
business strategy and will help Lancashire 
maximise underwriting opportunities for  
the business. Once again, the Company is 
seeking shareholder support for resolutions 
at the 2018 AGM allowing this capital 
management flexibility, and I would 
encourage all shareholders to vote in favour.

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chairman

www.lancashiregroup.com

9

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chairman

Has Lancashire’s dividend and capital 
management strategy changed?
The short answer is ‘no’, our dividend  
and capital management strategy has not 
changed. The dividend policy is set out on 
page 80 of this Annual Report and Accounts.

However, due to the exceptional loss 
environment during 2017 and our changing 
view of the (re)insurance markets, the Board 
decided not to pay an exceptional special 
dividend that our investors have enjoyed  
in recent years. Lancashire has however 
declared standard ordinary dividends for  
the 2017 year amounting in aggregate  
to $0.15 per common share.

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsBusiness model

Three platforms  
weathering all storms

We leverage our deep underwriting expertise with 
efficient management of capital and resources across our 
three platforms to provide our clients and brokers with 
excellent solutions for their insurance and reinsurance 
needs. We always focus on the risk-adjusted return.

c a s h i r e   Holdings Limited 

n

a

L

Responsibility

s
t
n
e
i
l
C

Lancashire

Underwriting  
and capital 
management

R

e

t

u

r

n

M

a

r

k
e
t
s

Cathedral

Kinesis

Risk

10

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Our responsibilityWe recognise that our responsibility as a company and as individuals reaches wider than our shareholders and our clients. We strive  to be a good employer,  a good corporate citizen  and a responsible preserver  of resources. Through the Lancashire Foundation, we make financial contributions and provide human support to a number of good causes in the places we operate around the world (for further details see  pages 36 to 41). 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
c a s h i r e   Holdings Limited 

n

a

L

s

t

n

e

i

l

C

M

a

r

k

e

t

s

Lancashire Companies

Cathedral

Kinesis

 • Strong brand with clients and brokers
 • Recognised for significant capacity  

and leadership ability in well-defined 
business sectors

 • Proven track record of supplying 
capacity across the cycle with 
consistently high performance
 • A lean business operation allows  
us to remain nimble and make 
decisions efficiently

 • A stable core book of business and 

disciplined underwriting

 • Strong record of capital management 
actions to optimise and adjust capital 
and navigate market cycles

 • Experienced management team with 

proven ability

 • Maintain key client, broker and 

reinsurer relationships to ensure  
the continued flow of business
 • Continue the use of reinsurance 
solutions to uphold risk-adjusted 
balance across the insurance  
market cycle

 • Retain ‘underwriting comes first’ 
culture and discipline without  
being tempted into innovation  
or diversification for its own sake

 • Provide profitable growth in  

areas experiencing an improved  
rating environment

 • Manages two active syndicates
 • Strong relationships with clients  

and brokers

 • Experienced, fully dedicated 

management with strong relationships 
with clients, brokers and investors

 • Recognised for long-term consistency  

 • Ability to leverage Group relationships 

of relationships

 • Efficient Lloyd’s capital model allowing 
Cathedral greater premium leverage
 • Worldwide licensing maintained by 
Lloyd’s allows Cathedral to write 
business worldwide with limited 
regulatory overheads

 • Use of world’s oldest insurance third 
party capital, the Names, who provide 
support and capacity to Syndicate 2010

 • Proven track record with more  
than four years as part of the  
Lancashire Group

and reputation with investors  
and clients

 • Highly specialised multi-class product 
with barriers to entry in terms of data 
and modeling expertise

 • Ability to raise and deploy capital quickly
 • Strong investor base since 2014
 • Proven track record with Kinesis now  

in its fifth year

 • Maintain core portfolios in  

 • Ensure product is correctly calibrated  

the syndicates

 • Continue to look for new  
opportunities for bolt-on  
business lines in both syndicates

 • Leverage the Group’s balance sheet  

and cross-sell where opportunities arise

to meet clients’ needs in terms of 
responding to events and providing 
capital relief

 • Deliver returns in line with expectations 
for modeled ranges given market losses 
and pricing

 • Continue to increase number  

of investors

 • Provide bespoke and flexible products 
to match investor and client appetite

 • Influx of new capacity and further 

 • Pressure on signings and participation 

development of broker facilities with 
less robust underwriting controls

 • Pressure on insurance rates across the 

market cycle

 • Widening terms and conditions being 
accepted by the insurance market 
without adequate pricing or exclusions

given relatively small line sizes
 • Expanded burden of regulatory 

oversight or overlapping regulation 
from Lloyd’s, the PRA and the FCA

 • Increased competition from  
traditional and collateralised  
markets, with attempts to replicate  
the Kinesis product

 • Possible waning of investor interest in 
insurance allocations as interest rates 
begin to increase and yields return to 
capital markets

 • Resistance to complex reinsurance 

products amongst clients, given cheap 
availability of traditional products

www.lancashiregroup.com

11

Key strengthsGoalsRisksOverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Chief Executive’s review

Responding to opportunity

“For the first time in 
several years I am 
cautiously optimistic 
that we will see a halt in 
the year-on-year decline 
in premium rates and  
a return to stronger 
underwriting discipline 
across the whole 
insurance and 
reinsurance sector.”

We are strongly positioned, with the right expertise and 
good relationships with our clients, their brokers and our 
capital providers, to take the lead in establishing better-
priced and more sustainable insurance and reinsurance 
markets and to remain a relevant and valued provider  
of insurance and reinsurance solutions.

Did Lancashire perform as you expected 
in 2017?
Our results for 2017 have generated a return 
on equity of negative 5.9 per cent and a 
combined ratio of 124.9 per cent, which may 
at first sight seem lacklustre compared with 
Lancashire’s performance in previous years. 
Whilst no CEO likes losing money, this is to 
be expected in what has been a significant 
year for catastrophe insurance losses across 
the market. On balance I am satisfied with 
this outcome during a year in which we had 
worked hard to moderate our risk exposures 
whilst remaining relevant to the needs of  
our policyholders and the expectations of 
our investors during the soft part of the  
market cycle.

The recent run of catastrophe losses, which 
regrettably caused much human suffering 
and property damage, has resulted in losses 
to the global insurance markets which are 
estimated to be in excess of $100 billion, 
placing the 2017 year within the top three 
years for aggregate industry insured losses  
in recent history and ultimately could end  
up being the costliest on record. Over the 
last few years, I have spoken regularly about 
the oversupply of capital and the resulting 
imbalance which this has generated, leading 
to downwards pricing and pressure on 
coverage terms within the international 
insurance and reinsurance markets. 
Lancashire’s response to those market 
conditions has been to demonstrate good 
inwards risk selection through underwriting 
discipline and to manage down its aggregate 
risk exposures through the judicious 
purchase of more and better-priced 
reinsurance coverage. We have bided our 
time for precisely the moment when there 

would be a marked increase in major 
catastrophe losses. That moment came  
in 2017. Faced with the 2017 loss events,  
our combined ratio is indicative of the 
success of our strategy to moderate our  
risk exposures in what has been a lower- 
yield underwriting environment.

As we enter 2018, we find ourselves  
well positioned, with the right people  
and expertise and a robust balance sheet.  
We have strong relationships with our  
clients, their brokers and our capital 
providers. Lancashire stands ready to take 
the lead in establishing better-priced and 
more sustainable insurance and reinsurance 
markets and to remain a relevant and  
valued provider of insurance and 
reinsurance solutions.

How do you view current  
market conditions?
After 25 years’ experience as an underwriter, 
I firmly believe that the (re)insurance business 
is cyclical in its fundamentals. Due to an 
overabundance of capital and a protracted 
period of lower loss activity over a number  
of years, the beginning of 2017 marked a low 
point in the cycle of pricing and terms and 
conditions. Recent experience suggests to me 
that the market cannot continue to operate 
at the very margins of profitability. The 2017 
catastrophe events should mark a point at 
which the balance of capital and underwriting 
opportunity will readjust, at least in the short 
to medium term. For the first time in several 
years I am cautiously optimistic that we will 
see a halt in the year-on-year decline in 
premium rates and a return to stronger 
underwriting discipline across the whole 
insurance and reinsurance sector.

12

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Return on equity

-5.9%

Combined ratio

124.9%

Loss after tax

$71.1m

Alex Maloney
Group Chief Executive Officer

In which classes of business do you 
expect to see the greatest change?
The early evidence suggests that pricing  
has started to improve, in particular in the 
U.S. property insurance and reinsurance 
lines, which have been directly affected  
by the recent losses. But I am also hopeful  
that a return to the fundamentals of good 
underwriting will extend to those other 
specialty lines which we underwrite. There  
is, at the very least, a likelihood that the 
decline in pricing will come to a halt and  
a reasonable prospect of improved and  
more sustainable pricing across many  
of our lines of business.

Paul Gregory, our Group CUO, sets out his 
view of the likely trends in our core lines of 
business on page 20 of this Annual Report 
and Accounts. I believe that a move to a 
market which is more realistically and 
sustainably priced is ultimately in the best 
interests not only of the (re)insurance  
sector itself but also of our clients, who  
value continuity and professionalism from 
their insurance and reinsurance partners. 
Price is not the sole determinant of value for  
our products.

How is Lancashire different from  
other businesses?
We remain a business with a relatively small 
headcount of around 200 and we continue to 
pride ourselves on having a lean and nimble 
‘can do’ business culture. During 2017,  
we implemented a reorganisation of our 
London office and, whilst that may seem  
a mundane step, it has helped us become 
even more joined-up between our businesses 
in London and Bermuda, our Cathedral 
Lloyd’s platform and Kinesis, our third party 
reinsurance facility. We are a business with  
a very flat hierarchy and efficient lines of 
communication. We have the operating 
structure to respond quickly to the insurance 
and reinsurance needs of our clients  
and their brokers and to offer a level of 
underwriting and claims service, security  
and professionalism which often exceeds  
that of many of our larger competitors. We 
pride ourselves on doing what makes sense  
as disciplined underwriters. Rather than 
targeting growth or faddish diversification  
we have focused on management of the  

(re)insurance cycle, if necessary refusing 
business and exposures which have been 
underpriced. This positions Lancashire  
well to develop the best opportunities,  
which should arise when we enter what  
I hope may become a more rewarding  
phase of the market cycle.

I would like to thank all our staff across  
the Group for having contributed to the 
successful negotiation of what has been  
a challenging phase of the (re)insurance 
market cycle. I know that the skill and 
dedication of our people is key to the success 
of Lancashire and I look forward to leading 
our excellent team as we develop the market 
opportunities and face the challenges which 
lie ahead in the coming year.

Alex Maloney
Group Chief Executive Officer

www.lancashiregroup.com

13

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsStrategy

Our strategy

Our strategy
The Group executes its strategy by 
concentrating on three strategic priorities 
that enable the Group to meet its goal  
of maximising risk-adjusted returns  
for shareholders: underwriting comes 
first; effectively balance risk and return;  
and operate nimbly through the cycle.  
These strategic priorities enable the Group 
to serve clients and brokers with significant 

capacity across the cycle, not just in the core 
business the Group aims to renew every year, 
but also in times or in areas where capacity is 
scarce: the opportunistic part of the Group’s 
portfolio. The Group maintains a lean 
structure and keeps overheads under strict 
control so that resources may be refocused 
quickly. The Group tests its assumptions  
and performance constantly through its 
structure, using its daily underwriting calls  

or exception reporting to management,  
its fortnightly RRC meeting with all 
disciplines within the Group represented, 
and a series of supporting committees at 
management and board levels. The Group’s 
risk function and internal audit supply 
challenge and provide assurance to 
management and the boards through a 
simple and continuous reporting process.

Underwriting  
comes first

Operate nimbly 
through the cycle

Effectively balance 
risk and return

Cross-cycle  
return of risk-free plus 13%

Profitable 4 years out of 5

Peak-zone  
PML limits  of 25% of capital

SHAREHOLDER 
RETURN

Our culture – The bedrock of our strategy
Lancashire encourages a culture of co-operation and respect based on open challenge.  
This can be seen clearly in the LICL and LUK daily underwriting and marketing call where 
junior and senior underwriters debate the risks they want to write and their fit to the portfolio 
and market. It also characterises the Group-wide RRC which brings together underwriting, 
actuarial, modeling, finance, treasury, risk and operations to challenge the assumptions  
used in all areas of our business.

14

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Underwriting  
comes first

Effectively balance  
risk and return

Operate nimbly  
through the cycle

We focus on maintaining our portfolio 
structure, with the bulk of our exposures 
balanced towards market-moving events, 
and a strong commitment to core clients. 
We use the principle of peer review 
throughout the Group, usually prior  
to underwriting business for LICL,  
LUK and Kinesis, the platforms that 
accept larger net exposures, and 
post-underwriting at Cathedral,  
with its much smaller net exposures.

By bringing together all our disciplines 
– underwriting, actuarial, modeling, 
finance, treasury, risk and operations –  
at our fortnightly RRC meetings, we are 
able to look at how different parts of  
our operations are working together.  
We stress test our business plans and 
gauge where we can be most effective 
without undue volatility.

We have reduced our written premium 
and PMLs by turning down underpriced 
business, whilst retaining our core book.

We have grown the number of Kinesis 
investors and the number of cedants  
to double figures.

Cathedral was successful in renewing  
its business, despite intense competition.

We have had to reduce income in some 
areas of our business in response to a 
weakening market in the first half of 
2017. However, we have been able to  
find substantial outwards reinsurance 
opportunities that allowed us to mitigate 
some of the effects of price reductions, 
and reduce our net exposures until the 
time is right for us to retain more risk.

Combined ratio

124.9%

A respectable combined ratio, even in a 
year where the global insurance industry 
sustained a significant level of catastrophe 
losses, evidencing the continued focus on 
underwriting, superior risk selection and 
portfolio construction.

Gross premiums written

$591.6m

We focused on protecting our  
core portfolios, but maintained the 
discipline to decline or restructure our 
participation on underpriced or poorly 
performing business.

The key risk in the current market phase 
is the loss of relevance to brokers and 
clients. With so much surplus capacity, 
insurers need to have a unique selling 
point. For the Group, that is found in  
its mixture of underwriting capacity, 
leadership capability, claims service  
and multiple balance sheet options.

Return on equity

-5.9%

A good result despite a challenging 
market and the incidence of catastrophe 
risk losses in our major portfolios of 
business, helped by our improved 
outwards reinsurance programme.

Probable maximum loss

$161.8m*

We continued to reduce our exposure  
to key catastrophe perils as the market has 
become more competitive, demonstrating 
our discipline and nimbleness.

*  1 in 100 year Gulf of Mexico Hurricane 
expected net loss at 1 January 2018.

The key issue for Lancashire is to 
continue to serve our clients and brokers 
with significant capacity, whilst ensuring 
that the portfolio is balanced. This means 
constantly reassessing our business mix, 
and testing key risk assumptions.

As capital continues to accumulate in  
the (re)insurance market, the need to  
be nimble is more important than ever. 
This means being ready to deploy capital 
quickly when it is needed, and having the 
discipline to return it when it is not.

Lancashire renewed its 15 per cent 
disapplication of pre-emption rights at 
the 2017 AGM to assist potential future 
capital raises.

Ordinary dividends paid

$29.9m

Lancashire continues to exercise  
the discipline of maintaining sufficient 
capital headroom to support underwriting 
operations and take advantage of new 
opportunities as they emerge or  
returning capital to shareholders  
it cannot profitably use.

Dividend yield

1.6%

Capital is retained following loss events  
to take advantage of any underwriting 
opportunities that may follow.

Lancashire has developed an expectation 
among its shareholders that it will 
produce a consistent return and pay 
ordinary dividends with special dividends 
only when it makes sense to do so. All 
shareholders understand that in harder 
markets Lancashire will retain, and 
potentially even raise, capital to take full 
advantage of underwriting opportunities.

Read more on page 18

Read more about our risk management on page 31

www.lancashiregroup.com

15

DescriptionAchievementsPerformanceAssociated strategic risksOverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsFinancial review

Strong performance  
in challenging conditions

Lancashire produced a loss for the year. 
What drove that?
There were a number of significant  
and costly catastrophe events in 2017 
– Hurricanes Harvey, Irma and Maria, two 
Mexican earthquakes plus the Californian 
wildfires being the larger events and the  
ones with the most impact on Lancashire’s 
performance. We have therefore produced a 
return on equity of negative 5.9 per cent and 
a comprehensive loss of $66.2 million. Given 
the nature of our book, and that 2017 could 
end up being one of the costliest natural 
catastrophe years on record, we are actually 
pretty pleased with the way our book 
performed. Our loss experience across  
these events was very much in line with 
expectations. Overall, for these events we 
have recorded a net loss after recoveries and 
reinstatement premiums of $189.2 million, 
with our equity pick-up from our investment 
in Kinesis also included in that number. 
Looking forward to 2018 we do expect  
to benefit from the post-loss improved 
pricing environment.

How does the Group establish reserves 
for such significant events?
It’s quite an involved process. Our CUOs  
and Active Underwriters work with our 
claims and actuarial teams to establish which 
lines of business are impacted. There is then 
a detailed review on an account-by-account 
basis by our underwriting teams, in 
conjunction with claims, to identify the 
individual accounts which may be exposed. 
With a combination of experience, history 
and feedback from the brokers and clients 
themselves, they put together a preliminary 
estimate of loss per client. The gross loss is 
then fed through our various reinsurance 
programmes to get to a net loss position. 
This goes through a rigorous internal  
review process and we overlay our view of the 
industry loss size. Lastly, all of this is provided 
to the Reserve Committee who review and 
challenge the underlying estimates.

Elaine Whelan
Group Chief Financial Officer

In 2017, we carried a little bit more of a capital buffer 
than we typically would – a bit of an insurance policy 
given the market conditions we were dealing with.  
That strategy served us well and our balance sheet 
remains strong.

16

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

“Given the nature of  
our book, and that 2017 
could end up being one 
of the costliest natural 
catastrophe years on 
record, we are actually 
pretty pleased with  
the way our book 
performed.”

What does that mean for Lancashire’s 
capital position?
We always work out the business we want  
to write and then we work out the capital we 
need to support that. We add a buffer on top 
of that and typically any excess is returned  
to shareholders. In 2017, we carried a little 
bit more of a capital buffer than we typically 
would – a bit of an insurance policy given  
the market conditions we were dealing with. 
That strategy served us well and our balance 
sheet remains strong. Given current 
expectations of post-loss pricing, we expect  
to fully utilise our current capital base. As a 
result, we did not declare a special dividend 
in 2017. Depending on loss activity in 2018,  
a better rating environment should lead  
to better returns.

Have the events had any impact on  
the Group’s strategy?
In short, no. Our goal has always been  
to maximise risk-adjusted returns for our 
shareholders across the cycle. Our strategy 
remains to manage the cycle appropriately 
and match our capital to the underwriting 
opportunity. Over the last few years we have 
reduced our top line and bought more 
reinsurance as the market softened. In 2018 
we expect to be able to take advantage of  
the post-loss pricing environment.

Elaine Whelan
Group Chief Financial Officer

Financial highlights

Gross premiums written
Net premiums written
Net premiums earned
Net insurance losses
Net underwriting (loss) income
Net investment income
Net realised gains (losses) and impairments
Net operating (loss) profit
(Loss) profit after tax 
Net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments
Comprehensive (loss) income 
Dividends1
Diluted (loss) earnings per share
Diluted operating (loss) earnings per share
Fully converted book value per share
Return on equity
Return on equity excluding warrant adjustments
Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio
Combined ratio
Accident year loss ratio 
Net total return on investments2

(1) Dividends are included in the financial statement year in which they were recorded.
(2) Net return on investments includes internal foreign exchange hedge.

2017 
$m
591.6 
398.0 
427.9 
335.4 
(23.1) 
30.5 
9.1 
(86.0) 
(71.1) 
4.9 
(66.2) 
29.9 
($0.36) 
($0.43) 
$5.48 
(5.9%) 
(5.9%) 
78.4% 
27.0% 
19.5% 
124.9% 
94.2% 
2.5% 

2016 
$m
633.9
458.7
488.1
142.5
213.5
29.8
(2.4)
144.0
153.8
4.1
157.9
178.9
 $0.76
$0.71
$5.98
13.5%
13.5%
29.2%
27.1%
20.2%
76.5%
46.2%
2.1%

2015 
$m
641.1
481.7
567.1
155.7
265.2
29.8
(2.8)
173.4
181.1
(11.3)
169.8
317.5
$0.91
$0.87
$6.07
10.9%
13.5% 
27.5%
25.8%
18.8%
72.1%
46.0%
0.7%

2014 
$m
907.6
742.8
715.6
226.5
335.7
28.6
(5.9)
231.9
229.3
(2.1)
227.2
321.0
$1.16
$1.17
$6.96
13.9%
14.7% 
31.7%
21.4%
15.6%
68.7%
35.9%
1.0%

2013 
$m
679.7
557.6
568.1
188.1
254.2
25.4
12.6
184.2
222.5
(32.5)
190.0
325.6
$1.17
$0.97
$7.50
18.9%
18.9% 
33.1%
22.1%
15.0%
70.2%
36.1%
0.3%

www.lancashiregroup.com

17

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
Key performance indicators

Return on equity

Combined ratio

Total investment return

The return on equity is measured by 
management as the internal rate of return 
of the change in fully converted book 
value per share in the period, adjusted  
for dividends.

The Group’s aim is to provide 
shareholders with a risk-adjusted return 
on equity of 13 per cent in excess of the 
risk-free rate over the longer term.

The combined ratio is the ratio of costs  
to net premiums earned and is a measure 
of an insurance company’s operating 
performance. It is calculated as the sum  
of the loss ratio, the acquisition cost ratio 
and the expense ratio. These ratios are 
defined in our glossary.

The Group aims to price its business to 
ensure that the combined ratio across the 
cycle is significantly less than 100 per cent.

Total investment return measures 
investment income and net realised and 
unrealised gains and losses produced by 
the Group’s managed investment portfolio.

The Group’s primary investment 
objectives are to preserve capital and 
provide adequate liquidity to support  
the Group’s payment of claims and other 
obligations. Within this framework we aim 
for a degree of investment portfolio return.

-5.9%

18.9*

124.9%

2.5%

14.7*

13.5*

13.5

124.9

70.2

68.7

72.1

76.5

-5.9

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

A significant level of loss activity in 2017 
has resulted in a negative RoE for the  
year for the first time since we began 
underwriting in 2006.  

The stated aim is a long-term goal, 
acknowledging that management expects 
both higher and lower results in the 
shorter term. The cyclicality and volatility 
of the insurance market is expected to be 
the largest driver of this pattern. We seek 
to align our variable remuneration to 
shareholders’ interests by having a RoE 
component in this.

Please refer to the Directors’ 
Remuneration Report on page 60  
for further details.

In 2017, we witnessed the occurrence  
of three major hurricanes (Harvey, Irma 
and Maria), two earthquakes in Mexico  
as well as wildfires in California. The high 
combined ratio in 2017 reflects the impact 
of these losses. Whilst there was a higher 
than usual sequence of catastrophe loss 
events in 2017 the impact of these was not 
outsize or unexpected for the Group or  
its stakeholders. 

The Group’s underwriters assess likely 
losses, using models, their experience  
and knowledge of past loss experience, 
industry trends and current circumstances. 
This allows them to estimate the premiums 
sufficient to meet likely losses and 
expenses. Peer reviews of risks are 
conducted through the daily underwriting 
call or peer review, depending on  
risk impact, enabling the Group to  
ensure careful risk selection, limits on 
concentration and appropriate portfolio 
diversification. The RRC then monitors 
performance at a portfolio level. 

e
g
a
r
e
v
a
r
a
e
y
-
5

2.5

2.1

1.0

0.7

0.3
2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

In 2017, Lancashire continued to monitor 
risk-on/risk-off volatility and maintained 
the allocation to risk assets in the surplus 
portfolio as a hedge against the interest 
rate risk inherent in the significant fixed 
maturity allocation of the portfolio. 

The investment strategy places an 
emphasis on the preservation of invested 
assets and provision of sufficient liquidity 
for the prompt payment of claims, in 
conjunction with providing a reasonably 
stable income stream. These objectives  
are reflected in the Group’s investment 
guidelines and its conservative asset 
allocation. Management reviews the 
composition, duration and asset allocation 
of the investment portfolio on a regular 
basis in order to respond to changes in 
interest rates and other market conditions. 

*  RoE including the impact of warrants was 10.9% in 2015, 13.9% in 2014 and 18.9% in 2013. The five-year average was 10.3%.

18

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

AimMeasurementPerformanceRisk management 
Total shareholder return

Total shareholder return is measured in 
terms of the internal rate of return of the 
increase/decrease in share price in the 
period, measured in U.S. dollars and 
adjusted for dividends.

Percentage of comprehensive 
income returned to shareholders

The percentage of comprehensive income 
returned to shareholders equals the total 
capital returned to shareholders through 
dividends and share repurchases paid in  
a given year, divided by the Group’s 
comprehensive income.

Dividend yield

Dividend yield is measured by dividing the 
annual dividends per share by the share 
price on the last day of the given year.

The Group’s aim is to maximise RoE  
over the longer term and we would  
expect that to be reflected in our share 
price and multiple. This is a long-term 
goal, recognising that the cyclicality and 
volatility of both the insurance market  
and the financial markets in general will 
impact management’s ability to maximise 
the share multiple in the immediate term.

The Group aims to carry the right level  
of capital to match attractive underwriting 
opportunities, utilising an optimal mix of 
capital tools. Over time, through proactive 
and flexible capital management across 
the cycle, we aim to generate optimum 
returns for shareholders.

The Group aims to maintain a strong 
balance sheet whilst generating an attractive 
risk-adjusted return for shareholders. 
Lancashire’s dividend yield demonstrates 
our ability to operate nimbly through the 
cycle through the active capital management 
that underpins our business model. We 
aim to pay annual ordinary dividends, and 
when we decide not to retain our profits 
as additional underwriting capital we 
return them to shareholders by way  
of special dividends.

9.4%

21.3

25.9

2.4

9.4

n/a*

171.4

152.3

187.0

1.6%

17.8

17.3

113.3

12.3

e
g
a
r
e
v
a
r
a
e
y
-
5

-24.2
2014

2013

2015

2016

2017

2013

2014

2015

2016

n/a*
2017

The share price benefited from an uptick 
towards the end of the year due to positive 
expectations for the (re)insurance market 
following the run of catastrophe losses. 

The Lancashire remuneration structure 
and RSS ensure that staff are highly 
motivated and closely aligned to the 
Group’s goals, and therefore with 
shareholders. Permanent staff are all 
eligible to receive RSS awards. The 
participation of employees in the RSS 
ensures that there is a strong focus on 
sustainable long-term shareholder value.

Following the costly catastrophe events in 
2017, Lancashire took the decision not to 
pay a special dividend in order to retain 
capital to support potential business 
opportunities in the post-loss market.

*  The Group made a comprehensive loss of  
$66.2 million during 2017. We paid annual 
ordinary dividends of $0.15 per share.  Due  
to 2017 being n/a, the average is calculated  
over 4 years.

Risk tolerances are set at a level that aims 
to prevent the Group incurring losses that 
would impair its ability to operate. The 
Group’s key capital measure is its A.M. 
Best rating, and a minimum rating of A–  
is considered necessary to attract business. 
In 2017, Lancashire maintained its A rating.

10.5

1.6

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

During 2017, we paid annual ordinary 
dividends of $0.15 per share.

As capital continues to accumulate in  
the (re)insurance market, the need to  
be nimble is more important than ever. 
This means being ready to deploy capital 
quickly when it is needed and having the 
discipline to return it when it is not. The 
Group has to ensure that all shareholders 
understand that in harder markets the 
Group will want to retain, and potentially 
even raise, capital to take full advantage  
of underwriting opportunities.

KPI linked to Executive Directors’ remuneration. For more information see pages 60 to 79.

www.lancashiregroup.com

19

AimMeasurementPerformanceRisk managementOverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
Underwriting review

Adapting to the cycle

In recent years we have been able to ignore 
the pressure for top-line premium growth, 
focusing on maintaining a core portfolio  
of risks and protecting this portfolio  
with tailored, and increasingly more 
comprehensive, reinsurance products. When 
the price you receive for the risk reduces, the 
amount of risk you take should also reduce.

Rates in almost all of our product lines have 
been declining year-on-year making it more 
and more difficult to produce acceptable 
underwriting margins. We, like all of our 
peers, have clearly benefited from what  
has been a benign period over a number  
of years for natural catastrophe insured loss 
events. However, in non-natural catastrophe 
exposed lines we have also been able to 
continue to deliver underwriting margins, 
which the broader market has struggled to 
achieve, through disciplined underwriting 
and superior risk selection. The benign  
loss environment in natural catastrophe 
exposed lines has certainly masked rating 
deficiency elsewhere. So despite soft market 
conditions we were still able to achieve 
sector-leading underwriting results across  
our underwriting platforms by maintaining 
underwriting discipline.

The benign natural catastrophe environment 
was never going to continue forever, and the 
broader market was able to hide behind the 
profits generated by catastrophe business 
throughout this benign period. At some 
point this was going to end, and in the third 
quarter of 2017 this benign loss environment 
came to an abrupt halt with the three land- 
falling hurricanes, namely Harvey, Irma  
and Maria, as well as Mexico experiencing 
two major earthquakes. These losses were 
promptly followed by a fourth, if rather  
less significant, hurricane (Nate) and  
some of the costliest wildfires ever seen in 
California. In addition to these there were 
also major flood events in South East Asia 
and devastating mudslides in Columbia.

Mother Nature has certainly reminded  
our industry of the devastation and cost she 
can deliver. Every time there are catastrophe 
losses there seems to be something ‘unique’ 
about the loss or losses. By now we should 
realise the next loss or run of losses will 
always be different from the last.

First, these losses are devastating from  
a human perspective with millions of 
people’s lives impacted by these cruel events. 
Second, the broader economic impact of 
these events, particularly in areas such as  
the Caribbean, are also incredibly damaging 
with lasting implications for these local 
economies. Third, the impact to our industry 
has been significant. It is likely that when the 
final bill is added up 2017 will be only the 
third year on record with natural catastrophe 
insured losses in excess of $100 billion and 
quite possibly the costliest in history, and in 
any year this is a true test for the industry.

As a Group we have always had significant 
exposure to natural catastrophe risk across 
all of our platforms via a number of our 
reinsurance and insurance product lines. 
These events are a real test of our risk 
management capabilities as they are at the 
heart of our major product lines. When there 
are losses of this frequency and magnitude 
we obviously expect to incur losses across  
all of our platforms. At our inception one  
of our strategic objectives was to make an 
underwriting profit four years in every five, 
therefore acknowledging that there will be 
years where we will make an underwriting 
loss. We have been able to achieve an 
underwriting profit every year for the  
past 11 years, so whilst this year will be  
the first exception to this, in the context  
of our original target we have performed 
remarkably well.

20

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

We have always been very candid about our underwriting approach. Our aim as underwriters has always been to find the appropriate balance between risk and return. This underwriting philosophy has never changed since our formation, however it does mean that at each stage of the market cycle our underwriting tactics change. Paul Gregory
Group Chief Underwriting Officer

“Mother Nature has 
certainly reminded  
our industry of the 
devastation and cost she 
can deliver. Every time 
there are catastrophe 
losses there seems to be 
something ‘unique’ about 
the loss or losses. By now 
we should realise the 
next loss or run of losses 
will always be different 
from the last.”

Part of our disciplined underwriting strategy 
over the past few years has been to ensure 
that when we experience loss events such  
as those in 2017, we perform in line with  
our various stakeholders’ expectations and 
remain in a position to be responsive to  
our clients’ and brokers’ needs. First, we 
need to be able to pay our clients’ claims 
expeditiously. Second, we need to be in a 
position to continue to provide these clients 
with ongoing support. Third, we want the 
underwriting platforms to be in a robust 
position to broaden our underwriting 
appetite and client base should the  
market conditions dictate.

I am very pleased that after experiencing 
these events we have achieved these aims  
and remain in a position to respond 
appropriately to our clients’ current and 
future needs. As much as we have been 
prepared to narrow our portfolio in soft 
market conditions, we are equally prepared 
to broaden our portfolio in improving 
market conditions.

So as we look forward into 2018 we are very 
well positioned as a Group to service and 
support our existing clients and portfolio. 
We have the platforms and the people to 
ensure we maximise whatever underwriting 
opportunities manifest themselves.

Property Reinsurance
2017 certainly bucked the recent trend of 
benign loss years. The market received a 
stark reminder of the havoc and cost that 
Mother Nature can deliver. All of the various 
hurricane, flood, fire and earthquake events 
of 2017 tested the global reinsurance and 
retrocession markets. It was not just the 
quantum of these losses but the frequency. 
After a number of years of rate reductions 
and broadening terms and conditions these 
losses come at a time that really tests the 
robustness of the market. Thus far it looks 
like the market will be able to respond  
to these losses as our customers would  
expect with claims being paid, however  
the dynamics of the market are now likely  
to change, albeit not to the extent we  
would like to see.

The structure of the reinsurance  
market in recent years has subtly changed,  
with the growth of ILS funds in the sector, 
predominantly into the retrocession space.  
It is fair to say that the 2017 losses are the 
first true test for a lot of this ‘new’ capacity 
and much like traditional rated paper  
there will be some that respond better than 
others. There is no doubt that retrocession 
pricing is going up, whether that be  
rated paper or ILS paper. This will flow 
through to the property reinsurance  
market as retrocessional costs increase. 

www.lancashiregroup.com

21

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsUnderwriting review continued

There will of course be differentiation, with 
loss-impacted territories and clients sharing 
more of the cost burden than those territories 
and clients that were not loss impacted.

No one can predict exactly how much  
better the market will be in 2018 for these 
classes of business but what we do know is  
the softening has currently stopped and 
pricing is improving. The extent to which  
it does is very much dependent upon both 
the development pattern of the losses,  
and as always the dynamic between  
demand and supply.

As a Group we are very well placed to access 
all sectors of the reinsurance market so will 
be able to maximise whatever opportunity 
there is. We have the option of both rated 
paper, either company market or Lloyd’s, 
and collateralised products via Kinesis, 
providing our clients with the full suite of 
reinsurance options. We have an established 
position and reputation in the property 
reinsurance market with deep broker and 
client relationships to benefit from any 
improved market conditions. As always  
the Group will look to take risk that is 
appropriate to the opportunity.

Property Direct & Facultative
Much like the property reinsurance  
market the story for the direct property 
market in 2017 was dominated by the 
significant natural catastrophe events. Years 
of relatively benign conditions had led to 
increased competition in this sector, which 
inevitably had led to rating pressure across  
all elements of the portfolio, albeit more so 
for the open market business than the more 
stable binder business. As in other sectors of 
the market this pricing pressure had taken 
the margin from the portfolio. As a result, 
when events with the frequency and severity 
of those experienced in 2017 occur, the 
underwriting results will be in the red.

The D&F portfolio within the Group is 
primarily written from our Lloyd’s platform 
and much like other lines of business this has 
shrunk as market conditions softened. The 
portfolio has de-risked in certain territories 
as rates and conditions became unsustainable. 
Given the 2017 industry loss events this has 
justified the decision as the losses incurred  
to the Group would have undoubtedly been 
larger if risk levels had not been reduced.

Following the losses there is likely to be 
positive rating movement during 2018 on 
our existing Direct & Facultative portfolio 
and also the opportunity to grow in areas 
where in recent years we have shrunk, for 
example Mexico and the Caribbean. We 
expect this to be predominantly within  
the open market D&F sphere as the binder 
book is traditionally a more stable portfolio 
although this will also benefit from better 
rating conditions. The extent of any growth 
will obviously be dictated by the extent of the 
opportunity as we look to balance risk and 
return appropriately.

Energy
The ‘perfect storm’ of a low oil price and 
historically high levels of upstream energy 
market capacity witnessed during 2015 and 
2016 continued in 2017, albeit with an oil 
price that was far more stable and a client 
base whose necessary cost cutting had largely 
been achieved. The stabilisation of the oil 
price meant that the demand side of the 
equation held up during 2017. Whilst the 
upstream energy market did not see a huge 
uptick in demand there were not any further 
reductions and there are a few early signs of 
some demand coming back into the system 
with a small number of construction projects 
coming to market and a number of our 
clients gradually increasing activity.

With the supply dynamic unchanged,  
i.e. historically high levels of market  
capacity, there was still pressure on rates  
as competition for a much reduced pot of 
premium continued amongst markets. The 
Group’s strategy has been to maintain our 
core portfolio of profitable business as rates 
are now approaching levels last seen in the 
late 1990s and, considering that in 2012 rates 
were not far from historical highs, this shows 
how steep the fall in energy rates has been  
in the space of only a few years.

2017, however, was relatively benign for  
the upstream energy market in terms of 
significant claims although some prior  
year major losses did develop negatively, 
highlighting the volatility of the class.  
This benign loss year has helped mask the 
underlying weakness of energy rates and  
any return to a ‘normalised’ loss year would 
likely render the current rating environment 
unsustainable from a macro-market 
perspective. Whilst the natural catastrophe 

22

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

events of 2017 have not directly impacted  
the upstream energy market they are large 
enough to alter the direction of the energy 
reinsurance market, which will filter through 
to the direct market as reinsurance costs 
increase. With this dynamic in place we  
fully expect market conditions to improve 
during 2018. The Group has access to  
energy business from both the Lancashire 
Companies and Lloyd’s platforms, which 
primarily will focus on servicing existing 
clients’ needs. However, should market 
conditions dictate, we have the people  
and the platforms to grow our energy 
portfolio further.

“Following the  
losses there is likely  
to be positive rating 
movement during 2018 
on our existing Direct & 
Facultative portfolio 
and also the opportunity 
to grow in areas where  
in recent years we have 
shrunk, for example 
Mexico and the 
Caribbean.”

“The Group is able  
to offer significant 
capacity across multiple 
platforms to ensure  
we are providing both 
clients and brokers with 
fully rounded products 
and services, which 
allows us to maintain 
our underwriting 
principles despite  
the many challenges  
the market contains.”

Marine
The marine market was relatively stable 
during 2017 with rates across areas of  
our marine portfolios remaining  
reasonably static.

Within the cargo market a number of 
London market participants exited the  
class during 2017, which aided this stability. 
The natural catastrophe events later in the 
year also impacted the cargo market given 
the exposure that this portfolio has to these 
kinds of events. Fortunately for us our 
portfolio performed admirably given  
the make-up of the book which has been 
deliberately designed to try to mitigate 
natural catastrophe exposures where 
possible. We expect these loss events  
to improve the cargo market during  
2018 with rates reacting positively.

Outside of cargo, our hull, builders’ risk  
and ancillary marine products portfolio 
performed steadily and we maintained  
our position on all our key accounts. This 
portfolio has been our most stable since  
our inception with our risk appetite clearly 
defined, which has allowed us to deliver 
sector-leading results for what is a notoriously 
difficult area to generate underwriting 
returns. Whilst the natural catastrophe  
events of 2017 have no direct impact on  
the insurance lines we write it will impact  
the broader reinsurance market so we  
expect stability in this market to continue 
through 2018.

Aviation
The aviation market, much like the marine 
market, has historically been a difficult place 
to deliver respectable underwriting returns. 
Fortunately as a Group we have consistently 
been able to do this across all of our platforms. 
In a soft but more stable market in 2017 we 
continued to deliver underwriting profits. 
We access both the direct and reinsurance 
market across the Group’s platforms so have 
excellent visibility of the entire sector.

Throughout the year there were a few green 
shoots of hope that the market had found a 
more viable level, particularly in the direct 
lines such as war. Market capacity has yet  
to retract, however, so as always until the 
demand/supply dynamic alters there is 
unlikely to be any material improvement  

in market conditions. That said there  
has been a general recognition within  
the market, most notably post the natural 
catastrophe events of the third quarter of 
2017, that the softening needs to stop. The 
rating environment for the broader market 
has now stabilised, much like other non-
catastrophe lines, although it is still not at a 
level to sustain any quantum of normalised 
loss levels. We are confident that, at the very 
least, this stability of market conditions will 
continue through 2018.

Terrorism, Political Violence  
& Political Risks
As in recent years the world continued to  
be a volatile place during 2017. There were 
numerous terrorist attacks across the globe 
in cities including London, Manchester, 
Barcelona, Paris and Stockholm as well as 
ongoing wars and civil disruption in many 
countries including Syria, Libya, Afghanistan, 
Iraq and Yemen. In addition, we have seen 
political tensions escalate between North 
Korea and the U.S. with the sabre-rattling 
intensifying. Despite these terrorism events 
and wars being horrific from a loss of life 
perspective, the impact on the insurance 
market has been minimal as they have 
created very few actual insured losses.

This global political and socio-economic 
climate certainly creates challenges for 
underwriting these classes of business, and 
risk selection remains absolutely crucial as 
years of softening rates means that there  
is little margin to cater for any type of 
attritional losses. Given this, and as with 
other classes of business, we have built up a 
profitable core portfolio of business, which 
in the softer market we have successfully 
retained. If the significant loss events of 2017 
lead to a broader hard market then our 
leadership capabilities in these classes would 
allow us to develop our portfolio quickly  
and we have the appetite to do so.

The Group is able to offer significant 
capacity across multiple platforms to ensure 
we are providing both clients and brokers 
with fully rounded products and service 
which allows us to maintain our underwriting 
principles despite the many challenges the 
market contains.

www.lancashiregroup.com

23

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsBusiness review

Ready to deliver, in all conditions

Hayley Johnson
Chief Underwriting Officer, LUK

Sylvain Perrier
Chief Underwriting Officer, LICL

Jon Barnes
Active Underwriter, Syndicate 2010

John Spence
Active Underwriter, Syndicate 3010

Business environment and outlook
2017 was characterised by a significant  
level of loss activity. With the occurrence  
of hurricanes Harvey, Irma and Maria, the 
Mexican earthquakes and the California 
wildfires, the industry has incurred 
substantial losses.

At Lancashire we pride ourselves on 
understanding the insurance cycle. These 
events have shown the value of our priorities. 
Our discipline means that we prioritise the 
appropriate risk selection for all stages of  
the cycle.

Our outlook for 2018 is more positive than  
it has been for some time. We expect to  
put our capital to work to take advantage  
of improving market conditions and will  
be paying our standard ordinary dividend,  
in line with our stated dividend policy.

Renewal price index (RPI)
Lancashire’s RPI is an internal methodology 
that management uses to track trends in 
premium rates on a portfolio of insurance 
and reinsurance contracts. The RPI is 
calculated on a per contract basis and reflects 
Lancashire’s assessment of relative changes 
in price, terms, conditions and limits on 
like-for-like renewals only, and is weighted by 
premium volume. The RPI does not include 
new business and only covers business written 
by LICL and LUK, to offer a consistent basis 
for analysis. The calculation involves a degree 
of judgement in relation to the comparability 
of contracts and the assessment noted above. 
To enhance the RPI tool, Lancashire may 
revise the methodology and assumptions 
underlying the RPI, so the trends in 
premium rates reflected in the RPI may  
not be comparable over time. Consideration 
is only given to renewals of a comparable 
nature so the RPI does not reflect every 
contract in LICL and LUK’s portfolio. The 
future profitability of the portfolio of contracts 
within the RPI is dependent upon many 
factors besides the trends in premium rates.

24

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The following table summarises the RPI figures for the main business classes, excluding the Lloyd’s segment, using 2006 as the base year:

RPI

Class
Aviation (AV52)
Gulf of Mexico offshore energy
Worldwide offshore energy
Marine
Property retrocession and reinsurance
Terrorism
Combined

Underwriting results

2017
34
103
68
65
98
36
57

2016
37
111
70
72
103
38
61

2015
41
118
81
82
117
43
68

2014
44
125
91
91
132
48
76

2013
49
136
97
89
152
52
81

2012
55
140
100
86
157
55
84

2011
59
140
97
79
131
57
83

2010
62
139
88
80
121
60
81

2009
68
137
84
82
127
66
83

2008
69
64
68
80
86
71
76

2007
80
80
80
88
97
86
86

2006
100
100
100
100
100
100
100

2017

2016

Gross premiums written
Net premiums earned
Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio
Combined ratio

Marine  
$m
67.6
50.7

Aviation 
$m
16.9
11.6

Energy  
$m
101.8
70.4

Property 
$m
198.0
146.5

Total  
$m
591.6
427.9
114.4% 15.8% 32.9% (19.0)% 95.6% 78.4%

Total  
Property 
$m
$m
633.9
219.5
148.5
488.1
9.2% 39.3% 41.8% (4.7)% 42.6% 29.2%
18.8% 44.0% 36.3% 27.6% 23.8% 27.0% 18.9% 45.1% 27.4% 30.6% 22.5% 27.1%
— 20.2%
8.6% 119.4% 124.9% 28.1% 84.4% 69.2% 25.9% 65.1% 76.5%

—
133.2% 59.8% 69.2%

Lloyd’s  
$m
207.3
148.7

Lloyd’s  
$m
215.0
173.2

Energy  
$m
126.0
105.5

Aviation 
$m
36.2
25.5

Marine  
$m
37.2
35.4

— 19.5%

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

Premiums
Gross premiums written decreased by  
6.7 per cent in 2017 compared to 2016.  
Gross premiums earned decreased by 6.9 per 
cent in 2017 compared to 2016. The Group’s 
five principal segments, and the key market 
factors impacting them, are discussed below.

Property
Property gross premiums written  
decreased by 9.8 per cent for the year  
ended 31 December 2017 compared to the 
year ended 31 December 2016. The decrease 
was primarily due to multi-year contracts in 
the property catastrophe, political risk and 
terrorism classes which were written in 2016 
that are not yet due to renew. This reduction 
was partly offset by new business written in 
the political risk book. Business flow in the 
political risk class is generally less predictable 
than other classes due to the specific nature 
of each deal. We also saw some new business 
written in the property catastrophe book and 
$7.0 million of reinstatement premiums in 
connection with hurricanes Harvey, Irma 
and Maria.

Energy
Energy gross premiums written decreased  
by 19.2 per cent for the year ended  
31 December 2017 compared to the year  
ended 31 December 2016. The decrease  
for the year was mainly due to exposure 
reductions on prior underwriting year 
risk-attaching business in the worldwide 
offshore book, which can include exposure 
such as construction projects that have  
been delayed or cancelled, plus the  
timing of renewal of non-annual deals  
in the worldwide offshore book.

Marine
Marine gross premiums written  
increased by 81.7 per cent for the year  
ended 31 December 2017 compared to  
the year ended 31 December 2016. The 
majority of the increase was due to new 
pro-rata business plus the timing of non-
annual renewals and an increase in prior 
underwriting year risk-attaching business  
due to changes in the underlying exposure.

in the AV52 book. In addition, there were 
premium reductions year on year in the 
satellite book following the de-risking of  
this book during 2017.

Lloyd’s
In the Lloyd’s segment gross premiums 
written decreased by 3.6 per cent for the  
year ended 31 December 2017 compared  
to the year ended 31 December 2016. The 
decrease was driven primarily by continued 
rating pressure on the energy book. This 
decrease was partly offset by an increase  
in reinstatement premiums in connection 
with hurricanes Harvey, Irma, and Maria.

Ceded
Ceded reinsurance premiums increased by 
$18.4 million, or 10.5 per cent, for the year 
ended 31 December 2017 compared to the 
year ended 31 December 2016. The increase 
was due to additional limit purchased plus 
reinstatement premiums in connection  
with hurricanes Harvey, Irma, and Maria.

Aviation
Aviation gross premiums written  
decreased by 53.3 per cent for the year 
ended 31 December 2017 compared to  
the year ended 31 December 2016. This  
was due to exposure reductions on prior 
underwriting year risk-attaching business  

Earned
Net premiums earned as a proportion of net 
premiums written were 107.5 per cent for the 
year ended 31 December 2017, compared  
to 106.4 per cent for the year ended 
31 December 2016. The earnings ratios  
were relatively stable on an annual basis.

www.lancashiregroup.com

25

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsBusiness review continued

Losses
2017 was characterised by significant 
catastrophe activity, in the form of hurricanes 
Harvey, Irma and Maria, the two earthquakes 
in Mexico and the California wildfires. As a 
result, the Group’s net loss ratio was 78.4  
per cent for the year ended 31 December 
2017 compared to 29.2 per cent for the  
year ended 31 December 2016. The 2017  
accident year loss ratio, including the  
impact of foreign exchange revaluations,  
was 94.2 per cent compared to 46.2 per  
cent for the year ended 31 December 2016.

Our net losses recorded for the year  
ended 31 December 2017 in relation to the 
catastrophe events noted above was $181.8 
million, excluding the impact of inwards and 
outwards reinstatement premiums and our 
share of losses from Kinesis. While reserves 
have been recorded, significant uncertainty 
exists on the eventual ultimate losses in 
relation to the hurricanes, earthquakes  
and wildfires as loss information after these 
types of events can take some time to obtain. 
The Group’s reserve estimates were derived 
from a combination of market data and 
assumptions, a limited number of provisional 
loss advices, limited client loss data and 
modeled loss projections. As additional 
information emerges, the Group’s actual 
ultimate loss may vary, perhaps materially, 
from the current reported reserves. The  
final settlement of all claims is likely to take 
place over a considerable period of time.

While there were no other significant  
net losses in either of 2017 and 2016, both 
years experienced a few small to mid-sized 
losses, primarily across the property and 
energy classes.

Prior year favourable development was  
$65.1 million for the year ended 31 December 
2017 compared to $85.8 million for the year 
ended 31 December 2016. Despite some 
adverse development on a prior accident 
year property and energy claims, we saw 
overall favourable development primarily 
due to general IBNR releases across most 
lines of business due to a lack of reported 
claims. Experience in 2016 was similar in 
terms of releases, offset partially by some 
adverse development on prior accident  
year energy and marine claims.

Excluding the impact of foreign exchange evaluations, the table below shows the impact  
of current accident year catastrophe events on the Group’s loss ratio for the year ended  
31 December 2017:

Reported loss ratio at 31 December 2017
Absent hurricane Harvey
Absent hurricane Irma
Absent hurricane Maria
Absent Mexico earthquakes
Absent California wildfires
Absent all catastrophe events

Losses  
$m
335.4
287.6
281.6
300.0
325.1
300.9
153.6

Loss ratio  
%
78.4
67.7
66.1
70.5
76.0
70.4
36.6

Note: The table does not sum to a total due to the impact of reinstatement premiums.

Excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations, previous accident years’ ultimate 
losses developed as follows during 2017 and 2016:

Ultimate loss development by accident year

2007 accident year and prior
2008 accident year
2009 accident year
2010 accident year
2011 accident year
2012 accident year
2013 accident year
2014 accident year
2015 accident year
2016 accident year
Total

2017  
$m
0.6
(0.5)
0.1
1.8
8.8
5.0
3.5
9.2
20.3
16.3
65.1

Note: Positive numbers denote favourable development.

The ratio of IBNR to total net loss reserves was 44.8 per cent as at 31 December 2017 
compared to 34.6 per cent as at 31 December 2016.

The table below provides further detail of the prior years’ loss development by class, 
excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations:

Loss development by class

Property
Energy
Marine
Aviation
Lloyd’s
Total

2017  
$m
14.4
21.1
15.2
3.0
11.4
65.1

Note: Positive numbers denote favourable development.

Accident year loss ratios

Accident year loss ratio
Initial accident year loss ratio
Change in loss ratio post 
accident year

2017  
%
94.2
n/a

n/a

2016  
$m
36.6
17.3
1.9
3.9
26.1
85.8

2016  
%
43.5
46.2

2015  
$m
26.4
35.2
13.8
2.9
29.4
107.7

2015  
%
32.4
46.0

2014  
$m
19.8
5.4
(9.7)
0.9
18.0
34.4

2014  
%
25.9
35.9

2016  
$m
(0.4)
1.6
(18.0)
3.2
9.9
13.5
(1.6)
19.9
57.7
—
85.8

2013  
$m
13.2
18.4
(23.4)
(1.4)
9.1
15.9

2013  
%
28.1
36.1

2.7

13.6

10.0

8.0

Note: Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2017.

26

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
 
Acquisition costs
The acquisition cost ratio was 27.0 per cent 
for the year ended 31 December 2017 
compared to 27.1 per cent for the year 
ended 31 December 2016. The acquisition 
cost ratio is relatively stable on an  
annual basis.

Investments, liquidity and cash flow
Since inception, the primary objectives for 
our investment portfolio have been capital 
preservation and liquidity. Those objectives 
remain unchanged, and are more important 
than ever in today’s volatile and reactive 
markets. As market volatility continues, we 
position our portfolio to limit downside risk 
in the event of market shocks. In 2017, our 
focus has been on managing our interest rate 
risk, the largest risk to our predominantly 
fixed maturity portfolio. We continue to 
maintain a short-duration fixed maturity 
portfolio and have been using our risk 
budget to add products to our portfolio  
to help mitigate a rise in rates.

Managed investment portfolio allocations

Cash
Short-term investments
Fixed maturity funds
Government debt
Agency debt
Agency MBS, CMBS
Non-agency RMBS, ABS, CMBS
Corporate bonds
Bank loans
Fixed maturity – at FVTPL
Equity securities
Hedge funds – at FVTPL
Other investments
Total

Our portfolio mix illustrates our conservative 
philosophy, as shown in the table below. 
With the composition regulated by the 
Group’s investment guidelines, we have  
three investment portfolio categories: ‘core’, 
‘core plus’ and ‘surplus’. The core portfolio 
contains at least enough funds required to 
meet near-term obligations and cash flow 
needs following an extreme event. Assets  
in excess of those required to be held in  
the core portfolio may be held in any of  
the three categories, which are discussed 
further on page 110.

As at 31 December 2017 and 2016  
the managed portfolio was as follows:

Fixed maturity securities
Cash and cash 
equivalents
Hedge funds
Equity securities
Total

2017  
%
80.1

2016  
%
81.4

10.2
8.4
1.3
100.0

10.4
7.0
1.2
100.0

2017  
%
10.2
6.0
1.7
17.0
3.8
7.7
8.5
28.2
5.8
1.4
1.3
8.4
—
100.0

2016  
%
10.4
0.3
0.8
20.3
4.4
6.4
7.3
32.5
6.6
2.8
1.2
7.0
—
100.0

2015  
%
9.6
1.1
0.6
23.6
0.2
7.3
8.4
33.2
5.9
1.3
0.8
8.0
—
100.0

2014  
%
10.6
1.4
0.7
21.4
0.8
7.7
11.0
31.7
5.8
1.4
0.7
6.8
—
100.0

2013  
%
14.7
9.8
1.1
14.6
4.1
10.9
8.4
29.7
4.5
1.3
0.7
—
0.2
100.0

www.lancashiregroup.com

27

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
Business review continued

The composition, duration and asset 
allocation of the investment portfolio  
are reviewed on a regular basis in order  
to respond to changes in interest rates and 
other market conditions. If certain asset 
classes are anticipated to produce a higher 
return within management’s risk tolerance 
an adjustment in asset allocation may be 
made. Conversely, if the risk profile is 
expected to move outside of tolerance levels, 
adjustments may be made to reduce the  
risk in the portfolio. We try to be nimble  
in our investment strategy while putting  
our objective of capital preservation first  
and foremost.

We believe in the application of common 
sense, and do not place much reliance  
on ‘black box’ approaches to  
investment selection.

Investments are, however, inherently 
unpredictable and there are risks associated 
with any investment strategy decisions. 
Recent market history has been tumultuous 
and we remain ever watchful. We will 
continue to monitor the economic 
environment closely.

Investment performance
Net investment income excluding realised and 
unrealised gains and losses, was $30.5 million 
for the year ended 31 December 2017, an 
increase of 2.3 per cent compared to 2016. 
Total investment return, including net 
investment income, net realised gains  
and losses, impairments and net change  

Key investment portfolio statistics

Duration
Credit quality
Market yield
Book yield

Liquid securities will be maintained at an 
adequate level to more than meet expenses, 
including unanticipated claims payments. 
Only once safety, liquidity and investment 
income requirements are satisfied, may 
additional growth in the investment  
portfolio be pursued.

Cash flow
The Group’s cash inflows are primarily 
derived from net premiums received, from 
losses recovered from reinsurers, from net 
investment income, including dividends  
and net income from managed third party 
capital, and any capital raising activities 
performed in a given year including the 
issuance of debt. Excess funds are invested  
in the investment portfolio, which primarily 
consists of high-quality, highly liquid fixed 
maturity securities of short duration. Other 
cash inflows result from the sale and 
redemption of investments.

The principal outflows for the Group are  
the settlement of claims, the payment of 
premiums for reinsurance cover, payment  
of general and administrative expenses, the 
servicing of debt, the purchase of investment 
products and the distribution of dividends.

in unrealised gains and losses, was a  
gain of $45.7 million for the year ended 
31 December 2017 compared to a gain 
of $38.4 million for 2016.

Despite the increase in treasury yields in 
2017, the investment portfolio produced a 
return of 2.5 per cent due to the narrowing 
of credit spreads, coupon income and strong 
returns in the Group’s risk-asset portfolios. 
In 2016, the investment portfolio returned 
2.1 per cent. The fixed maturity portfolios 
performed reasonably well in 2016, primarily 
due to the narrowing of credit spreads,  
which more than offset the slight increase  
in treasury yields during the year. The 2016 
returns were also supported by strong 
performance from the Group’s bank  
loans, equities and equity-linked notes.

Our average annual total investment return 
since inception is 2.9 per cent, and we have 
made a positive investment return in every 
year since inception, including 2008.

Liquidity
The Group is a short-tail insurance and 
reinsurance group. As such, the investment 
portfolio must be liquid, short duration  
and highly creditworthy. As noted earlier,  
the Group’s investment strategy places an 
emphasis on the preservation of invested 
assets and provision of sufficient liquidity  
for the prompt payment of claims in 
conjunction with providing a reasonably 
stable income stream.

2017
1.7 years
AA-
2.1%
2.0%

2016
1.8 years
A+
1.9%
1.8%

2015
1.5 years
AA-
1.9%
1.6%

2014
1.5 years
AA-
1.5%
1.5%

2013
1.0 year
AA-
1.2%
1.4%

28

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
Lancashire third party capital 
management
The total contribution from third  
party capital activities consists of the 
following items:

Kinesis underwriting fees
Kinesis profit 
commission
Lloyd’s managing agency 
fees & profit commission
Total other income
Share of (loss) profit  
of associate
Total net third party 
capital managed income

2017  
$m
5.8

2016  
$m
4.4

5.9

6.2

5.5
17.2

9.9
20.5

(9.4)

5.1

7.8

25.6

The increase in Kinesis underwriting fees 
during 2017 was due to more limit being 
placed compared to 2016. The Kinesis  
profit commission was driven by the timing 
of loss experience and collateral release  
and therefore varies from year to year. The 
share of (loss) profit of associate reflects 
Lancashire’s 10 per cent equity interest in 
KHL. The overall loss for 2017 was entirely 
driven by the significant catastrophe  
activity during the second half of 2017.  
The reduction in Lloyd’s fees and profit 
commission was driven by the relative 
profitability of the underwriting years 
impacting each period.

Other operating expenses

Employee remuneration 
costs
Other operating 
expenses
Total

2017  
$m

2016  
$m

40.2

61.4

43.4
83.6

37.1
98.5

Employee remuneration costs for the year 
ended 31 December 2017 were $21.2 million 
lower than the same period in 2016, primarily 
driven by lower variable compensation due 
to the catastrophe activity in the year.

Other operating expenses were $6.3 million 
higher for the year ended 31 December 2017 
compared to the same period in 2016, 
primarily due to increased software costs, 
placement fees for the Kinesis vehicle plus 
higher consulting costs.

The equity-based compensation credit of 
$0.4 million for the year ended 31 December 
2017, compared to an expense of $10.7 
million for the year ended 31 December 
2016, was due to incorporating losses 
incurred during the second half of 2017  
into performance estimates, combined with 
the lapsing of awards of former Cathedral 
employees on their departure from the 
Group. The equity-based compensation 
charge was driven by the anticipated vesting 
level of the active awards based on current 
performance expectations.

Capital management
Lancashire has built a reputation for  
being one of the best known and most active 
proponents of capital management in the 
industry. Capital management is our most 
important area of focus after underwriting 
and it is our firm belief that proactive and 
flexible capital management is crucial in 
helping to maximise risk-adjusted return 
over time. With that focus we will return 
capital where this offers the best returns  
for our shareholders. We have returned 
108.1 per cent of comprehensive income 
generated via dividends or share  
repurchases since inception.

The Group actively reviews the level and 
composition of capital on an ongoing basis. 
Internal methods have been developed to 
review the profitability of classes of business 
and their estimated capital requirements 
plus the capital requirements of the 
combination of a wide range of other  
risk categories. The key aim of the capital 
management process is to maintain a  
strong balance sheet, whilst:

 • maintaining sufficient capital for 

underwriting opportunities and to  
meet obligations to policyholders;
 • maximising the risk-adjusted return  

to shareholders within predetermined  
risk tolerances;

 • maintaining adequate financial strength 

ratings; and

 • meeting internal, regulatory and rating 

agency requirements.

www.lancashiregroup.com

29

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
Business review continued

The subsidiary operating entities also 
conduct capital requirement assessments 
under internal measures and in compliance 
with local regulatory and Lloyd’s 
requirements.

Capital raising can include debt or equity, 
and returns of capital may be made through 
dividends, share repurchases, a redemption 
of debt or any combination thereof. All 
capital actions require approval by the  
Board of Directors. The retention of earnings 
generated also leads to an increase in capital.

The composition of capital is driven  
by management’s appetite for leverage, 
amongst other factors, including the cost  
and availability of different types of capital. 
Maintaining a strong balance sheet will  
be the overriding factor in all capital 
management decisions.

Capital
As at 31 December 2017, total capital 
available to the Group was $1.433 billion, 
comprising shareholders’ equity of $1.107 
billion and $326.3 million of long-term debt. 
Tangible capital was $1.279 billion. Leverage 
was 22.8 per cent on total capital and 25.5 
per cent on total tangible capital. Total 
capital and total tangible capital as at 
31 December 2016 were $1.528 billion  
and $1.374 billion respectively.

Dividends
During 2017, the Lancashire Board  
declared a final dividend of $0.10 per 
common share in respect of the 2016 
financial year and an interim dividend of 
$0.05 per common share in respect of 2017. 
With the final dividend in respect of 2017  
of $0.10 per common share, total capital 
returns since inception amount to $2.7 
billion, or 277.8 per cent of initial capital 
raised. The final dividend of $0.10 per 
common share will be paid on 21 March 
2018 to the shareholders of record on 
23 February 2018.

Non pre-emptive issue of shares
As part of the Group’s flexible approach  
to capital management the Board has in 
recent years requested and received from 
shareholders authority to issue up to 15 per 
cent of its shares on a non pre-emptive basis. 
Lancashire believes that this ability to raise 
capital quickly is important in securing 
first-mover advantage in the catastrophe 
insurance and reinsurance business in which 
it underwrites. The Board proposes to put a 
similar request for authority to shareholders 
in a resolution at the 2018 AGM to be held 
on 2 May 2018.

Letters of credit
Lancashire has a standard syndicated LOC 
facility which in total amounts to $300.0 
million, with a $75.0 million loan sub-limit 
available for general corporate purposes. 
Syndicate 2010 has an $80.0 million 
catastrophe facility in place to assist in paying 
claims and gross funding of catastrophes. 
Furthermore, a $130.0 million syndicated 
uncollateralised facility is available for 
utilisation by LICL and guaranteed by  
LHL for Funds at Lloyd’s purposes.

There was no outstanding debt under the 
above facilities at any reporting date. There 
are no off-balance sheet forms of capital.

30

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Enterprise risk management

Navigating our environment

Consistent Enterprise Risk Management is the key to being ready  
to respond in all environments.

The Group is exposed to risks from  
several sources. These include insurance  
risk, market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk, 
operational risk and strategic risk. The 
primary risk to the Group is insurance risk, 
which can be subdivided into the core risk of 
underwriting and non-core risk of reserving.

The Group has formulated, and keeps  
under review, a risk appetite which is set by 
the Board of Directors. The Group’s appetite 
for risk will vary marginally from time to time 
to reflect the potential risks and return that 
present themselves. However, protecting the 
Group’s capital and maximising risk-adjusted 
returns for investors over the long term are 
constants. The risk appetite of the Group  
is central to how the business is run and 
permeates into the risk appetites that  
the individual operating entity boards of 
directors have adopted. These risk appetites 
are expressed through detailed risk tolerances 
at both a Group and an operating entity 
level. Risk tolerances represent the maximum 
amount of capital, generally on a modeled 
basis, that the Group and its entities are 
prepared to expose to certain risks.

The Board of Directors is responsible  
for setting and monitoring the Group’s  
risk appetite and tolerances, whereas the 
individual entity boards of directors are 
responsible for setting and monitoring 
entity-level risk tolerances. All risk tolerances 
are subject to at least an annual review and 
consideration by the respective boards of 
directors. The Board and individual entity 
boards of directors review actual risk levels 
versus tolerances, emerging risks and any risk 
learning events at least quarterly. In addition, 
on at least a monthly basis, management 
reviews the output from SHARP in order to 
assess modeled potential losses against risk 
tolerances and to ensure that risk levels  
are managed in accordance with them.

ERM framework
The Group subscribes to a ‘three lines  
of defence’ model, the front line being  
risk ownership by business managers. 
Responsibility for the management of 
individual risks has been assigned to, and 
may form part of the performance objectives 
of, the risk owners within the business. Risk 
owners ensure that these risks and controls 
are consistent with their day-to-day processes 
and the entries made in the Group risk 
registers, which are a direct input into the 
subsidiary capital models. The second line 
comprises the risk management team, which 
is responsible for risk oversight. Within this, 
the Group CRO provides regular reports  
to the business outlining the status of the 
Group’s ERM activities and strategy, as well  
as formal reports to the Board and the 
boards of the individual operating entities. 
The Group CRO ultimately has the right  
to report directly to the Group and entity 
regulators if she feels that management  
is not appropriately addressing areas of 
concern. Cathedral’s CRO provides formal 
reports to the CUL Board and its Risk, 
Capital and Compliance Committee. The 
third line of defence is the internal audit 
function, which works very closely with the 
business and the risk management team  
in providing risk assurance.

We continue to perform a quarterly risk  
and controls affirmation process whereby  
the operation of all key controls is affirmed 
by the control operators and then reviewed  
and signed off by the risk owners. In addition,  
the risk owners are required to affirm their 
risks remain appropriately documented  
and scored. During 2017 this process was 
expanded to include all individual operating 
entities including the syndicates. The output 
from this process is reported to the RRC  
and the Group and operating subsidiary 
audit committees or boards of directors  
as appropriate.

www.lancashiregroup.com

31

Louise Wells
Group Chief Risk Officer

Maintaining the balance
The first eight months of 2017 were all about 
maintaining the balance of the risk we were 
taking on with the return we were receiving 
for that risk. It was pleasing therefore, that 
post hurricanes Harvey, Irma and Maria, the 
Mexican earthquakes and California wildfires 
we remained inside our Board-approved risk 
appetite and tolerances. Following these 
events our risk management processes did 
not change; our risk appetite was reviewed 
with the changing environment in mind, 
however no adjustments to tolerances  
were required.

Risk strategy
Our risk strategy is the starting point for  
the development and evolution of our risk 
management framework and is therefore 
refreshed on an annual basis in line with  
the continuous development of our 
framework and the annual review of the 
business and capital strategy. Our risk 
strategy must be aligned with our business 
and capital strategy to ensure the capital 
resources held are matched to the risk 
profile of the Group and that the balance 
between risk and return is considered as  
part of all key business decisions.

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsEnterprise risk management continued

ERM & ORSA 

Key Activities
 • Review of business strategy with challenge from the Board
 • Annual approval of a business strategy paper by the Board

 • Group CRO report  

to Board and Executive 
Management Committee
 • Production of ORSA report 
and review and approval  
by the Board

 • Capital and liquidity 

management frameworks

 • Review of BLAST  

policies, capital and  
solvency appetites

 • Full/proxy  

capital assessments

 • Rating agency  

capital assessments

 • Stress and scenario testing

STRATEGY REVIEW  

& CHALLENGE

RISK SOLVENCY &  

ASSESSMENT

CAPITAL 

MANAGEMENT

C U LTURE &
BOARD
RRCRRC
RRC
OVERN A N C E

G

RISK ID &  

ASSESSMENT

RISK APPETITE &  

TOLERANCES

RISK & BUSINESS  

MANAGEMENT

BUSINESS  

PLANNING

 • Risk identification and assessment
 • Quarterly risk and control  

affirmations

 • Quarterly internal audit reports to 
the Audit Committee per a three- 
and four-year rolling programme

 • External audit reports to the  

Audit Committee

 • Audit Committee annual  
review of the effectiveness  
of financial controls

 • Review of risk strategy  
and ‘attitude to risk’
 • Review of risk appetite  

and limits

 • Review of Group  
risk tolerances

 • Management, Board and 

subsidiary board approval  
of risk tolerances

 • Review of risk management 

 • Review and approval  

policies

of business plan by the Board

 • Assessment of risk management 

 • Stress and scenario testing 

framework maturity

(business plan)

 • Integrated assurance assessment
 • Emerging risk assessment

 • Assessment of management 

actions

Key Elements of ORSA

Board sign-off and embedding

Business Strategy

Risks

Capital and Solvency

Stress and Scenario testing

As at 31 December 2017, all Group entities 
were operating within their board-approved 
risk tolerances. No significant new risks have 
been identified and there have not been any 
material changes in our existing risks.

Our quarterly ORSA reports prepared by  
the Group CRO to the main Board provide a 
timely analysis of current and potential risks, 
compared against risk tolerances, along with 
their associated capital requirements. The 
2018 annual ORSA report will be presented 
to the Board for review, challenge and 
approval during Q1 2018 and then  
submitted to the PRA in line with  
supervisory requirements.

As a Lloyd’s managing agent, CUL falls 
within the Society of Lloyd’s for Solvency II 
reporting, preparing ORSA reports for  
each syndicate. Cathedral has its own  
ERM framework to ensure adherence  
to Lloyd’s minimum standards.

In November 2017, the Group CRO  
reported to the Remuneration Committee 
regarding risk and remuneration, 
recognising the importance of the design  
of the remuneration structure in driving 
desired behaviours over both the short-term 
and the longer-term business planning 
periods. In addition, a Group Solvency II 
Staff policy was reviewed, challenged and 
approved by the Remuneration Committee.

The diagram above illustrates how we 
balance our ERM and ORSA activities.  
Our risk culture is driven from the top down 
via the Board and executive management to 
the business, with the RRC central to these 
processes. The primary role of the Group 
CRO is to facilitate the effective operation of 
ERM and the ORSA process throughout the 
Group at all levels. The role includes, but is 
not limited to, the following responsibilities:

 • overall management of the risk 

management system;

 • to drive ERM culture, ownership  

and execution on three levels: Board, 
executive management and operational 
within the business;

 • to facilitate the identification, assessment, 
evaluation and management of existing 
and emerging risks by management and 
the Board including the articulation of risk 
preferences and the adoption of formal 
risk tolerances;

 • to ensure that these risks are given due 

consideration and are embedded within 
management’s and the Board’s oversight 
and decision-making process;

 • to be consulted, and opine, on policy  
in areas such as, but not limited to, 
underwriting, claims, investments, 
operations and capital management; and

32

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

O
v
e
r
v
e
w

i

 • to provide timely, accurate, reliable, 
factual, objective and accessible 
information and analysis to guide,  
coach and support decision making.

RRC
The RRC, under the chairmanship of the 
Group CEO, is the key management tool for 
monitoring and challenging the assessment 
of risk on a continual basis. It seeks to 
optimise risk-adjusted return and facilitate 
the appropriate use of BLAST, including 
considering its effectiveness. It ensures that 
all key areas of risk are discussed according 
to a schedule that covers fortnightly, monthly, 
quarterly, semi-annual and annual reviews. 
The RRC meets fortnightly and is responsible 
for co-ordinating and overseeing ERM 
activities within the risk profile, appetites and 
tolerances set by the Group and individual 
entity boards of directors. The RRC includes 
the Group CEO, members from the finance, 
actuarial, modeling, operations, treasury and 
underwriting functions and both the Group 
CRO and Cathedral CRO. The Group CRO 
reports on the RRC’s activities to the Group 

and individual entity boards of directors  
and, via the Cathedral CRO, the Risk, Capital 
and Compliance Committee of Cathedral. 
Through the Group CRO the RRC considers 
recommendations to the Board and its 
Committees with regard to the adoption  
of formal risk tolerances.

Capital models
We continue to challenge the assumptions 
used in the individual capital models and 
make changes where appropriate.

Emerging risk
The identification and assessment of 
emerging risk occurs throughout the Group 
from individual departments to management 
and executive committees to the boards of 
directors and sub-committees of the boards. 
The risk department maintains an emerging 
risk register, which is provided to the Board 
and entity boards of directors each quarter, 
and is therefore subject to an iterative 
process of review and oversight. Emerging 
risks, by their nature, are difficult to quantify, 
however during 2017 the Group strove to 

foresee potential areas of new risk, or 
developments in existing risks and to assess 
how those risks could impact the Group.

Risk universe
We continue to classify risks in three  
broad classes: (a) Intrinsic Risk: ‘Risk  
that stems from the inherent randomness 
and uncertainty that exists in the universe  
in which we operate and that is therefore 
fundamental to how we manage our 
business’. This can be core or non-core;  
(b) Operational Risk: which can be 
independent or correlated; and (c) Other 
Risk: the non-financial category of risks 
which cannot necessarily be mitigated by 
holding capital since such risks may not  
have direct balance sheet implications.

The Board evaluated the risks disclosed, 
alongside other factors, in the assessment of 
the Group’s viability and prospects as set out 
in the going concern and viability statement 
in the Directors’ Report at page 83.

Risk universe

Type

Category

Description

e
r
o
C
c
i
s
n
i
r
t
n
I

c
i
s
n
i
r
t
n
I

l
a
n
o
i
t
a
r
e
p
O

Underwriting

Investment

e Reserving
r
o
c
-
n
o
N

(Re)Insurance 
counterparty

Liquidity

Intrinsic risks representing the potential to generate a return as well as a loss.

In these areas, the Group promotes informed risk-taking that considers the risk and return equation in all major 
decisions, with the intention of maximising risk-adjusted return on equity.

We recognise that by insuring fortuitous events we can suffer losses, and that within our investment portfolio we  
can see the value of investments fall. We cannot avoid these risks so we focus on the correlated operational risks and 
seek to mitigate them. For example, we know that by insuring the risk of earthquake we are exposed to the risk that 
losses exceed our plan. We model our portfolio using stochastic modeling to review actual and planned exposures  
to ensure they remain within tolerances. The correlated risks are that we might fail to design or maintain effective 
tolerances and limits, and fail to maintain exposures within such limits; or that we fail to keep accurate and timely 
records of our exposures. We then devise systems and processes to mitigate these risks, such as PML reconciliations, 
and RDS sign-offs, with review by the RRC and regular ORSA reports to the Board, which also considers and 
approves formal risk tolerances.

Intrinsic risks to which we are inevitably exposed as a result of conducting our day-to-day business operations yet offer 
no direct potential for return.

They are quantified insofar as practicable for the purposes of capital and risk management and avoided or 
minimised insofar as is economically justifiable.

Operational

These are risks arising as a result of inadequate or failed internal processes, personnel, systems or (non-insurance) 
external events.

r Strategic
e
h
t
O

Group

Emerging

They have the potential either to magnify the adverse impacts of intrinsic risks, for example increased reinsurer 
default losses arising through the use of non-approved counterparties; or to crystallise separately in their own  
right, for example losses arising through the imposition of fines as a result of a regulatory breach, so unrelated  
to our core functions.

These are risks for which quantitative assessment is difficult but for which a structured approach is still required to 
ensure that their potential impact is considered and mitigated insofar as is practicable. These are included within  
the risk register and are assessed and mitigated through scenario and stress testing.

www.lancashiregroup.com

33

StrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
Principal risks

Balancing our risks and opportunities

As described under our review of the Risk Universe, our classification of risks as Intrinsic Core and Intrinsic Non-core, Operational and Other 
helps us to focus on our management and mitigation of those risks. Further details concerning these risks can be found on pages 100 to 125. 
Within the capital models, insurance risk accounts for over 80 per cent of the allocated risk capital, so this is clearly the principal area where  
we stringently apply controls and reviews. For example, we place a large number of controls around monitoring risk levels across the business. 
However, we understand that even risks that do not generate a capital charge under an economic capital model can pose serious threats to  
the execution of the business plan and strategy, and therefore need to be monitored and tested. For example, we spend a lot of time looking 
at the implications of emerging capital and the evolution of the market cycle.

INTRINSIC RISK: CORE

TYPE
Underwriting: Losses in our classes are hard to predict in particular  
as to the specifics of timing and quantum of catastrophe loss events. 
Additionally, we write lines of business that are subject to accumulations, 
including accumulations of individual risk losses arising from a single 
event such as several property catastrophe excess of loss programmes 
being affected by a windstorm or earthquake, and accumulations 
between business lines such as a 9/11 type event impacting both the 
terrorism and AV52 portfolios. Losses can also exceed expectations in 
terms of both frequency and severity. So, although we model losses,  
for example using the RMS and AIR stochastic models, we know  
that these projections can and will be wrong in many instances.

Movement since 2016: Decreased due to reduced retentions and  
further contraction to core book reducing aggregate exposure.

Investment: We need to hold sufficient assets in readiness to pay claims, 
but the markets and products in which we invest can suffer volatility and 
losses. As a short-tail insurer, we are able to hold the majority of assets in 
low-duration securities such as fixed maturities. However, this creates an 
additional source of risk in the current environment, where there is a 
considerable risk from changes to interest rates as quantitative easing 
programmes may begin to taper or be increased. We model our 
investment portfolios and use various stress scenarios to see what  
kinds of losses we could expect under a range of outcomes.

Movement since 2016: No material change.

INTRINSIC RISK: NON-CORE

TYPE
Reserving: Because we do not know the amount of losses we are going  
to incur at the outset of a contract, we have to make estimates of the 
reserves we need to hold to pay claims. If these reserves are inadequate 
and claims exceed them, this may have an impact on earnings, or indeed 
capital. Independent external reviews of our reserves look at the overall 
levels of expected losses, as well as individual large events, including 
benchmarking analyses to provide assurance over the level of  
reserves booked.

Movement since 2016: No material change. Our processes and controls 
remain the same as in previous periods.

34

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

MITIGATION
Modeling: We apply loads to, and stress test, stochastic  
models and develop alternative views of losses using  
exposure damage ratios.

RRC: The RRC considers accumulations, clashes and 
parameterisation of losses and models.

Capital: We set our internal capital requirements at a level that 
allows for buffers above accumulations of extreme events and the 
Board approves risk tolerances at least annually and considers 
capital requirements on at least a quarterly basis.

Investment strategy: Our strategy is that investment income  
is not expected to be a significant driver of our returns. Our 
primary focus remains on underwriting as the engine of profits. 
Investment strategy, including investment risk tolerances, is 
approved annually and monitored on a quarterly basis by  
the Investment Committee and Board.

IRRC: The IRRC forms an integral part of our risk management 
framework, meeting at least quarterly and reporting to the RRC.

External advisers: Lancashire’s Board and management 
recognise that the Group’s principal expertise lies in 
underwriting so we use the services of internationally recognised 
investment managers who are experts in their fields.

MITIGATION
Short-tail business: Lancashire’s focus is on short-tail lines of 
business where losses are usually known within, or shortly after, 
the policy period with a reasonable degree of certainty.

Experience data: We have access to a lot of data, both our own and 
from the industry as a whole, about losses and loss trends. Actuarial 
and statistical data are used to set estimates of future losses, and 
these are reviewed by underwriters, claims staff and actuaries to 
ensure that they reflect the actual experience of the business.

External review: Insurers typically facilitate an independent, 
external review of their loss reserves. Lancashire retains the 
services of one of the leading industry experts, and our appetite is 
defined so as to set reserves within a range of reasonable estimates 
based on both internal and external review. The Audit Committee 
of the Board reviews reserve adequacy at its quarterly meetings.

 
 
INTRINSIC RISK: NON-CORE

TYPE
(Re)Insurance and intermediary counterparty: Almost all the insurance 
policies which we write are brought to us by brokers, who act as 
intermediaries between us and the client, and handle the transaction  
of payments of claims and premiums on our behalf. This exposes us  
to the risk of mishandling by, or failure of, the broker concerned. In 
order to make our portfolio as efficient as possible, we buy reinsurance  
to protect against severity, frequency and accumulation of losses. Again, 
this exposes us to the risk that our counterparties may have the inability 
or unwillingness to pay us in the event of a loss.

Movement since 2016: No material change.

Liquidity: In order to satisfy claims payments we need to ensure  
that sufficient assets are held in a readily realisable form. This includes 
holding cash accounts for the expected level of attritional losses, as  
well as ensuring that we can meet claims payment requirements in 
extreme events.

Movement since 2016: No material change.

OPERATIONAL

MITIGATION
Counterparty credit limits: The Broker Vetting Committee  
is responsible for the broker vetting approval process and 
monitoring credit risk in relation to brokers. In addition, the 
Group conducts broker business using non-risk transfer TOBAs. 
This mitigates the risk due to non-payment by brokers and 
intermediaries as monies are held in separated client accounts. 
We use counterparty credit limits, seek to deal with reputable 
reinsurers that meet our minimum rating standards, and use 
collateral agreements where appropriate. The operating entities 
of the Group that contract for reinsurance separately maintain 
and report their own counterparty credit limits at the entity level.  
The RSC is responsible for approving counterparties and 
monitoring aggregate limits. 

Portfolio management: The Group maintains liquidity in  
excess of the Board-agreed tolerances. This is achieved through 
the maintenance of a highly liquid portfolio with short duration 
and high creditworthiness. We monitor this through the use  
of stress tests and mitigate risks through the quality of the 
investments themselves.

TYPE
These are risks arising as a result of inadequate or failed internal 
processes, personnel, systems or (non-insurance) external events.  
They have the potential either to magnify the adverse impacts of intrinsic 
risks or crystallise separately in their own right. This can encompass IT 
availability, where the failure of an IT system, such as our underwriting 
system, could impact our ability to maintain accurate and up-to-date 
records of our exposures. If correlated with an insurance loss this could 
cause us to breach insurance risk tolerances. It could also encompass  
IT integrity, where an unauthorised intruder could alter data in our 
systems, or introduce a bug that would corrupt the system.

Movement since 2016: Increasing as we commence our project to 
develop our systems to enable us to further improve the functionality  
of Group IT Finance systems, to enhance management of financial 
reporting risk and to ensure compliance with IFRS 17 which comes  
into effect in 2021.

MITIGATION
Capacity: We mitigate IT availability risk by adding redundancy to 
the capacity we need and using backups of data including off-site 
storage that we test regularly.

Testing and access: We mitigate the integrity risk by using 
independent external penetration tests, and by restricting access 
to key systems to only those people who are qualified and need  
to use them.

Personnel: We mitigate the risks associated with staff retention 
and key-man risk through a combination of resource planning 
processes and controls. Examples include targeted retention 
packages, documented position descriptions and employment 
contracts, resource monitoring and the provision of appropriate 
compensation and training schemes. The Board regularly reviews 
succession planning arrangements and remuneration structures.

OTHER

TYPE
These are risks for which quantitative assessment is difficult but for  
which a structured approach is still required to ensure that their 
potential impact is considered and mitigated insofar as practicable.  
They include categories such as Strategic, Group and Emerging Risks.

Movement since 2016: On balance no material change. The impact  
of Brexit is not considered to be a significant risk to the Group given  
the Group’s current operations and trading profile. We will keep U.S.  
tax reform under review but do not at present consider that it will 
materially adversely impact the Group’s operations.

MITIGATION
Qualitative approach: These risks require a qualitative  
approach, engaging staff in appropriate discussions about 
sources of risk, and then thinking about possible outcomes.  
The Group Executive Management Committee and the RRC 
consider these issues, and the ORSA reports made by the Group 
CRO to the Board include standing items on Emerging Risk.

www.lancashiregroup.com

35

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
Corporate responsibility

Our responsibility to others 
and the environment

Why corporate responsibility is important to Lancashire
Corporate responsibility is an integral part of Lancashire’s approach to its business.  
We recognise the need to balance our commitment to our shareholders, employees 
and more immediate stakeholders with a responsibility to support the wider 
community and the environment, whether within our neighbouring areas or  
further afield. The work of The Lancashire Foundation is fundamental to the  
Group’s corporate responsibility programme.

Our approach
Lancashire tries to improve society and our 
environment using such tools as donations 
by the Foundation and the allocation of staff 
charity days to work on local improvement 
projects. We limit the negative impact of  
our carbon footprint through mitigation 
strategies and off setting. As well as the direct 
benefits, we believe that Lancashire reaps 
indirect benefits in terms of its attraction as 
an ethical and compassionate employer, and 
the positive and long-lasting team-building 
benefits of the activities undertaken. In terms 
of governance, the Board sets the policy for 
corporate donations to the Foundation and 
reviews reports on its activities. For more 

information about the day-to-day management 
of the Foundation and how it operates see 
pages 37 and 38. The Board also sets the 
policy for the operation of the HR function, 
and oversees the management of the 
environmental impact of the business.

Lancashire has a relatively low headcount 
(204 employees globally), all of whom are 
remunerated on a basis which comfortably 
exceeds UK minimum wage requirements.  
In particular, the Group’s UK operation is  
an accredited Living Wage employer by the 
Living Wage Foundation. In the ancillary 
services and limited supply chains used by 

the Group, Lancashire seeks to receive 
assurance that its service providers pay a 
living wage. Concerns over human rights 
issues with insureds and potential clients  
are addressed as part of the underwriting 
process. The Board has recently reviewed 
and modified the statement on slavery and 
human trafficking made on behalf of all 
companies within the Group and considers 
that it remains fit for purpose. This statement 
is published on the Company’s website. The 
Chairman’s statement on the Group’s 
diversity policy has also been debated by  
the Board during the year and is posted  
on the Company’s website.

We focus on the following four areas:

Community
$18.5m

donated by the Lancashire 
Foundation since inception

Environment
100%

of our 2017  
CO2 emissions offset

Marketplace
100%

of our permanent employees  
are eligible for RSS awards

Workplace
12

different nations represented  
by our employees

See page

37

See page

39

See page

39

See page

40

36

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The Lancashire Foundation

Committed to  
supporting communities

In 2017, 131 of our staff across the Group 
participated in charity volunteer days, 
mentoring opportunities or fundraising 
events. The Foundation also operates a 
charity matching scheme to support 
individual staff members’ charitable 
initiatives. During 2017 matched funds  
from the Foundation amounted to  
£16,785 and supported 12 charities.

This sounds simple, but how does  
it work in practice?
Let’s take grant-making first. As a charity 
closely linked to the Lancashire Group, we 
strive to ensure that the charities we support 
reflect the issues and concerns of our staff, 
whether from personal experience or 
through the demonstrably positive impact 
that they have on those in need. We 
underpin this with a set of objectives to 
inform our giving with a focus on charities 
operating in the fields of poverty relief, 
removing barriers to social exclusion, 
supporting medical research and 
humanitarian relief.

The majority of charities we supported in 
2017 were as a result of staff suggestions and 
support. In addition, the Foundation also 
supported charities suggested by clients and 
brokers which, for 2017, included Batten 
Disease Family Association, Skiing with 
Heroes, Edinburgh Global Partnerships, 
Starlight Foundation, The Brain Tumour 
Charity, World Vision – Hurricane Relief  
and Richard House Children’s Hospice.

Taking the second aspect of staff giving, we 
actively encourage support by staff. This takes 

a number of forms, for example: carrying out 
volunteering work that directly benefits the 
charity, like our annual volunteering trip to 
the Philippines to support the work of ICM 
with the ultra-poor; providing mentoring 
support to staff at St Giles Trust, many of 
whom are ex-offenders; or participating in 
fundraising events like marathons. During 
the year the Foundation carried out a 
number of presentations to remind staff  
what the Foundation aims to do and how 
they can support it.

How is the Foundation staffed to 
support this work?
We don’t employ staff; all the work is carried 
out on a voluntary basis by the existing staff 
of the Lancashire Group. As I mentioned 
earlier, a key aspect is ensuring that the 
Foundation reflects what engages our staff, 
so funding applications received from 
charities are analysed and challenged by the 
Foundation’s Donations Committee, which  
is comprised of staff from across the UK  
and Bermuda platforms.

The Trustees of the Foundation review the 
recommendations for funding received from 
the Donations Committee and release funds 
as appropriate. As Trustees we also set the 
strategic direction of the Foundation and 
ensure it is meeting all of its governance  
and compliance requirements.

We are lucky with the quality and 
commitment of the people involved in  
the Foundation. It does not seem right to 
highlight certain individuals involved in  
the Foundation’s work as all of them are 

www.lancashiregroup.com

37

Michael Connor
Chairman of the Trustees of  
The Lancashire Foundation

Can you explain what The Lancashire 
Foundation is and define its purpose?
The Foundation is a registered charity in 
England and Wales (number 1149184) and 
its purpose is to act as the focal point for  
the Lancashire Group’s corporate social 
responsibility activities.

These activities can be divided into two  
main streams: giving money in the form of 
grants to selected charities and, equally as 
important, encouraging our staff to give of 
themselves by supporting the Foundation’s 
work through volunteering. We do this by 
providing day release programmes for staff  
to give back to the communities in which 
they live and around the world. In addition, 
staff are entitled to up to a week’s annual 
charity leave on completion of three years’ 
permanent employment with the Group.

The Lancashire Foundation, our charitable grant-making body, is the cornerstone of our support. The channelling of the talents and energy of our staff in helping others in this way helps benefit and build Lancashire’s business and a positive culture.OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsCorporate responsibility continued

The Lancashire Foundation

Clockwise from left: Louise Wells, Chris 
Wilkinson, Louise Byrne, Derek Stapley  
and Robert Kennedy

committed and talented, however I am  
very grateful for the insight and support  
of my fellow trustees, Derek Stapley and 
Louise Wells, the Chair of our Donations 
Committee, Chris Wilkinson, Robert 
Kennedy, who lends his considerable 
financial skills to the Foundation’s budgeting 
and forecasting and Louise Byrne, whose 
organisational skills keep the whole show  
on the road!

However, it does not stop there. We have  
a wider pool of advocates to draw upon, 
namely staff members who act as the 
Foundation’s ‘eyes and ears’ in relation  
to specific charities. This really allows both 
the Donations Committee and the Trustees 
to obtain comfort that we have close liaison 
with our charity partners and that questions 
and issues can typically be resolved quickly.

“It was very pleasing  
that the Foundation  
was shortlisted for  
an award at the 2017 
Charity Times Awards  
in the Corporate 
Community Local 
Involvement category.”

We’ve not really talked about  
charities. Can you give me a  
flavour of who you support?
Of course. The Foundation looks to  
support charities around the world but  
with an emphasis on charities where we can 
see a demonstrable positive impact on the 
communities they serve and which operate  
in effective, transparent and sustainable ways 
to deliver the programmes they provide.

Through our flagship or cornerstone 
relationships we can see this: for example, 
the work of MSF really needs little introduction 
but they have an ability to react nimbly to 
multiple international humanitarian crises 
and to continue to shine a light on issues 
once the news cycle has moved on. More 
locally, the Family Centre in Bermuda 
provides early intervention services for 
children on the island suffering from 
family-based problems such as abuse and 
neglect, and St Giles Trust in the UK looks to 
break the bleak cycle of re-offending through 
a variety of means, one of which is its model 
of using ex-offenders trained to act as peer 
advisers to support those released from prison.

It was very pleasing that the Foundation was 
shortlisted for an award at the 2017 Charity 
Times Awards in the Corporate Community 
Local Involvement category, which is a 
tribute to our advocate for St Giles, John 
Cadman (the Group’s General Counsel), 
and a number of our staff who act as mentors 
and give up their spare time to support 
selected St Giles’ staff as they develop  
their careers.

What kind of relationships do you  
look to cultivate with the charities  
you support?
Put simply – open and transparent. The 
advocate system allows us to get close to  
our charities and foster the deep, multi-year 
relationships we hope to develop with most 
of the charities we support.

Annually, where we have multi-year 
relationships, the advocates are expected  
to review and reflect on the performance of 
the charity they advocate with the Donations 
Committee to ensure that the Committee  
is happy to recommend a renewal of the 
grant for the next year to the Trustees.  
Both quantitative and qualitative data  
will be reviewed as part of this process.

What is the relationship like between  
the Foundation and Lancashire  
Holdings Limited?
A very supportive one. The Foundation  
has been very lucky to receive an annual 
donation from LHL to support its activities 
and at the Foundation’s inception it was 
granted warrants which have been converted 
into shares. We currently hold 330,713 shares 
in LHL. In this way we have aligned the 
Foundation to the Group and can share in  
its success, and leverage that success to causes 
and communities that do not often receive 
such material rewards. Ideally through our 
work we can develop something approaching 
a virtuous circle as a grant maker, but this 
remains a work in progress.

38

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Our focus areas
Using an operational control approach, 
Lancashire assessed its boundaries to identify 
all the activities and facilities for which it is 
responsible and reported on all material 
Greenhouse Gas (GHG) emissions including 
Scope 1, 2 and 3. Calculations performed 
follow the ISO-14064-1:2006 standard and 
give absolute and intensity factors for the 
Group’s emissions.

Emissions from water (Scope 3) have also 
decreased by 72.2 per cent compared with 
2016. This was due to a water leakage at the 
Bermuda office during 2016, which was 
subsequently rectified in 2017.

Lancashire has purchased carbon credits to 
reduce its gross GHG emissions by 2,453.3 
tonnes, offsetting its total carbon emissions 
and remaining carbon neutral.

Environment
Despite a small increase in reporting scope, 
total emissions for 2017 have decreased  
by 4.3 per cent compared to 2016, with 
emissions per full-time employee (FTE) 
falling by 7.0 per cent.

With operations in London and Bermuda, 
and with clients and brokers around the 
globe, the Lancashire Group incurs the bulk 
of its carbon footprint as a result of airline 
travel, which is offset through an organised 
programme. The Group operates out of two 
offices; in London and Bermuda. The Group 
is also responsible for an apartment in 
Bermuda which is used for temporary  
visitor accommodation.

Our approach
The figures in this report are calculated over 
a 12-month period from 1 January 2017 to 31 
December 2017. Emissions are calculated by 
converting consumption data into tonnes of 
carbon equivalent (tCO2e) using the DEFRA 
2017 greenhouse gas reporting: conversion 
factors. Lancashire uses the number of FTE 
as its intensity metric, which this year shows a 
decrease of 7.0 per cent to 12.0 tCO2e per FTE, 
compared to 12.9 tCO2e per FTE in 2016.

Where data was not available for 2017, values 
have been extrapolated by using available 
data or calculated using industry benchmarks.

In 2017, the Group’s UK operations  
achieved BREEAM excellence for its London 
offices at 20 Fenchurch Street, which has 
supported an overall improvement in 
environmental performance.

Therefore, results show that GHG emissions 
in the year were 2,453.3 tCO2e, comprised  
of direct emissions (Scope 1) amounting  
to 70.9 tCO2e, and indirect emissions  
(Scope 2) amounting to 418.0 tCO2e. The 
source of other indirect emissions (Scope 3) 
comprised 1,964.4 tCO2e. Scope 1 emissions 
have decreased by 21.7 per cent. Scope 2 
emissions have decreased by 14.4 per cent 
compared with 2016 due to the decarbonisation 
of the UK power grid. Scope 3 emissions 
have also decreased compared with 2016 
due, in part, to a reduction in airline  
travel, most notably short haul flights.

Types of Emissions
Direct (Scope 1)

Indirect Energy (Scope 2)
Indirect Other (Scope 3) 

Gross Emissions (tCO2e)
Gross Emissions per FTE (tCO2e/FTE)
Carbon Credits
Total Net Emissions after offset (tCO2e)

Activity
Gas (measured in kWh)
Refrigerant (measured in kg)
Electricity (measured in kWh)
Business Travel  
(measured in miles and GBP)
Additional Upstream Activities1  
(measured in kWh, litres, miles  
and spend)
Water (measured in m3)
Waste (measured in kg)
Paper (measured in reams)
Hotels (measured in hotel nights)

2017 
tCO2e
70.9
0.0
418.0

2016 
tCO2e
90.5
0.0
488.5

1,619.5 1,624.3

299.7
7.2 
4.4 
6.9 
26.7 

308.7
 25.9 
 1.7 
 5.5 
 17.2 
2,453.3 2,562.3
12.9
2,563
0.0

12.0
2,454
0.0

(1) Additional Upstream Activities include Well-to-Tank and Transmission & Distribution emissions. These  

are emissions associated with the upstream processes of extracting, refining, and transporting raw fuel to  
our business.

The Group has chosen to offset its carbon 
emissions with Carbon Clear by buying 
credits in the Wind Power Generation 
Project in India. These offsetting  
proposals were discussed and agreed  
with the Group CEO.

Marketplace
We continue to help the development of our 
marketplace by making employees available to 
sit on market committees, boards and working 
groups. During 2017, our employees gave talks 
at industry conferences, investor days and 
symposia, and market education programmes. 
As noted on page 37, we also donate to many 
of the causes supported by our industry 
partners through the Foundation.

Our approach
We believe it is important to make our people 
available to the markets in which we operate, 
and we do this happily. We also engage actively 
with our regulators in Bermuda and London, 
and the Cathedral team is active within the 
Lloyd’s market. With our clients and their 
brokers, we are happy to welcome them to  
our offices, but we also travel to see them  
and their businesses all around the world.

Our focus areas
Clients: we strive to offer clear, fairly priced 
and useful products that meet their needs 
across our range of underwriting operations.

Brokers: we are fully committed to 
supporting a ‘broker market’ and prize  
our broker relationships very highly, right 
across the Group.

Investors: we continue to work hard at investor 
relations and have an active programme of 
engagement with investors around the globe.

Regulators: we recognise the need to engage 
closely with our regulators at the PRA, FCA, 
BMA and at Lloyd’s and seek to be transparent 
in all our dealings with them.

www.lancashiregroup.com

39

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate responsibility continued

Corporate responsibility in action

Relay for Life

For the past four years the Bermuda  
office has participated in the Relay for  
Life event put on by Bermuda Cancer  
and Health Centre. This event is part  
of the Global Relay for Life which  
is a 24-hour fundraiser that brings 
communities together in the fight against 
cancer. We walk to remember those  
we have lost, celebrate those who have 
survived, encourage those who are still 
fighting and give thanks to all caregivers. 
In 2017, Lancashire’s ‘Team Tango’ was 
made up of over 100 staff, family and 
friends. In 2017 our team raised over 
$25,000 and over the four years we have 
raised over $75,000. These funds have 
been used to bring radiation therapy to 
Bermuda so patients can be treated locally 
rather than having to travel overseas.

Workplace
We strive to attract and retain excellent 
employees who drive our appetite to 
outperform so as to ensure that the talents of 
our people and our unique culture continue 
to set us apart from our competitors. 
Matching the skills, aspirations and values  
of new recruits to both the role and the 
values of Lancashire remains a high  
priority for our business.

Our approach – promoting a positive  
and diverse culture
The Group promotes an inclusive 
environment that recognises and values 
diversity as key to enhancing individual 
development and maximising business 
effectiveness. As an equal opportunities 
employer, we will not tolerate discrimination 
of any kind in any aspect of employment, 
including in job advertisements, recruitment, 
training, promotion, compensation, benefits, 
advancement and career development.  
The Group is also committed to a working 
environment that is free from any form  
of bullying or harassment.

Our proactive measures to achieve a diverse, 
vibrant and positive business culture include 

our ‘Respect in the Workplace/
Communications Etiquette’ training  
sessions which are given to all new employees 
during their induction. The training sessions  
aim to highlight their responsibilities in 
preventing discrimination in the workplace 
and in fostering a positive and productive 
working environment.

Staff training and  
professional development
The Group encourages continuous  
personal and professional development  
for all of its employees, whether through 
individual external training, professional 
qualifications, performance coaching or 
‘lunch and learn’ sessions.

The Group values having a diverse workforce 
and bases all recruitment decisions on the 
ability of prospective employees to do the 
job, without consideration to race, age, 
gender, sexual orientation, disability,  
beliefs, background (except as may be 
pertinent to the requirements of a role,  
such as educational qualifications or prior 
employment experience) or nationality.

Individual training and personal 
development needs are discussed on a 
regular and ongoing basis by managers  
and their team members, including as part  
of the formal performance appraisal process.

Compulsory training is provided to new 
permanent staff and fixed-term contract staff 
in relation to a number of topics as follows:

The Group is currently represented by 
employees from 12 different nations.  
The gender split of males to females  
(see page 56) within the Group is  
60/40 per cent respectively.

Lancashire respects, supports and complies 
with all relevant local Bermudian and UK 
legal requirements, in particular with respect 
to rights of freedom of association, collective 
bargaining and working time regulations.

 • Tax/Regulatory Operating Guidelines;
 • Disclosure (including share dealing);
 • Inspections;
 • Financial Crime;
 • ERM; and
 • Respect in the Workplace/
Communications Etiquette.

Other training may be held on an ad hoc, 
one-off or refresher basis. The training is 
designed to ensure that all personnel who 

40

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Corporate responsibility in action

Project 
Transform

Every year since 2010, six to eight employees 
from across the Group volunteer to travel 
to the Philippines and work alongside ICM 
for a week providing aid and support to 
those living in ultra-poverty. The 2017 
Project Transform volunteers have 
reflected on their experience and 
summarised their thoughts:

“The members of the 2017 Project Transform 
team were very grateful to have been selected  
to travel to the Philippines and work with ICM.

We each applied to be part of the team due to 
the positive feedback shared by previous team 
members. The team were keen to help people 

less fortunate than ourselves, as well as better 
understand some of the challenges ICM is trying 
to overcome locally.

During the project week we had the opportunity 
to see how ICM are trying to reach and educate 
as many people as possible. Our work included 
building projects and delivering educational 
talks within various communities.
“Ultimately ICM  
gives people hope  
for the future.”

We loved spending time and interacting  
with the communities we visited and could see 
first-hand that lives have clearly been changed 
by the work of ICM. The week with ICM was a 
humbling experience which made us all see the 
world a little differently. Ultimately ICM gives 
people hope for the future.”

The Lancashire 2017 
Project Transform 
team – Steven 
Hartley, Shirley 
Donovan, Susan 
Blasetti, Mathew 
Churm, Samantha 
Cobb, Sean Pitcher, 
Louise Cowin and 
Harry London.

56

members of staff 
have volunteered to 
participate in ICM’s 
Project Transform  
in the Philippines 
since 2010. 

are employed by the Group are provided 
with the skills, knowledge and expertise 
appropriate to their responsibilities. 
Quarterly updates regarding attendance  
at these compulsory training sessions  
are provided to the Board for  
information purposes.

Employee turnover and third  
party contractors
Among the Group’s employees, the  
turnover for 2017 was 16.2 per cent  
(a decrease from 20.1 per cent in 2016),  
and as at 31 December 2017, 10.1 per cent  
of the workforce was composed of third party 
contractors, a decrease from 11.6 per cent  
in 2016. The rate of staff turnover and third 
party contractors was driven principally by 
changes in our Lloyd’s platform, where there 
continued to be a process of refreshment 
and renewal implemented during 2017.

Our focus areas
Our focus in 2017 has been to maintain the 
success of our employees through ongoing 
training and coaching, provided both 
internally and externally. During 2017 
approximately 67 per cent of our employees 
undertook formal training supported by  
the Group. We continue to measure our 
employees’ success through attainment  
of personal performance metrics as well  
as performance within the Group’s values 
framework. We can confirm that during  
2017 3.4 per cent of our employees were 
promoted within the Group, supported  
by the training and development 
opportunities provided. An area for 
continuing development during 2018 will  
be greater standardisation of the appraisal 
and training frameworks across the Group.

Internship programme –  
Corporate responsibility in action
Since 2014, the Group and the Foundation 
have jointly sponsored an internship 
programme for Bermuda resident college 
graduates. These graduates are afforded  
the opportunity to spend two years working 
and learning about insurance in the Group’s 
London office. The first two-year placement 
completed during 2016 and one of these 
graduates is now a permanent employee 
within Lancashire and the other has obtained 
a role at another market insurer in Bermuda. 
The Group has since welcomed two further 
graduates during 2016 and 2017, respectively.

www.lancashiregroup.com

41

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsChairman’s introduction

Responsive 
governance 

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chairman

In my opening statement I discussed the way 
in which our business and Board responded 
to the strategic challenges of 2017 as the year 
progressed. The following section focuses  
on the work carried out by the Board and its 
Committees in exercising effective oversight, 
taking decisions and providing responsive 
challenge and support to the business.

How does the Board structure and 
monitor the governance objectives  
for the business?
As a premium-listed company on the  
LSE, Lancashire measures its corporate 
governance compliance against the 
requirements of the UK Corporate 
Governance Code published by the UK FRC. 
The FCA requires each company with a 
premium listing to ‘comply or explain’ 
against the Code (i.e. to disclose how it has 
complied with Code provisions or, if the 
Code provisions have not been complied 
with, provide an explanation for the 
non-compliance). The Group monitors  
its compliance with the Code on at least  
a quarterly basis.

In this corporate governance section and 
throughout the Annual Report and Accounts 
for the 2017 financial year, areas of corporate 
governance compliance are explained by 
reference to the Code. The Company also 
monitors its compliance with applicable 
corporate governance requirements under 
both Bermuda law and regulations and, as  

an insurance operation subject to  
UK group supervision by the PRA, in 
accordance with the requirements of  
the UK’s Solvency II regime.

I am pleased to be able to report that  
the Board considers that the Company has 
complied with the principles and provisions 
as set out in the Code throughout the year 
ended 31 December 2017. The Board and 
business seek to ensure that the formal 
consideration of governance and regulatory 
requirements does not become a sterile 
exercise but is used to best advantage as  
a framework to inform the strategic and 
commercial matters which are so central  
to the nimble and responsive operation  
of the Group.

How does the Board have regard to the 
interests of Lancashire’s stakeholders in 
promoting the success of the business?
Over the last year or so the governance 
debate within the UK has concentrated 
strongly on the requirement for boards  
to focus on a broad group of stakeholders. 
Our Board has for many years taken what 
might be described as a holistic view to the 
operation of its business. Our strategic focus 
upon excellence in underwriting encompasses 
the importance which we attach to two of  
our most important stakeholder groups: our 
policyholders and our staff. It is paramount 
that the (re)insurance products we offer 
meet the needs of our clients and their 

42

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Responsive  governance requires  clear communication, constructive challenge  and debate and creative strategic thinking. A diverse range of perspectives and experience helps build a responsive culture, which serves and balances the expectations of a broad range of stakeholders.Our governance structure

Group Board

Lancashire Holdings Limited  
Board of Directors

Group 
Committees

Audit  
Committee 

p50

Nomination  
& Corporate 
Governance 
Committee
p55

Investment 
Committee 

Underwriting  
& Underwriting  
Risk Committee 

Remuneration 
Committee 

p57

p58

p59

Operational Boards

LUK Board

LICL Board

KCML Board

CUL Board

Lancashire Board and the subsidiary boards 
continues to operate effectively.

We have also gained useful insights and 
identified various areas for enhancements  
to the ways we operate and considered  
areas for training and learning during the 
coming year. I would like to thank all of  
our Directors, our management team and  
all employees for their hard work during  
the year. 

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chairman

brokers and that Lancashire is viewed as  
a trusted partner and provider of solutions. 
Similarly, we spend time as a Board carefully 
considering the staff resources across the 
Group and in particular the succession 
planning for Board and senior roles. Given 
our relatively small headcount each of our 
Directors has regular opportunities to meet 
employees at all levels across the business. 
In particular, we meet frequently with senior 
employees in both London and Bermuda  
as part of our quarterly activities.

All of our staff have the opportunity to  
meet our Directors both at the AGM and  
at semi-formal lunches for employees and 
Directors held periodically in both London 
and Bermuda.

I am personally involved in the programme 
of dialogue which Alex and our management 
team conducts with our regulators, in 
particular the PRA, Lloyd’s and the BMA, 
and those conversations are routinely 
reported back to our full Board. The business 
also prides itself on its engagement with the 
communities in which it operates, both 
through staff outreach programmes and 
through the operation of the Lancashire 
Foundation, which reports to the Board  
on its activities. Please see pages 36 to 41  
of this Annual Report and Accounts for 
further details.

We also pride ourselves on engaging 
regularly with our shareholder community, 
not only through the regular programme  
of meetings organised by our management 
team, but also through periodic initiatives to 
consult with our shareholders. In particular, 
Simon Fraser led a consultation with our 
principal shareholders on the remuneration 
policy and implementation issues in advance 
of the 2017 AGM. As a Board we also meet 
regularly with our corporate brokers to seek 
their feedback on investor priorities as well as 
Lancashire’s performance and perception 
amongst investors within the broader 
insurance sector.

Are the Board and its Committees 
operating effectively?
During 2017 our Board once again carried 
out a review of its effectiveness which I led, 
facilitated by our Company Secretary (see 
page 48 for further details). A summary 
report was discussed by the full Board and  
we concluded that the Board, its members 
and each of its Committees have a balance of 
experience and talents that serves the Group 
well and have the culture and competencies 
necessary to meet the strategic challenges  
of the business effectively as we enter 2018. 
I have made it my practice to meet regularly 
with the chairs of each of our principal 
subsidiary boards and our review concluded 
that the relationship between the main 

www.lancashiregroup.com

43

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
Board of Directors

A balanced Board

Alex Maloney
Chief Executive Officer
Alex Maloney joined Lancashire in 
December 2005 and was appointed 
Group Chief Executive Officer in 
April 2014. On joining, Mr Maloney  
was responsible for establishing and 
building the energy underwriting 
team and account and, in May 2009, 
was appointed Group Chief 
Underwriting Officer. Since 
November 2010 Mr Maloney has 
served as a member of the Board  
and was appointed Chief Executive 
Officer of Lancashire Insurance 
Company (UK) Limited in 2012.  
Mr Maloney also serves as a Director 
of Cathedral Underwriting Limited 
and has been closely involved in the 
development of the Group’s Lloyd’s 
strategy. Mr Maloney has over 20 
years’ underwriting experience and 
has also worked in the New York  
and Bermuda markets. 

Elaine Whelan
Chief Financial Officer
Elaine Whelan joined Lancashire  
in March 2006 and leads both the 
Group finance function and the 
Bermuda subsidiary, reporting to  
the Group Chief Executive Officer. 
Ms Whelan was previously Chief 
Accounting Officer of Zurich 
Insurance Company, Bermuda 
Branch. Prior to joining Zurich,  
Ms Whelan was an Audit Manager at 
PricewaterhouseCoopers, Bermuda, 
where she managed a portfolio of 
predominantly (re)insurance and 
captive insurance clients. Ms Whelan  
graduated from the University of 
Strathclyde in 1994 with a BA in 
Accounting and Economics and 
gained her Chartered Accountancy 
qualification from the Institute of 
Chartered Accountants of Scotland 
in 1997.

Michael Dawson
Non-Executive Director
Michael Dawson has more than 35 
years’ experience in the insurance 
industry, having started his career  
at Lloyd’s in 1979. He joined Cox 
Insurance in 1986 where he was the 
Chief Executive from 1995 to 2002. 
In 1991, Mr Dawson formed and 
became the underwriter of Cox’s  
and subsequently Chaucer’s specialist 
nuclear syndicate 1176. Between 
2005 and 2008 Mr Dawson was 
appointed Chief Executive of 
Goshawk Insurance Holdings PLC 
and its subsidiary Rosemont Re, a 
Bermuda reinsurer. Mr Dawson  
served on the Council of Lloyd’s 
from 1998 to 2001 and on the Lloyd’s 
Market Board from 1998 to 2002. He 
is a Non-Executive Director of Pool 
Re (Nuclear) Limited and Deputy 
Chairman of the management 
committee of Nuclear Risk  
Insurers Limited.

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chairman
Peter Clarke was Group Chief 
Executive of Man Group plc between 
April 2007 and February 2013. In 
1993 Mr Clarke joined Man Group 
plc, a leading global provider of 
alternative investment products and 
solutions as well as one of the world’s 
largest futures brokers. He was 
appointed to the board in 1997 and 
served in a variety of roles, including 
Head of Corporate Finance and 
Corporate Affairs and Group 
Company Secretary, before becoming 
the Group Finance Director in 2000. 
During this period he was responsible 
for investing in and developing one 
of the leading providers of third party 
capital insurance and reinsurance 
products. In November 2005, he was 
given the additional title of Group 
Deputy CEO. Mr Clarke is currently 
the Chairman of City Year and a 
Non-Executive Director of AXA 
Investment Managers S.A., RWC 
Partners Limited and Lombard 
Odier Asset Management. He is a 
member of the Treasury Committee 
of King’s College London. Mr Clarke 
previously served as the Chairman of 
the National Teaching Awards Trust. 
Mr Clarke took a first in Law at 
Queens’ College, Cambridge and is  
a qualified solicitor, having practised  
at Slaughter and May, and has 
experience in the investment 
banking industry, working at  
Morgan Grenfell and Citibank. 

44

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Simon Fraser
Senior Independent 
Non-Executive Director
Simon Fraser was Head of 
Corporate Broking at Merrill 
Lynch and subsequently 
Bank of America Merrill 
Lynch until his retirement  
in 2011. He began his career 
in the City in 1986 with BZW 
and joined Merrill Lynch in 
1997. He led initial public 
offerings, rights issues, 
placings, demergers and 
mergers and acquisitions 
transactions during his 
career and advised many UK 
companies on stock market 
and LSE issues. Mr Fraser  
has an MA degree in modern 
history from the University  
of St Andrews. He is also  
a Non-Executive Director  
of Legal and General 
Investment Management 
(Holdings) Limited and 
Senior Independent Director 
of Derwent London plc, 
where he sits on the 
Remuneration, Audit and 
Nominations Committees. 
Mr Fraser also serves  
as a Non-Executive  
Director of Cathedral 
Underwriting Limited.

Samantha 
Hoe-Richardson
Non-Executive Director
Samantha Hoe-Richardson 
since 2014 has been 
Chairman of the Audit 
Committee. She is also a 
Non-Executive Director  
of Unum Ltd and Unum 
European Holding Company 
Ltd. Unum is one of the 
UK’s leading employee 
benefits providers through 
the workplace. She also 
chairs their Audit 
Committees. Prior to  
this, she was Head of 
Environment & Sustainability 
for Network Rail and 
formerly Head of 
Environment for Anglo 
American plc, one of the 
world’s leading mining and 
natural resources companies. 
She was also a director and 
founder of Anglo American 
Zimele Green Fund (Pty) 
Ltd, which supports 
entrepreneurs in South 
Africa. Prior to her role  
with Anglo American,  
Ms Hoe-Richardson worked 
in investment banking and 
audit and she holds a masters 
degree in nuclear and 
electrical engineering from 
the University of Cambridge. 
She also has a Chartered 
Accountancy qualification. 
Ms Hoe-Richardson is also  
a Non-Executive Director 
of LUK.

Robert Lusardi
Non-Executive Director
Robert Lusardi is currently  
a private investor and has 
spent his career as a senior 
executive in the financial 
services industry. From  
1980 until 1998 he was  
an investment banker with 
Lehman Brothers, ultimately 
as Managing Director in 
charge of the insurance and 
asset management practices. 
From 1998 until 2005 he was 
a member of the Executive 
Management Board of XL 
Group plc, first as Group 
CFO then as CEO of one  
of their three operating/
reporting segments; from 
2005 until 2010 he was an 
EVP of White Mountains  
(an insurance merchant 
bank) and CEO of certain 
subsidiaries; and from 2010 
to 2015 he was CEO of 
PremieRe Holdings LLC  
(a private insurance entity).  
He has been a director of a 
number of insurance-related 
entities including Symetra 
Financial Corporation, 
Primus Guaranty Ltd., 
OneBeacon Insurance 
Group Ltd., Esurance  
Inc., Delos Inc. and FSA 
International Ltd. He is  
also on the board of Oxford 
University’s 501(c)3 
charitable organisation.  
He received his BA and  
MA degrees in Engineering 
and Economics from Oxford 
University and his MBA  
from Harvard University.

Tom Milligan
Non-Executive Director
Tom Milligan was Co-Chief 
Executive Officer of Ariel  
Re Holdings Ltd., until his 
retirement in 2015. He 
began his career in the City 
in 1991 with Guy Carpenter 
& Co. In 2005, Mr Milligan 
joined Goldman Sachs 
Group Inc. to start the  
GS Reinsurance Group’s 
non-life activities. Mr 
Milligan served as Chief 
Underwriting Officer of 
Arrow Capital Re and started 
Goldman Sachs-owned 
Lloyd’s Syndicate 1910  
in 2008, serving as Active 
Underwriter until 2012.  
In 2012, Mr Milligan led 
Goldman Sachs’ purchase  
of Ariel Re and served as 
Co-CEO from April 2012 
until July 2014. During 2013, 
Mr Milligan played a leading 
role in the spin-off of GS 
Reinsurance Group into 
Global Atlantic Financial 
Group (‘GAFG’), before 
managing the sale of the 
Ariel businesses from GAFG 
to BTG Pactual in 2014.  
He is also a Non-Executive 
Director of Managing 
Agency Partners Limited  
and Non-Executive 
Chairman of Beat Capital 
Partners Ltd. Mr Milligan 
graduated from Durham 
University in 1991.

Christopher Head
Company Secretary
Christopher Head joined 
Lancashire in September 
2010. He was appointed 
Company Secretary of 
Lancashire Holdings Limited 
in 2012 and advises on issues 
of corporate governance and 
generally on legal affairs for 
the Group. He also advises 
on the structuring of 
Lancashire’s third party 
capital underwriting 
initiatives which have 
included the Accordion  
and Kinesis facilities. Prior  
to joining Lancashire, he was 
in-house Counsel with the 
Imagine Insurance Group, 
advising specifically on the 
structuring of reinsurance 
transactions. He transferred 
to Max at Lloyd’s in 2008  
as Lloyd’s and London 
Counsel. Between 1998  
and 2006, Mr Head was  
Legal Counsel at KWELM 
Management Services 
Limited, where he managed 
an intensive programme  
of reinsurance arbitration 
and litigation for insolvent 
members of the HS Weavers 
underwriting pool. Mr Head 
is a UK solicitor having 
worked until 1998 at  
Barlow Lyde and Gilbert  
in the Reinsurance and 
International Risk Team.  
Mr Head has a history  
MA and legal qualification 
from Cambridge University.

www.lancashiregroup.com

45

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsOur Board’s year

Highlights of the Board’s year

February/Q1 meeting
 • The Board approved the appointment  

of Andrew McKee as a Director and CEO 
of CUL, subject to Lloyd’s and relevant 
regulatory approvals. The Board also 
approved the appointment of Nicholas 
Davenport as Chairman of the Board  
of Directors of CUL;

 • Following its quarterly review of capital 
management, the Board declared a  
final ordinary dividend of $0.10 per 
common share in respect of the year 
ended 31 December 2016;

 • The Board approved the Group’s 2017 
business plan that had been updated  
in light of the 1 January 2017 renewals  
and market conditions;

 • The Board approved updated UK and U.S. 
regulatory and tax operating guidelines for 
the Group;

 • The Board approved the core objectives  

of the Lancashire Foundation for adoption 
by the Trustees of the Foundation;

 • The Board approved the Group’s 2017 
framework for executive remuneration;

 • The Board approved the Directors’ 

Remuneration Policy and the Annual 
Report on Remuneration, as set out in  
the Directors’ Remuneration Report for 
the year ended 31 December 2016, for 
presentation to shareholders for approval 
at the 2017 AGM;

 • The Board approved the LHL 2017 RSS 
rules for presentation to shareholders  
for approval at the 2017 AGM; and
 • The Board approved the Annual  

Report and Accounts 2016.

March/Solvency II training
 • Solvency II training was provided to the 
Non-Executive Directors as part of the 
structured programme delivered  
between 2015 and 2017.

May/Q2 meeting
 • The Board approved the Group’s  
UK tax strategy for the year ended  
31 December 2017;

 • The Board approved the Solvency II 
submissions as at 31 December 2016  
for submission to the PRA;

 • The Board approved the appointment  
of Robert Lusardi as Chairman of the 
Investment Committee;

July/Q3 meeting
 • The Board approved the Group’s 

three-year strategic plan, including the 
Group’s risk appetite and capital and 
solvency appetite;

 • The Board approved the Group’s 2017 

reforecast business plan in light of actual 
experience to 30 June 2017 and market 
conditions and expectations following  
the 1 July 2017 renewals;

 • The Board received a presentation from 

 • The Board declared an interim  

the Group’s corporate brokers; and
 • The Company’s 2017 AGM was held  
at its Head Office on 3 May 2017. All 
resolutions were duly passed and  
approved by shareholders.

June/Board strategy session
The objective of the 2017 strategy session was 
to consider the key decisions to be made in 
the preparation of the Group’s three-year 
strategic plan. The agenda included:
 • review of the current strategy; 
consideration of its continued  
relevance and the views of shareholders;
 • review of the Group’s underwriting lines  
of business and potential opportunities;

 • presentations on the London and 

international specialty and reinsurance 
markets and alternative capital in the 
reinsurance market;

 • consideration of soft market challenges 

and potential hard market issues;
 • review of the business’s resourcing  

and training needs; and

 • discussion of the strategic themes  

and options for the business.

dividend of $0.05 per common share;

 • The Board approved the Group’s updated 

ERM strategic objectives and plan;
 • The Board approved amended and 
restated Terms of Reference of the  
Audit Committee;

 • The Board approved an updated division 
of responsibilities between the Chairman 
and the CEO together with an amended 
Schedule of Board Reserved Matters, 
which is published on the Group’s  
website; and

 • The Board received a presentation on  
the fixed maturity market from one  
of the Group’s investment managers.

October/Q3 loss events
 • The Board approved the publication  
of a press release in respect of the  
Group’s preliminary loss estimates  
from hurricanes Harvey, Irma and  
Maria and the Mexican earthquakes.

November/Q4 meeting
 • The Board approved the Group’s 2018 

business plan;

 • The Board discussed its policy on diversity;
 • The Board approved a Group Solvency II 
Identified Staff Remuneration policy; and
 • The annual performance evaluation of the 
Board and its Committees and individual 
Directors was commissioned, to be 
facilitated by the Company Secretary.

46

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Corporate governance report

Board Committees

Board and Committee administration
The Board of Directors is responsible for  
the leadership and control and the long-term 
success of Lancashire’s business. The Board 
has reserved a number of matters for its 
decision, including responsibility for setting 
the Group’s values and standards, and 
approval of the Group’s strategic aims  
and objectives. The Board has delegated 
certain matters to Committees of the Board, 
as described below. Copies of the Schedule  
of Board-Reserved Matters and Terms  
of Reference of the Board Committees  
are available on the Company’s website  
at www.lancashiregroup.com.

The Board has approved and adopted a 
formal division of responsibilities between 
the Chairman and the CEO. The Chairman 
is responsible for the leadership and 
management of the Board and for providing 
appropriate support and advice to the CEO. 
The CEO is responsible for the management 
of the Group’s business and for the 
development of the Group’s strategy  
and commercial objectives. The CEO is 
responsible, along with the executive team, 
for implementing the Board’s decisions.

The Board and its Committees meet on  
at least a quarterly basis. At the regular 
quarterly Board meetings, the Directors 
review all areas of the Group’s business  
and receive reports from management  
on underwriting, reserving, finance, 
investments, capital management, internal 
audit, risk, legal and regulatory developments, 
compliance and other matters affecting the 
Group. Management provides the Board 
with the information necessary for it to fulfil 
its responsibilities. In addition, presentations 
are made by external advisers such as the 
independent actuary, the investment 
managers, the external auditors, the 
remuneration consultants and the corporate 
brokers. The Board Committees are 
authorised to seek independent professional 
advice at the Company’s expense.

The Board also meets to discuss strategic 
planning matters outside the formal meeting 
schedule. A Board strategic planning session 
was held in June 2017.

The Chairman holds regular meetings  
with the Non-Executive Directors, without 
the Executive Directors present, to discuss a 
broad range of matters affecting the Group.

The Directors
Appointments to the Board are made  
on merit, against objective criteria and  
with due regard for the benefits of diversity 
on the Board, including gender. The Board 
considers all of the Non-Executive Directors 
to be independent within the meaning of  
the Code.

Michael Dawson, Simon Fraser, Samantha 
Hoe-Richardson, Robert Lusardi and  
Tom Milligan are independent, as each is 
independent in character and judgement 
and has no relationship or circumstance 
likely to affect his or her independence. 
Peter Clarke was independent upon his 
appointment as Chairman on 4 May 2016.  
At the Board meeting held on 14 February 
2018, further to a recommendation by the 
Nomination and Corporate Governance 
Committee, the Board affirmed its judgement 
that five of the eight members of the Board 
are independent Non-Executive Directors. 
Therefore, in the Board’s judgement, the 
Board composition complies with the Code 
requirement that at least half the Board, 
excluding the Chairman, should comprise 
Non-Executive Directors determined by  
the Board to be independent.

In accordance with the provisions of the 
Company’s Bye-laws and the Code, all the 
Directors are subject to re-election annually 
at each AGM.

www.lancashiregroup.com

47

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsCorporate governance report continued

Information and training
On appointment, the Directors receive 
written information regarding their 
responsibilities as Directors and information 
about the Group. An induction process is 
tailored for each new Director in the light  
of his or her existing skill set and knowledge 
of the Group, and includes meeting with 
senior management and visiting the Group’s 
operations. Information and advice regarding 
the Company’s official listing, legal and 
regulatory obligations and on the Group’s 
compliance with the requirements of the 
Code is also provided on a regular basis.  
An analysis of the Group’s compliance  
with the Code is collated and summarised  
in quarterly reports together with a more 
general summary of corporate governance 
developments, which are prepared by the 
Group’s legal and compliance department 
for consideration by the Nomination and 
Corporate Governance Committee. The 
Directors have access to the Company 
Secretary who is responsible for advising the 
Board on all legal and governance matters. 
The Directors also have access to the  
Group General Counsel and independent 
professional advice as required. Regular 
sessions are held between the Board and 
management as part of the Company’s 
quarterly Board meetings, during which 
in-depth presentations covering areas of  
the Group’s business are made. During  
these presentations the Directors have the 
opportunity to consider, challenge and help 
shape the Group’s commercial strategy.

Board performance evaluation
A formal performance evaluation of the 
Board, its Committees and individual 
Directors is undertaken on an annual  
basis and the process is initiated by the 
Nomination and Corporate Governance 
Committee. The aim of this work is to  
assess the effectiveness of the Board and  
its Committees in terms of performance  
and risk oversight, strategic development, 
composition, supporting processes and 
management of the Group. The evaluation  
is forward-looking in terms of identifying  
the strategic priorities as well as considering 
performance, training and development 
needs for the Directors within the context  
of the work of each Committee and that of 
the Board. The 2015 and 2016 performance 
evaluations were facilitated by Lintstock 
Limited, a London-based corporate advisory 
firm with no other connection to the Group, 

whilst the 2017 evaluation was conducted 
internally and facilitated by the Company 
Secretary and the Chairman.

The 2017 evaluation process involved each 
Director as well as the Company Secretary, 
the Group CRO, Group General Counsel 
and other members of senior management 
completing a questionnaire designed by the 
LHL Chairman and the Company Secretary 
with input from the Chairs of each of the 
relevant Committees. Responses to the 
completed questionnaires were collated  
by the Company Secretary, who prepared  
a suite of summary reports that were 
discussed in draft with the Board Chairman 
and Committee Chairs before being  
distributed to each of the Directors.

In February 2018, the performance evaluation 
reports were discussed at meetings of the 
Nomination and Corporate Governance 
Committee and the Board, and each  
of the other Committees discussed the  
report pertinent to its own operation and 
performance. The Board discussions were 
led by the Chairman and focused on such 
matters as strategic oversight, succession 
planning, Board composition and training 
and priorities for 2018.

In summary, in the Board’s consideration  
of the 2017 evaluation reports, the Board 
concluded that it operates effectively and  
has a good blend of insurance, financial  
and regulatory expertise. All Non-Executive 
Directors are committed to the continued 
success of the Group and to making the 
Board and its Committees work effectively. 
Attendance at Board meetings was found  
to be excellent. The CEO and the CFO,  
the Company’s Executive Directors, were  
also found to be operating effectively.

Appropriate infrastructure, processes and 
governance mechanisms are in place to 
support the effective performance of the 
Board and its Committees. The Board  
is considered to manage risk effectively.  
The number of Directors on the Board  
is considered to be appropriate.

It was noted in the evaluation process that,  
in what had been a year involving significant 
material losses, the Board and Committee 
oversight of underwriting strategy and risk 
tolerances had operated effectively and 
within expectations. Engagement between 

the Board and the wider body of staff  
is considered to be generally strong and 
beneficial to the operation of the business. 
Looking ahead, the Board and Committees 
will, during the course of 2018, seek to 
ensure that the Group holds sufficient  
capital and utilises capital tools to ensure  
that the business is well-placed to be a leading  
(re)insurance market participant in what 
may become a more dynamic underwriting 
environment than has been the case in 
recent years. In this regard the Board expects 
to monitor any changes to the rating agency 
and regulatory capital models. The Board 
also highlighted a number of themes which 
will inform the business of the Board during 
2018 including the attributes required in 
future non-executive appointments, the 
benefits of a broad diversity on our Board 
and in our business and the ongoing need to 
ensure a strong succession plan to meet the 
requirements of the business. A number of 
practical steps to optimise the focus of Board 
and Committee meetings were also identified 
for action.

The Board will continue to review  
its procedures, training requirements, 
effectiveness and development during 2018.

The Chairman’s performance appraisal  
was conducted by the Senior Independent 
Director, who consulted with the Non-
Executive Directors with input from the 
Executive Directors during November 2017. 
The discussion and feedback was positive 
regarding all aspects of the Chairman’s 
performance. Particular reference was made 
to the strong lines of communication which 
have been fostered with the Chairs of the 
subsidiary boards and his support of the 
senior executives. It was noted that the 
Chairman also attends (at the invitation of 
the relevant Committee Chairman) meetings 
of those Committees of which he is not an 
appointed member, thus tracking the detail 
of Committees’ decision-making, as well as 
providing strategic and high-level leadership 
to the Board.

Following the year end, the Chairman met 
with the CEO, and the CEO met with the 
CFO, to conduct a performance appraisal  
in respect of 2017 and to set targets for 2018. 
The results of these performance evaluations 
were discussed by the Chairman and the 
Non-Executive Directors and are reported  
in the Directors’ Remuneration Report 
commencing on page 60.

48

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Non-Executive Directors
Peter Clarke
Michael Dawson
Simon Fraser
Samantha Hoe-Richardson
Robert Lusardi
Tom Milligan
Executive Directors
Alex Maloney
Elaine Whelan

Original date of 
appointment to the Board

Board

Audit Committee

Investment 
Committee

Nomination  
and Corporate 
Governance 
Committee

Underwriting  
and Underwriting  
Risk Committee

Remuneration 
Committee

9 June 2014
3 November 2016
5 November 2013
20 February 2013
8 July 2016
3 February 2015

5 November 2010
1 January 2013

4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4

4/4
4/4

–
–
4/4
4/4
3/41
–

–
–

4/4
–
–
–
4/4
4/4

–
4/4

4/4
4/4
–
4/4
–
4/4

–
–

–
4/4
–
–
–
4/4

4/4
–

4/4
4/4
4/4
–
4/4
–

–
–

(1) Robert Lusardi is resident in the U.S. Due to unforeseen circumstances, he was unable to attend the meeting of the Audit Committee held in London on 21 July 2017. 

He was able to follow proceedings for information purposes via telephone conference. However, pursuant to the Group’s strict tax and regulatory operating guidelines, 
he did not participate in the meeting. 

Relations with shareholders
During 2017, the Group’s Head of Investor 
Relations, usually accompanied by one or  
more of the Group CEO, the Group CUO,  
the Group CFO, the Chairman or a senior 
member of the underwriting team, made 
presentations to major shareholders, analysts 
and the investor community. Formal reports  
of these meetings were provided to the Board 
on at least a quarterly basis. The Chairman of 
the Remuneration Committee conducted a 
consultation with the significant shareholders of 
the Group with regard to remuneration policy 
and practice in advance of the 2017 AGM.

Conference calls with shareholders and 
analysts hosted by senior management are 
held quarterly following the announcement 
of the Group’s quarterly financial results. 
The Group CEO, Group CUO and Group 
CFO are generally available to answer 
questions at these presentations.

Shareholders are invited to request meetings 
with the Chairman, the Senior Independent 
Director and/or the other Non-Executive 
Directors by contacting the Head of Investor 
Relations. All of the Directors are expected 
to be available to meet with shareholders at 
the Company’s 2018 AGM.

The Company commissions regular 
independent shareholder analysis reports 
together with independent research  
on feedback from shareholders and  
analysts following the Company’s results 
announcements. This research, together 
with the analysts’ notes, is made available 
to all Directors.

Enterprise Risk Management
The Board is responsible for setting the 
Group’s risk appetites, defining its risk 
tolerances, and setting and monitoring the 
Company’s risk management and internal 
control systems including compliance with 
risk tolerances. During 2017 the Board 
carried out a robust assessment of the 
principal risks affecting the Group’s business 
model, future performance, solvency and 
liquidity and the operation of internal 
control systems.

Further discussion of the risks affecting the 
Group and the policies in place to manage 
them can be found in the ERM section of 
this report on pages 31 to 35 and in the risk 
disclosures section on pages 100 to 125.

Each of the Committees is responsible  
for various elements of risk (see the various 
Committee reports from page 50 to page 59 
for further detail). The Group CRO reports 
directly to the Group and subsidiary Boards 
and facilitates and aids the identification, 
evaluation, quantification and control of 
risks at a Group and subsidiary level. The 
Group CRO provides regular reports to  
the Group and subsidiary boards covering, 
amongst other things, actual risk levels 
against tolerances, emerging risks, any 
lessons learned from risk events and 
assurance provided over key risks. During 
2017, the Directors participated in a number 
of training sessions addressing the Board’s 
obligations under Solvency II and, in 
particular, with regard to the review and 
approval of the Solvency II submissions as  
at 31 December 2016 for submission to the 

PRA. The Board considers that a supportive 
ERM culture, established at the Board and 
embedded throughout the business, is of key 
importance. The facilitating and embedding 
of ERM and helping the Group to improve 
its ERM practices are a major responsibility 
assigned to the Group CRO. The Group 
CRO’s remuneration is subject to annual 
review by the Remuneration Committee.  
The Board is satisfied that the Company’s 
risk management and internal control 
systems have operated effectively for  
the year under review.

Committees
The Board has established Audit, Investment, 
Nomination and Corporate Governance, 
Underwriting and Underwriting Risk and 
Remuneration Committees. Each of the 
Committees has written Terms of Reference, 
which are reviewed regularly and are available 
on the Company’s website. The Committees’ 
Terms of Reference were reviewed by the 
Board during 2017 and were considered  
to be in line with current best practice. The 
Committees are generally scheduled to meet 
quarterly, although additional meetings and 
information updates are arranged as business 
requirements dictate. Director attendance of 
the 2017 Board and Committee meetings is 
set out in the table appearing above. A report 
from each of the Committees is set out from 
page 50 to page 59.

www.lancashiregroup.com

49

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Committee reports

Audit Committee

Samantha Hoe-Richardson
Chairman of the Audit Committee

Committee membership
The Audit Committee comprises three 
independent Non-Executive Directors and  
is chaired by Samantha Hoe-Richardson, a 
qualified accountant. The Board considers 
that the three independent Non-Executive 
Directors all have recent and relevant 
financial experience. The Audit Committee 
as a whole has competence in the specialty 
insurance and reinsurance sectors. The 
internal and external auditors have the right 
of direct access to the Audit Committee. 
The Audit Committee’s detailed Terms  
of Reference are available on the  
Company’s website.

Samantha Hoe-Richardson 
(Chairman)
Simon Fraser
Robert Lusardi1

  Meetings attended

4/4
4/4
3/4

(1) Robert Lusardi is resident in the U.S. Due  

to unforeseen circumstances, he was unable  
to attend the meeting of the Audit Committee  
held in London on 21 July 2017. He was able  
to follow proceedings for information purposes  
via telephone conference. However, pursuant to 
the Group’s strict tax and regulatory operating 
guidelines, he did not participate in the meeting.

Principal responsibilities of  
the Committee
 • Financial reporting: monitors the integrity 
of the consolidated financial statements  
of the Group and any other formal 
statements relating to its financial 
performance, including the annual 
Solvency II Group reporting requirements. 
Reviews and reports to the Board on 
significant financial reporting issues and 
judgements that those statements contain. 
Reviews the Annual Report and Accounts 
and advises the Board on whether,  
taken as a whole, it is fair, balanced  
and understandable;

 • External audit: oversees the relationship 

with the external auditors and is 
responsible for the annual assessment  
of their independence and objectivity. 
Makes a recommendation to the Board,  
to be put to shareholders for approval  
at the AGM, for the appointment of  
the Company’s external auditors;
 • Internal audit: monitors and reviews  

the effectiveness of the Group’s internal 
audit function ensuring it has unrestricted 
scope, the necessary resources and access 
to information to enable it to fulfil its 
mandate and in accordance with 
appropriate professional standards; and
 • Internal controls and risk management 
systems: oversight of internal controls  
and risk management systems. Reviews  
the Group’s ‘whistleblowing’ and other 
systems and controls for the prevention  
of fraud, bribery and money laundering.

50

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

During 2017 the focus of the Committee  has been on the adequacy of the Group’s loss reserves, as well as the transition of external auditors and the continued integrity of external financial reporting.www.lancashiregroup.com

51

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities during 2017FINANCIAL REPORTING COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITYMonitors the integrity of the Group’s consolidated financial statements, including its annual and half-yearly reports, annual Solvency II Group Pillar 3 reports, interim management statements and any other formal statements relating to the Group’s financial performance. Reports to the Board on significant financial reporting issues and judgements contained in the consolidated financial statements. COMMITTEE ACTIVITIESAt each quarterly meeting the Committee reviews the Group’s quarterly consolidated financial statements for the purposes of recommending their  approval by the Board. The Group’s annual Solvency II Pillar 3 reports were reviewed at the first quarter Audit Committee meeting prior to recommendation  of their approval at the May Board meeting. The Committee also monitors the activities of the Company’s Disclosure Committee and reviews the Group’s quarterly financial press releases, which it recommends to the Board for approval. The Committee receives quarterly reports from management on: •developments in accounting and financial reporting requirements; •any new and/or significant accounting treatments/transactions in the quarter; •the activities of LHL’s subsidiary companies, including consideration of any risk issues; and •loss reserving (see page 140 for further details).An annual paper is presented by management to the Committee that details the areas of significant judgement and estimation in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements. (See accounting policies (page 94) for the details of these areas.) The Committee also receives quarterly reports on the consolidated financial statements from the external auditors, including an interim review report and a year-end full audit report. These are discussed with the external auditors at the Committee’s meetings. With respect to the areas of judgement and estimation in  the preparation of the consolidated financial statements, those that were considered by the Committee to be significant during 2017 were the estimation of ultimate loss reserves and the valuation of intangible assets. These are explained in detail on page 54. KPMG considered the valuation of intangible assets to be an elevated audit risk but not a significant audit risk. This was based on various factors, including the historic levels of headroom in the impairment testing and sensitivity analysis performed. In accordance with auditing guidance, KPMG’s year-end audit report identified revenue recognition through the estimation of premium revenues as  an area of significant risk. The Audit Committee considered this and concluded that, whilst some premiums are subject to estimation, revenues are unlikely to  be materially different from initial estimates, particularly on a consolidated  Group basis.Reviews the content of the Annual Report and Accounts and advises the Board on whether, taken as a whole, it is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position  and performance, business model and strategy. The Chairman of the Committee reviewed the early drafts of the 2017 Annual Report and Accounts in order to keep appraised of its key themes and messages. The Committee reviewed the final draft of the Annual Report and Accounts at  the February 2018 Audit Committee meeting together with the external auditors’ report. The Committee advised the Board that, in its view, the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides  the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and performance, business model and strategy.OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsCommittee reports continued

52

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

EXTERNAL AUDIT COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITYOversees the relationship with the Group’s  external auditors, approves their remuneration  and terms of engagement, and assesses annually their independence and objectivity taking into account relevant legal, regulatory and professional requirements and the Group’s relationship with  the external auditors as a whole. This includes an annual assessment of the qualifications, expertise and resources, and independence of the external auditors and the effectiveness of the external  audit process.COMMITTEE ACTIVITIESThe Committee approves the annual external audit plan and receives reports from the external auditors at each quarterly Committee meeting, including an ongoing assessment of the effective performance of the audit compared to the plan. The Committee Chairman conducts informal meetings with the external auditors  and the CFO prior to, during, and after the review of the quarterly results. The Committee meets quarterly in executive session with the external auditors to discuss any issues arising from the audit, and with management to obtain feedback on  the audit process. The Committee conducted an assessment of the qualifications, expertise and resources, and independence of KPMG prior to recommending  its appointment as external auditor in 2017. A further review was conducted in February 2018 and the Committee concluded that the external auditors are independent and objective. Due to the appointment of KPMG as new external auditors in 2017, the formal assessment of the effectiveness of the external audit process was minimal and focused on the effectiveness of the facilitation of the external audit process by Lancashire’s staff. It is proposed to undertake a thorough review of KPMG’s effectiveness through their first year of providing external audit services for the financial year ending 31 December 2017 during the first quarter  of 2018.The development and implementation of a formal policy on the provision of non-audit services by the external auditors, taking into consideration any threats to the independence and objectivity of  the external auditors.The Committee has approved and adopted a formal non-audit services policy that  is reviewed on an annual basis and was last updated in October 2017. The policy, which stipulates the approvals required for various types of non-audit services that may be provided by the external auditors, is on the Group’s website. During 2017, KPMG provided non-audit services in relation to specified work over the distributable reserves and pre-appointment procedures on the first quarter 2017 earnings release. Fees for non-audit services provided in 2017 totalled $20,000. The Committee gave careful consideration to the nature of the non-audit services provided and the level of fees charged, and has determined that they do not affect the independence and objectivity of KPMG as auditors.Makes a recommendation to the Board, to be put to shareholders for approval at the AGM, in relation to the appointment, re-appointment and removal of the Group’s external auditorsIt was disclosed in the 2016 Annual Report and Accounts that, following a competitive external audit tender process undertaken during the year, it was proposed to recommend the appointment of KPMG as external auditors by shareholders at the 2017 AGM. The recommendation was approved by shareholders and KPMG were appointed as external auditors with effect from the conclusion of the 2017 AGM. The lead audit partner is Rees Aronson. The Committee worked with KPMG during 2017 to achieve a smooth transition of external auditors and recommended to the Board the re-appointment of KPMG as external auditors  at the 2018 AGM.www.lancashiregroup.com

53

INTERNAL AUDIT COMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITYMonitors and reviews the effectiveness of the Group’s internal audit function in the overall context of the Group’s risk management system.COMMITTEE ACTIVITIESThe Group’s internal audit function reports directly to the Committee. Each year, the Head of Internal Audit presents an annual internal audit strategy and plan to the Committee for consideration and approval. In general, the most significant business risks and controls are usually considered for audit annually whilst less critical risks are audited periodically as part of a flexible multi-year programme.  The findings of each audit are reported to the Committee at the quarterly meetings and the Committee reviews the actions taken by management to implement the recommendations of internal audit. The Committee meets in executive session  with the Head of Internal Audit on at least an annual basis.During 2017, the Committee reviewed and approved an updated Internal Audit Charter. This can be viewed on the Group’s website. The Group CRO undertook an annual review of the implementation of the internal audit programme during 2017 to ensure its continued efficiency and appropriate standing within the Company and the effectiveness of the internal audit function. The Committee discussed the report and its findings with the Group CRO and the Head of Internal Audit and concluded that the internal audit function is operating effectively in the overall context of the Group’s risk management system.INTERNAL CONTROLS AND RISK MANAGEMENT SYSTEMSCOMMITTEE RESPONSIBILITYReviews the adequacy and effectiveness of the Group’s internal financial controls systems that identify, assess, manage and monitor financial risks, and other internal control and risk management systems; and reviews and approves the statements  to be included in the Annual Report and Accounts concerning internal control, risk management  and the viability statement.COMMITTEE ACTIVITIESThe Board has ultimate responsibility for ensuring the maintenance by the Group  of a robust framework of internal control and risk management systems, and has delegated the monitoring and review of these systems to the Committee. The system of internal controls is designed to manage rather than eliminate the risk of failure  to achieve business objectives, and can only provide reasonable and not absolute assurance against material misstatement or loss. The Committee receives from the Head of Internal Audit an annual assessment of the Group’s governance, risk and control framework together with an analysis of themes and trends from the internal audit work and their impact on the Group’s risk profile. In 2017, the Committee and Board were satisfied that the governance, risk and control framework  remains effective and appropriate for the Lancashire Group.Reviews for adequacy and security the Group’s compliance, ‘whistleblowing’ and fraud controls.During 2017, the Committee conducted an annual review of the Group’s policies and procedures relevant to financial controls and recommended the adoption  by the Board of updated policies and procedures in respect of anti-money laundering, bribery and financial crime (including fraud), conflicts of interest  and whistleblowing. There were no suspicious transaction or whistleblowing reports made during the year (whether arising from suspected money laundering activity  or knowledge of, suspicion or concern relating to suspected acts of bribery or any other type of financial crime, dishonesty or impropriety). The Committee also  keeps under review the adequacy and effectiveness of the Group’s legal and compliance function.OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsCommittee reports continued

Significant areas of  
judgement or estimation
Loss reserves and expenses
As detailed on pages 140 to 142 of the 
consolidated financial statements, the 
estimation of ultimate loss reserves is a 
complex actuarial process that incorporates  
a significant amount of judgement. The 
Committee considers the adequacy of  
the Group’s loss reserves at each Audit 
Committee meeting, for which purpose it 
receives quarterly reports from the Group’s 
Reserving Actuary. KPMG conduct a high- 
level review of the Group’s loss reserves as 
part of their first and third quarter review 
procedures. The external independent 
actuary and KPMG present a comparison  
of Lancashire’s booked reserves to their  
own best estimates at the second and  
fourth quarter Audit Committee meetings. 
Following the loss events in the third  
quarter of 2017, the Committee met with  
the Group’s Reserving Actuary and KPMG’s 
actuarial partner to review the adequacy  
of the Group’s loss reserves. Management 
provided the Board with an analysis detailing 
how the loss ranges for each event were 
determined, and how they were challenged 
and supported. During 2017, the Committee 
focused its discussions around the Group’s 
loss reserves on: the range of reasonable 
actuarial estimates and the divergence  
of the Group’s estimates to the external 
actuarial estimates; current and prior year 
loss development including ‘back-testing’  
of the Group’s prior year reserves; and 
reserving for each insurance operating 
subsidiary. Having reviewed and challenged 
these areas, the Committee concurred with 
management’s valuation of the Group’s loss 
reserves and the relevant disclosures around 
loss reserving in the Group’s consolidated 
financial statements.

Intangible asset valuation
The Group has two indefinite life intangible 
assets following the acquisition of Cathedral 
– goodwill and syndicate participation rights. 
Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives 
are subject to an impairment review at least 
annually, or sooner if there is an indication 
of impairment. Some of the key inputs  
in the impairment review are based on 
management judgement and/or estimation 
(see page 95 of the consolidated financial 
statements for further details). These inputs 
are reviewed by the Audit Committee 
annually and are considered reasonable.  
The Audit Committee also considers the 
Group’s internal stress tests and what stress 
scenarios would have to occur to indicate an 
impairment of its intangible assets. As a result 
of these considerations the Audit Committee 
agreed with management and KPMG that 
there was no impairment of the Group’s 
intangible assets.

Priorities for 2018
The Committee’s key priorities for 2018 are:

 • To ensure the continued effectiveness  
of the Group’s controls environment,  
the operation of the business’s financial 
reporting systems and the integrity  
of external financial reporting.

 • To continue to monitor the preparation  
by the Group for the implementation  
of IFRS 17.

IFRS 17, Insurance Contracts
During 2017 the International Accounting 
Standards Board issued IFRS 17, which will 
be mandatorily effective for annual reporting 
periods beginning on or after 1 January 
2021. Management is in the pre-planning 
stage for this project and during 2017 it 
engaged Ernst & Young LLP to assist in  
the preparation of an initial operational 
impact assessment. KPMG provided the 
Audit Committee with preliminary training 
on IFRS 17 in the fourth quarter of 2017. 
During 2018 the Committee will continue  
to monitor the preparation by the Group  
for the implementation of IFRS 17.

54

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Nomination and Corporate 
Governance Committee

Peter Clarke
Chairman of the Nomination and  
Corporate Governance Committee 

Committee membership
A majority of the members of the 
Nomination and Corporate Governance 
Committee are independent Non-Executive 
Directors. The Committee Chairman is Peter 
Clarke, who is the Chairman of the Board.

Peter Clarke (Chairman)
Michael Dawson
Samantha Hoe-Richardson
Tom Milligan

Meetings attended
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4

Principal responsibilities of  
the Committee
 • Reviews the structure, size and 

composition (including the skills, 
knowledge, independence, experience 
and diversity) of the Board;

 • Considers succession planning for 

Directors and other senior executives;

 • Nominates candidates to fill  

Board vacancies;

 • Makes recommendations to the  

Board concerning Non-Executive  
Director independence, membership  
of Committees, suitable candidates for  
the role of Senior Independent Director, 
and the re-election of Directors  
by shareholders;

 • Reviews the Company’s corporate 
governance arrangements and  
compliance with the Code; and
 • Makes recommendations to the  

Board concerning the charitable and 
corporate social responsibility activities  
of the Company and donations to  
the Lancashire Foundation.

How the Committee discharged  
its responsibilities during 2017
Board composition
The Committee reviewed the composition  
of the Board to ensure that the balance of 
skills, knowledge, independence, experience 
and diversity continue to be appropriate for 
the Group’s business to meet its strategic 
objectives. The Committee also considered 
whether any additional skills and experience 
were needed to complement those already 
on the Board.

In this regard, the Committee engaged 
external executive search firms, which  
have no other connection to the Group. 
They identified a number of potential 
candidates, although no additional 
appointments were made to the Board 
during the year. In accordance with  
the provisions of the Code, all of the 
Directors are subject to annual election  
by shareholders. All of the Directors were 
re-elected by shareholders at the 2017 AGM.

The Committee recommended to the  
Board the appointment of Robert Lusardi  
as Chairman of the Investment Committee 
during the year.

Succession planning
The Committee reviewed the Company’s 
succession plan for Executive Directors and 
other senior executives, taking into account 
the Company’s risk environment and 
strategic objectives, as well as the anticipated 
demands and requirements of the business. 
One notable development to the succession 
plan was the introduction of a risk-weighted 
traffic light system to provide a ‘dashboard’ 
indication of areas in which succession risk  
is considered to be lower or more elevated. 
The Committee has continued to focus in its 
dialogue with management on the delivery of 
training and support and the development  
of talent across the Group. In 2017, there 
were further positive developments in the 
management of the Cathedral operations  
as well as a number of planned promotions 
within the underwriting teams.

www.lancashiregroup.com

55

During 2018, the Committee will continue to monitor governance developments, in particular the anticipated changes to the UK Corporate Governance Code, to ensure that the Group maintains its flexible and proactive culture to  best serve the strategic needs of our business.OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsCommittee reports continued

Subsidiary boards
The Committee monitored the composition 
of subsidiary boards during 2017 and 
recommended appointments to the boards 
of LICL, KCML and CUL. The Committee 
also recommended the appointment of 
Nicholas Davenport as Chairman of the 
Board of CUL in succession to Tony Minns.

Corporate governance
The Committee keeps under review  
the Company’s corporate governance, 
particularly compliance with the Code, and  
is responsible for making recommendations 
to the Board concerning the process for 
conducting and facilitating the annual 
performance evaluation of the Board, its 
Committees and the individual Directors 
– see page 48.

During 2017, the Committee recommended 
the approval and adoption by the Board of 
an amended Schedule of Reserved Matters, 
and an amended and restated Terms of 
Reference of the Audit Committee. Copies  
of these documents are available on the 
Company’s website.

The Committee also recommended  
the approval by the Board of an updated 
protocol for the division of responsibilities 
and roles of the Chairman and Group CEO 
and the responsibilities and reporting lines 
of the CEOs of Group subsidiaries.

The Committee considered statistics  
relevant to the gender composition of  
the Board, Group management excluding 
LHL Non-Executive Directors, and overall 
Group employees. These statistics are shown 
opposite. The Committee also reviewed 
comparative pay data by gender within  
the Lancashire Group. The Committee 
recommended approval by the Board of an 
updated diversity policy, which is posted on 
the Company’s website. The Board remains 
of the view that the skills and experience 
needed to take the business of the Company 
forward are of paramount importance in 
selecting Board members, members of 
executive committees and senior management 
or, indeed, any role within the business. The 
Committee and Board recognise that there  
is increasingly an expectation within society, 
in particular as a result of the work of the 
Hampton-Alexander Review, that businesses 
should adopt a fixed percentage target for 

gender diversity. Accordingly the Board  
has modified its previously stated position  
so as to adopt a goal for the representation  
of women on the Board of LHL and the 
principal management executive committee 
of 33 per cent by 2020. The Board does not 
view the new goal as a ‘black line’ but rather 
a flexible target against which the business 
should measure its performance and strategy. 
Identifying ‘the best person for the job’ 
remains paramount in identifying the  
right candidate. Lancashire’s approach to 
recruitment and in particular ensuring the 
benefits of a broad diversity throughout the 
business is discussed further on page 40 in 
the discussion of the workplace culture.

The Committee also recommended the 
approval by the Board of an updated Slavery 
and Human Trafficking statement, a copy of 
which is posted on the Company’s website.

The Lancashire Foundation
The Committee is responsible for 
monitoring and making recommendations 
to the Board in relation to the Company’s 
charitable giving policy and the operation  
of, and reporting requirements for, the 
Lancashire Foundation. During 2017,  
the Committee received a report on  
the Foundation, including its objectives, 
governance, investment strategy, donations 
policy and charitable activities, and considered 
the ways in which the Foundation engages 
with employees throughout the Group. The 
Committee made a recommendation to the 
Board that during 2018, due to the Group’s 
financial performance in what was a year 
impacted by significant catastrophe losses, 
there should not be a donation from the 
Group to the Foundation. It was, however, 
noted by the Committee and the Board  
that the Foundation had sufficient assets  
to implement its plans and to meeting its 
spending commitments over the next  
three years.

Priorities for 2018
The Committee’s key priorities for 2018 are:

 • To continue to develop the succession 

plans for Directors and senior executives, 
in line with the Group’s strategic objectives, 
and to support management in the 
development of the talent pipeline;
 • To review the outcome of the 2017 
performance evaluation process as  
it relates to the Committee and the 
composition of the Board, and to agree 
and monitor any required actions; and

 • To continue the Committee’s focus  

on corporate governance requirements, 
regulatory developments and compliance 
with the Code, specifically in light of the 
anticipated changes to the Code which 
have been tabled for industry consultation 
during 2018.

LHL Board members

Male: 6 (75%)
Female: 2 (25%)
Total: 8

Group management excluding LHL 
Non-Executive Directors

Overall Group employees

Male: 14 (73.7%)
Female: 5 (26.3%)
Total: 19

Male: 123 (60%)
Female: 81 (40%)
Total: 204

56

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Investment Committee

Robert Lusardi
Chairman of  
the Investment Committee

Committee membership
The Investment Committee comprises  
two independent Non-Executive Directors, 
the Chairman of the Board, one Executive 
Director (the CFO) and the Chief 
Investment Officer (who is not a Director).

Robert Lusardi (Chairman)1
Peter Clarke1
Tom Milligan
Elaine Whelan 
Denise O’Donoghue 

  Meetings attended
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4

(1) Peter Clarke stepped down as Chairman of  
the Investment Committee with effect from  
3 May 2017 and was succeeded by Robert Lusardi.

Principal responsibilities of  
the Committee
 • Recommends investment strategies, 
guidelines and policies to the Board  
of the Company and other members  
of the Group to approve annually;

 • Recommends and sets risk asset  

definitions and risk tolerance levels;

 • Recommends to the relevant boards the 
appointment of investment managers  
to manage the Group’s investments;

 • Monitors the performance of investment 
strategies within the risk framework; and
 • Establishes and monitors compliance with 
investment operating guidelines relating 
to the custody of investments and the 
related internal controls.

How the Committee discharged  
its responsibilities during 2017
The Committee regularly discussed and  
kept under review macro-economic, capital 
markets and global political developments 
during the year, in particular fiscal and 
political developments in the U.S. and  
the ongoing impact of the UK’s Brexit 
negotiations on investment strategy  
and performance. The Committee  
also considered regular reports on the 
performance of the Group’s investment 
portfolios, including asset allocation and 
compliance with pre-defined guidelines and 
tolerances; and recommended amendments 
to portfolio investment guidelines to the 
boards of LHL, LICL, LUK and CUL.

The Committee focused in its discussions  
on the investment strategy priorities of 
preserving capital, ensuring the appropriate 
balance of risk assets and affording sufficient 
liquidity in the investment portfolio. These 
questions of investment strategy were all 
framed within the context of the Board’s 
objective of ensuring appropriate 
connectivity with, and support for,  
the Group’s underwriting operations.

The Committee also recommended to the 
Board and the boards of certain subsidiaries 
the appointment of a new investment 
manager to manage cash and cash 
equivalents on a Group platform.

The Committee received presentations from 
two of the portfolio investment managers 
during the year. During the fourth quarter of 
2017, the Committee considered the impact 
on the portfolio of the payment of claims 
arising from the large loss events of late 2017, 
noting in particular that, in what had been  
a significant year for catastrophe losses, the 
portfolio had performed well in meeting  
the liquidity requirements of the business.

Priorities for 2018
The Committee’s key priorities for 2018 are:

 • To maintain a continued focus on the 

preservation of capital, the maintenance  
of liquidity and the management of 
interest rate and other emerging 
investment risks; and

 • A review of the asset allocation strategy 
taking into account a rising interest rate 
environment, market valuations, expected 
returns, and the current state of insurance 
underwriting markets.

www.lancashiregroup.com

57

Our investment philosophy is to preserve capital and  to ensure liquidity in our investments while ensuring appropriate connectivity with, and support for, the Group’s underwriting operations. The Group’s strategy has been to remain relatively short in duration over the course of 2017 and into 2018 in anticipation of rising interest rates.OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsCommittee reports continued

Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee

Alex Maloney
Chairman of the Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk Committee

Committee membership
During 2017, the Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk Committee comprised 
one Executive Director (the Group CEO) 
and two Non-Executive Directors together 
with the Group CUO, the CUO of LICL, the 
CUO and Reinsurance Manager of LUK, the 
Active Underwriters for Syndicates 2010 and 
3010, and the Deputy Group Chief Actuary 
(who are not Directors).

Alex Maloney (Chairman)
Jon Barnes1
Michael Dawson
Paul Gregory
Hayley Johnston
Tom Milligan
Sylvain Perrier
Ben Readdy
John Spence2
Richard Williams3

  Meetings attended
4/4
3/3
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4
3/4
0/1

(1) Jon Barnes was appointed as a member of  

the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk 
Committee with effect from 15 February 2017.
(2) John Spence was unable to attend the 25 July 2017 
meeting of the Underwriting and Underwriting 
Risk Committee.

(3) Richard Williams retired as a member of  
the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk 
Committee with effect from 15 February 2017.

Principal responsibilities of  
the Committee
 • Reviews Group underwriting strategy;
 • Oversees the development of, and 

adherence to, underwriting guidelines  
by operating company CUOs;

 • Reviews underwriting performance;
 • Reviews significant changes in 
underwriting rules and policies;

 • Establishes, reviews and maintains strict 
underwriting criteria and limits; and

 • Monitors underwriting risk and its 
consistency with the Group’s risk  
profile and risk appetite.

How the Committee discharged  
its responsibilities during 2017
The Committee is actively engaged in the 
development of strategy and the formal 
underwriting risk tolerances, which are 
reviewed by the Committee and approved  
by the Board. Underwriting risk is the key 
risk faced by the Group. Specifically, the 
Committee receives quarterly risk data 
tracking movements in the Group’s 
exposures to modeled PMLs and RDSs.

The Committee also monitors underwriting 
performance on a quarterly basis. Good risk 
selection remains at the heart of the Group’s 
strategy, in particular in the recent soft phase 
of the market cycle. The Committee also 
reviewed management reports on the 
structuring and pricing of the outwards 
reinsurance protections purchased across  
the Group. The Committee received 
quarterly update reports from the Active 
Underwriters of Syndicates 2010 and 3010, 
the Chief Underwriting Officers for LUK and 
LICL and the CEO of KCML during 2017. 

The Committee also received quarterly 
reports of significant claims and related 
developments.

The Committee enhanced the reporting  
of new business options developed or 
considered by management during the 
course of 2017, which afforded scope for 
fruitful debate on risk and opportunities.

During 2017, the Committee meetings  
were open to attendance by all of the Board 
members and provided a useful forum for 
the discussion of underwriting performance, 
risk tolerances and strategic initiatives.  
The Committee and Board place great 
importance on the management of the 
Company’s capital so as to match capital  
to the underwriting requirements of the 
business in all parts of the underwriting cycle.

A more detailed analysis of the Group’s 
underwriting performance appears in the 
Business Review section of this Annual 
Report and Accounts on pages 24 to 30.

Priorities for 2018
The Committee’s key priorities for 2018 are:

 • To continue to monitor the development 

of a forward-looking and disciplined 
underwriting strategy appropriate for  
the Group’s underwriting platforms, 
within a framework of appropriate  
risk tolerances; and

 • To work actively with management in the 
identification, analysis and consideration 
of such new underwriters and/or lines of 
business as may complement or enhance 
existing underwriting strategy.

58

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The Committee provides a forum for discussing the trends in the pricing and coverage terms for the market sectors in which we operate. The losses to the market in 2017 have demonstrated the value of the work which  our underwriters, management and the Committee perform in managing our risk exposures through the insurance cycle.Remuneration Committee

Simon Fraser
Chairman of  
the Remuneration Committee

Committee membership
The Remuneration Committee comprises 
three independent Non-Executive Directors 
and the Chairman of the Board.

Simon Fraser (Chairman)
Peter Clarke
Michael Dawson
Robert Lusardi

  Meetings attended
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4

Principal responsibilities of  
the Committee
 • Sets the remuneration policy for,  

and determines the total individual 
remuneration packages, including  
pension arrangements of, the Company’s 
Chairman, the Executive Directors, 
Company Secretary and other designated 
senior executives, to deliver long-term 
benefits to the Group;

 • Agrees personal objectives for each 
Executive Director and the related 
performance and pay-out metrics  
for the performance element of the  
annual bonus;

 • Determines each year whether awards will 
be made under the Group’s RSS and, if so, 
the overall amount of such awards, the 
individual awards to Executive Directors 
and other designated senior executives, 
and the performance targets to be used;

 • Ensures that contractual terms  

on termination or retirement, and  
any payments made, are fair to the  
individual and the Company; and

 • Oversees any major changes in employee 
benefit structures throughout the Group.

How the Committee discharged  
its responsibilities during 2017
During 2017, the Committee reviewed the 
Group incentive packages to ensure that 
remuneration is structured appropriately  
to promote the long-term success of the 
Company. The Committee also reviewed  
the RSS structure for Executive Directors  
to ensure that the performance metrics 
continue to align the interests of the 
Company with its investors and management. 
The Committee considered the salary  
and bonus awards for 2017 for Executive 
Directors and other designated senior 
executives. The Committee also approved the 
grant of awards under the Company’s RSS.

The Committee reviewed Executive 
Directors’ shareholdings in the context of 
the Company’s share ownership guidelines 
for senior/key executives and discussed 
revisions to the guidelines to reflect more 
recent changes to the composition of the 
senior management team.

The Committee also reviewed the policy for 
Executive Directors’ remuneration, which 
has a three-year life following its approval  
by shareholders at the 2017 AGM. The 
Committee considers the policy fit for 
purpose and does not propose any 
amendments at the 2018 AGM.

During 2017, the Committee recommended 
the approval and adoption by the Board  
of a Group Solvency II Identified Staff 
Remuneration policy. The Committee  
noted progress made during the year  

on the alignment of remuneration practices 
across the Group and that further such 
alignment measures will be implemented  
by the management team during 2018.

The Committee also recommended changes 
to the companies comprising the Company’s 
peer group for comparator purposes in light 
of recent M&A activity.

The Committee considered a number of 
proposals relating to the treatment of RSS 
awards held by departing employees.

The Directors’ Remuneration Policy and the 
Annual Report on Remuneration, for which 
the Committee is responsible, can be found 
on pages 60 to 79. The report contains a 
summary of the debate which has been had 
within the Committee and the Board on  
the alignment of remuneration and Group 
performance both in the current year  
and over a longer time frame.

Priorities for 2018
The Committee’s key priorities for 2018 are:

 • To review the ongoing appropriateness 

and relevance of the Group’s remuneration 
structures, ensuring that they are in line 
with the Group’s business strategy, risk 
profile, objectives, risk management 
practices and long-term interests; and

 • To review arrangements for remuneration 

across the wider Group with a view to 
further aligning the processes for 
appraisal, objective setting and 
remuneration across the Lloyd’s  
and non-Lloyd’s platforms.

www.lancashiregroup.com

59

The Committee seeks to implement a Remuneration Policy which ensures the retention of our most valued staff whilst affording linkage between remuneration  and appropriate targets for company and personal performance. We seek to achieve a balance that avoids the incentivisation of excessive risk-taking or a culture  of short-termism.OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsDirectors’ Remuneration Report 

Annual statement 
Dear Shareholder, 

I am pleased to present the 2017 Directors’ Remuneration Report  
to shareholders.  

Shareholder decisions at the 2017 AGM 
Lancashire’s Directors’ Remuneration Policy was approved by 
shareholders at the May 2017 AGM. There were minor (largely 
housekeeping) changes to the Policy, which had previously been 
approved by shareholders in 2014. Shareholders also approved a  
set of revised rules for Lancashire’s long-term incentive RSS. The 
replacement 2017 RSS rules have substantially the same terms as the 
previous scheme, but incorporated some minor changes to bring the 
new rules more in line with current best practice. The new 2017 RSS 
rules took effect from the 2017 AGM.  

Remuneration and strategy 
The Group’s goal continues to be to reward its employees fairly  
and responsibly by providing an appropriate balance between fixed 
remuneration and variable remuneration linked to the achievement 
of suitably challenging Group and individual performance measures.  

There is a strong link between the Remuneration Policy and the 
business strategy. As highlighted elsewhere in this Annual Report  
and Accounts, our strategy focuses on the effective operation of the 
business necessary to maximise long-term RoE and the delivery of 
superior total shareholder returns on a risk-adjusted basis over the 
course of the insurance cycle. Our Remuneration Policy and the  
way it is implemented are closely aligned to this strategy. 

As I reported in the 2016 Annual Report and Accounts, the Board 
and management believe that the insurance industry is cyclical in its 
fundamental characteristics. At the low point in the insurance cycle, 
which we witnessed throughout 2016 and the first half of 2017, the 
Board has sought to prioritise achieving acceptable, but more modest, 
returns whilst moderating overall risk levels through underwriting 
discipline and prudent reinsurance planning. Of equal importance 
has been the need to ensure that throughout the softer part of the 
market cycle the business has continued to service the needs of its 
core clients and brokers. The Board has prioritised the need to 
ensure the continuing relevance of the business to its clients, 
shareholders and other stakeholders, and to position the  
business well for the time when market conditions turn.  

Performance outcomes for 2017 – A challenging year 
On account of the severe year for insured losses, due to the sequence 
of major natural catastrophe losses which occurred during 2017, the 
Group has produced an RoE of negative 5.9 per cent, which is the 
only negative full year annual RoE since the Group’s foundation in 
2005 (see the strategy and performance reviews of this Annual Report 
and Accounts on pages 12 to 41).  

Notwithstanding this, the Board and Committee were, on balance, 
satisfied with the outcomes in light of these events. Whilst the annual 
earnings have been impacted in comparison with previous years, 
there has not been a significant impairment to capital even in the  

face of the number of loss events. The business is well-positioned  
to compete in the market as we enter 2018 in what we expect to  
be an improving phase of the insurance cycle. This is in no small  
amount down to the work and planning of our management team  
in delivering a portfolio of business which was better able to respond  
to the challenge of a series of severe loss events notwithstanding the 
softer rating environment in which the Group and the whole 
(re)insurance sector have been operating in recent years. 

Against the background described above there has been a decrease  
in total remuneration of 49 per cent for the CEO and 47 per cent for 
the CFO between 2016 and 2017 (see the comparison table for single 
figure remuneration on page 70). This movement is driven by an  
RoE of negative 5.9 per cent for 2017 compared with 13.5 per cent  
for 2016, which affected vesting levels on the 2015 RSS awards  
(see below and page 73 for further details). 

Executive Directors’ annual bonus performance targets set at  
the beginning of 2017 for personal and financial performance  
were stretching, and given the Company’s 2017 lower return in 
comparison with previous years (as a result of the severe catastrophe 
loss environment) resulted in no annual bonus in relation to the 
financial element which made up 75 per cent of the annual bonus 
opportunity. The Board did however consider that both the Executive 
Directors had performed strongly in managing risk within the 
business and in positioning the Group well for what we hope will be  
a better rating environment in 2018 and 2019, therefore a bonus was 
awarded for the personal component in respect of 2017 performance. 
In summary, annual bonuses for our Executive Directors were 
achieved substantially below target level at only 17 per cent of 
maximum bonus for the CEO and 18 per cent of maximum  
bonus for the CFO (see page 72 for further details).  

In relation to long-term incentives, the 2015 Performance RSS awards 
were 75 per cent based on absolute RoE targets and 25 per cent on 
relative TSR against specified peer group companies over the three-
year period to 31 December 2017. Our TSR performance (in U.S. 
dollars) over this period ranked the Company below the median of 
the designated peer group of 11 companies, resulting in 0 per cent 
vesting for the TSR component.  

Our average RoE performance over this three-year performance 
period was 7.0 per cent against a threshold target of the 13-week 
Treasury bill rate plus 6 per cent and a maximum payout of the 13-
week Treasury bill rate plus 15 per cent, resulting in 30.1 per cent of 
the RoE component of the 2015 Performance RSS awards vesting. 
Overall, the 2015 Performance RSS awards vested at 22.5 per cent. 
This compared with the overall 67.4 per cent vesting of the 2014 
Performance RSS awards due to 89.8 per cent vesting of the RoE 
portion of those awards and 0 per cent vesting of the TSR portion  
of the awards, which we reported last year.  

The total remuneration received by our Executive Directors in 2017 
was accordingly significantly lower than that received in 2016 (see 
page 70 for the comparison data) and significantly lower than in 
many previous years, as demonstrated by the table of Total 
Remuneration History for the CEO on page 78. 

62 
60

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
The Committee has decided that the best way to avoid one loss-
making year having too big an impact on a series of RSS awards in  
the future is to separate the financial element of the award into three 
annual tranches. The RSS awards will still only vest after the three-  
year period, and the two-year subsequent holding period of course 
remains in place. We believe that this will help to create long-term 
value for our senior people in the future and avoid the problem of a 
big natural catastrophe year overly impacting the shares element of 
our remuneration structure. This will improve the retention value  
of the long-term incentive awards.  

The Committee will also be able to exercise downwards discretion at 
the end of an award period if it feels that the Executive Directors have 
not managed the business well, including in a loss-making year falling 
within the performance period of an RSS award.  

In addition, for our long-term RSS award TSR calculation, we are 
moving to an absolute TSR with a challenging threshold from the 
relative TSR calculation used in previous years. This is due to the 
radical reduction in the number of quoted peers which the Company 
now has as a result of M&A both in the UK and Bermuda. The 
Committee believes this has left the Company with no really relevant 
competitor group in the quoted sector and leads to unhelpful 
volatility in this part of the award. Further details are set out on  
pages 69 and 70 of this report. 

The final section of this report is the Annual Report on 
Remuneration, which provides detailed disclosure on how the Policy 
will be implemented for 2018 and how Directors have been paid in 
relation to 2017.  

The disclosures provide our shareholders with the information 
necessary to form a judgement as to the link between Company 
performance and how the Executive Directors are paid. This Annual 
Statement together with the Annual Report on Remuneration will be 
subject to an advisory vote and I hope that you will be able to support 
the resolution at the forthcoming AGM. The Committee is committed 
to maintaining an open and constructive dialogue with our 
shareholders on remuneration matters and I welcome any  
feedback you may have.  

Simon Fraser 
Chairman of the Remuneration Committee 

The Committee believes in setting challenging performance criteria 
and having a significant proportion of the overall package linked to 
Company performance. However, the Committee also continues  
to recognise the need to ensure that Executive Directors are 
appropriately remunerated and incentivised even in the more 
challenging phases of the insurance cycle, as at present.  

It is also important that the Committee and the Board ensure that 
Executive Director compensation is structured in such a way as to 
discourage excessive risk to the business.  

The like-for-like employee costs for the Group were $39.8 million in 
2017 compared with $72.1 million in 2016 (see page 78 for further 
detail). This 45 per cent decrease in employee costs is primarily 
attributed to the decrease in annual bonus and long-term incentive 
award grants. 

Overall, in light of the annual and three-year performance delivered, 
the Committee is satisfied that there has been a robust link between 
performance and reward for Executive Directors. However, in the 
context of the steep decline in Executive Director remuneration for 
2017, when compared with previous years, it is recognised by our 
Executive Directors that in a significant loss-making year (due to 
higher than normal natural catastrophe losses) it is appropriate for 
their remuneration outcomes to be aligned with the fortunes of our 
shareholders. In the insurance sector, which is powerfully cyclical, 
Lancashire will continue to ensure that there remains appropriate 
alignment between executive remuneration and Company 
performance not only in loss-affected years, but also in those  
future years when the Group hopes to produce results more  
in line with its cross-cycle return target. 

Application of Remuneration Policy for 2018 
The Remuneration Committee has reviewed the 2017 Directors’ 
Remuneration Policy approved by shareholders and considers it to 
remain fit for purpose.  

The Board has decided to apply the targets for the annual bonus  
on substantially the same basis as agreed for 2017. For the three-year 
longer-term RSS incentive awards, the Committee has decided to 
modify the structure for the 2018 awards, whilst remaining within  
the bounds of our overarching shareholder-approved Policy.  

The loss-making year of 2017 has had a very negative impact on the 
long-term RSS awards made in 2015, and is also expected to have a 
similar impact on the 2016 and 2017 RSS awards as we have used  
a rolling three-year average return to calculate the Company’s 
performance. In fact the Board believes that management’s 
performance in each of these years has been excellent and the 
financial results have been strong, given the market backdrop  
in 2015 and 2016 and the natural catastrophe frequency in 2017. 
Nevertheless, the impact of the 2017 year is expected to result in 
much lower levels of vesting of the long-term RSS awards granted 
in all these three years for senior management than the Board 
believes is warranted. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

63 
61

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued 

Directors’ Remuneration Policy section 
As a company incorporated in Bermuda, Lancashire is not bound  
by UK law or regulation in the area of Directors’ remuneration  
to the same extent that it applies to UK incorporated companies. 
However, by virtue of the Company’s premium listing on the  
LSE, and for the purposes of explaining its compliance against  
the requirements of the UK Corporate Governance Code, the  
Board is committed to providing full information on Directors’ 
remuneration to shareholders. 

The Company’s Remuneration Policy was approved by shareholders 
at the 2017 AGM and is effective for a period of three years from the 
2017 AGM until the AGM in 2020 (or until amended by a decision of 
shareholders). The 2017 Remuneration Policy was developed taking  
into account the principles of the Code and the views of our  
major shareholders. 

The 2017 Remuneration Policy contains details of the Company’s 
policy to govern future payments that will be made to Directors.  

The Annual Report on Remuneration also details the remuneration 
paid to Directors in respect of the 2017 financial year in accordance 
with the shareholder-approved Policy. 

Governance and approach 
The Company’s Remuneration Policy is geared towards providing a 
level of remuneration which attracts, retains and motivates Executive 
Directors of the highest calibre to further the Company’s interests 
and to optimise long-term shareholder value creation, within 
appropriate risk parameters. The Remuneration Policy also seeks  
to ensure that Executive Directors are provided with appropriate 
incentives to drive individual performance and to reward them fairly 
for their contribution to the successful performance of the Company. 

•  the Company has the power to clawback bonuses (including the 
deferred element of the annual bonus) and long-term incentive 
payments made to Executive Directors in the event of material 
misstatements in the Group’s consolidated financial statements, 
errors in the calculation of any performance condition, or the 
Executive Director ceasing to be a Director and/or employee  
due to gross misconduct. 

How the views of shareholders are taken into account 
The Committee Chairman and, where appropriate, the Company 
Chairman, consult with major investors and representative bodies  
on any significant remuneration proposal relating to Executive 
Directors. Views of shareholders at the AGM, and feedback  
received at other times, will be considered by the Committee. 

How the views of employees are taken into account 
The Remuneration Committee takes into account levels of  
pay elsewhere in the Group when determining the pay levels for 
Executive Directors. The Remuneration Policy for all staff is, in 
principle, broadly the same as that for Executive Directors in that  
any of the Group’s employees may be offered similarly structured 
packages, with participation in annual bonus and long-term incentive 
plans, although award types (restricted cash, restricted stock or 
performance shares) and size may vary between different categories  
of staff. For Executive Directors, with higher remuneration levels,  
a higher proportion of the compensation package is subject to 
performance pay, share-based remuneration and deferral.  
This ensures that there is a strong link between remuneration, 
Company performance and the interests of shareholders. 

Reflecting good practice in this area, Executive Directors’ pension 
provision is no more generous than the pension contributions made 
to employees in the Group (in percentage of salary terms). 

The Remuneration Committee and the Board have again considered 
whether any element of the Remuneration Policy could conceivably 
encourage Executive Directors to take inappropriate risks and have 
concluded that this is not the case, given the following: 

The Company does not consult with employees on Executive 
Directors’ remuneration. However, as noted above, the Committee  
is made aware of pay structures across the wider Group when setting 
the Remuneration Policy for Executive Directors.  

•  there is an appropriate balance between fixed and variable  
pay, and therefore Executive Directors are not required  
to earn performance-related pay to meet their day-to-day  
living expenses; 

•  there is a blend of short-term and long-term performance metrics 
with an appropriate mix of performance conditions, meaning that 
there is no undue focus on any one particular metric; 

•  there is a high level of share ownership amongst Executive 

Directors, meaning that there is a strong focus on sustainable  
long-term shareholder value; and 

64 
62

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
Remuneration Policy table 
Base Salary 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Helps recruit, motivate and retain high-calibre Executive Directors by offering salaries at market  

Operation  

competitive levels. 
Reflects individual experience and role. 

Normally reviewed annually and fixed for 12 months, typically effective from 1 January. Positioning and annual 
increases influenced by: 
•  role, experience and performance; 
•  change in broader workforce salary; 
•  changes to the size and complexity of the business; and 
•  changes in responsibility or position. 
Salaries are benchmarked periodically against insurance company peers in the UK, U.S. and in Bermuda. 

Opportunity 

No maximum. 

Benefits 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Market competitive structure to support recruitment and retention.  

Medical cover aims to ensure minimal business interruption as a result of illness. 

Operation  

Executive Directors’ benefits may include healthcare, dental, vision, gym membership and life insurance. Other 
additional benefits may be offered from time to time that the Committee considers appropriate based on the 
Executive Director’s circumstances.  
Executive Directors who are expatriates or are required to relocate may be eligible for a housing allowance or 
other relocation-related expenses. 
Any reasonable business-related expense can be reimbursed, including any personal tax thereon if such 
expense is determined to be a taxable benefit. 

Opportunity 

No maximum. 

Pension 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Contribution towards funding post-retirement lifestyle. 
Operation  

The Company operates a defined contribution pension scheme (via outsourced pension providers)  
or cash-in-lieu of pension. 
There is a salary sacrifice structure in the UK. 
There is the opportunity for additional voluntary contributions to be made by individuals, if elected. 

Opportunity 

Company contribution is currently 10 per cent of base salary. 

Annual Bonus1,2 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Rewards the achievement of financial and personal targets. 
Operation 

The annual bonus is based on financial and personal performance. 
The precise weightings may differ each year, although there will be a greater focus on financial as opposed to 
personal performance. 
The Committee will have the ability to override the bonus outcome by either increasing or decreasing the 
amount payable (subject to the cap) to ensure a robust link between reward and performance. 
At least 25 per cent of each Executive Director’s bonus is automatically deferred into shares as nil-cost  
options or conditional awards over three years, with one third vesting each subsequent year. 
A dividend equivalent provision operates enabling dividends to be accrued (in cash or shares) on  
unvested deferred bonus shares in the form of nil-cost options up to the point of exercise. 
The bonus is subject to clawback if the consolidated financial statements of the Company were materially 
misstated or an error occurred in assessing the performance conditions on bonus and/or if the Executive 
ceased to be a Director or employee due to gross misconduct. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

65 
63

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued 

Opportunity 

Performance Metrics 

The maximum bonus for Executive Directors for achieving target level of performance as a percentage of salary is 
200 per cent of salary. Maximum opportunity is two times target. 
Note: The Committee may set bonus opportunities less than the amounts set out above – see Implementation of 
Policy section of the Annual Report on Remuneration.  

The weightings that apply to the bonus measures and the degree of stretch in objectives may vary each year 
depending on the business aims and the broader economic or industry environment at the start of the relevant 
year. For Executive Directors, the financial component will be at least 75 per cent of the overall opportunity,  
and no more than 25 per cent will be based on personal or strategic objectives. 
Financial Performance 
The financial component is based on the Company’s key financial measures of performance. For any year, these 
may include RoE, growth in BVS, profit, comprehensive income, combined ratio, investment return or any other 
financial KPI3. 
Typically, a sliding scale of targets applies for financial performance targets. Bonus is earned on an incremental 
basis once a predetermined threshold level is achieved. Up to 25 per cent of the total bonus opportunity is 
payable for achieving threshold/median, rising to maximum bonus for stretch/upper quartile performance. 
The degree of stretch in targets may vary each year depending on the business aims and the broader economic  
or industry environment at the start of the relevant year. 
Personal Performance 
Personal performance is based upon achievement of clearly articulated objectives. A performance rating is 
attributed to participating Executive Directors, which determines the payout for this part of the bonus. 

Long Term Incentives (LTI)   

Purpose and Link  
to Strategy 

Operation2,3 

Opportunity 

Performance Metrics  

Rewards Executive Directors for achieving superior returns for shareholders over a longer time frame. 
Enables Executive Directors to build a meaningful shareholding over time and align goals with shareholders. 
RSS awards are normally made annually in the form of nil-cost options (or conditional awards) with vesting 
dependent on the achievement of performance conditions over at least three financial years, commencing with 
the year of grant. This three-year period is longer than the typical pattern of loss reserve development on the 
Group’s insurance business, which is approximately two years. 
The number of awards will normally be determined by reference to the share price around the time of grant 
unless the Committee, at its discretion, determines otherwise. 
The Committee considers carefully the quantum of awards each year to ensure that they are competitive in light 
of peer practice and the targets set. 
Awards are subject to clawback if there is a material misstatement in the Company’s consolidated financial 
statements, an error in the calculation of any performance conditions or if the Executive Director ceases to  
be a Director or employee due to gross misconduct. 
A dividend equivalent provision operates enabling dividends to be accrued (in cash or shares) on RSS awards up 
to the point of exercise. 
The Committee has the discretion, in exceptional circumstances, to settle an award made to Executive Directors 
in cash. 
A two-year post-vesting holding period applies to awards made to Executive Directors since 2016. 

Award levels are determined primarily by seniority. A maximum individual grant limit of 350 per cent  
of salary applies.  
Note: The Committee may set the normal level of award at less than the percentage set out above – see 
Implementation of Remuneration Policy section of the Annual Report on Remuneration. 
Awards vest at the end of a three-year performance period based on performance measures reflecting the  
long-term strategy of the business at the time of grant.  
These may include measures such as TSR, RoE/BVS, Company profitability, or any other relevant  
financial measures. 
If more than one measure is used, the Committee will review the weightings between the measures chosen and the 
target ranges prior to each LTI grant to ensure that the overall balance and level of stretch remains appropriate. 
A sliding scale of targets applies for financial metrics with no more than 25 per cent vesting for  
threshold performance. 
For TSR, none of this part of the award will vest below median ranking or achievement of an index. No more than 
25 per cent of this part of the award will vest for achieving median or index.  

66 
64

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
Remuneration Policy table continued 
Share Ownership Guidelines4 

Under the guidelines, Executive Directors are expected to maintain an interest equivalent in value to no less than two times salary over time. 
Until such time as the guideline threshold is achieved Executive Directors are required to retain no less than 50 per cent of the net of tax value 
of awards that vest under the RSS.  

Chairman and Non-Executive Directors’ fees 

Purpose and Link to Strategy  Helps recruit, motivate and retain a Chairman and Non-Executive Directors of a high calibre by offering  

Operation 

a market competitive fee level. 

The Chairman is paid a single fee for his responsibilities as Chairman. The level of these fees is reviewed 
periodically by the Committee and the CEO by reference to broadly comparable businesses in terms of size  
and operations. 
In general, the Non-Executive Directors are paid a single fee for all responsibilities, although supplemental fees 
may be payable where additional responsibilities are undertaken, including a Non-Executive Director role on a 
subsidiary board. 
Any reasonable business-related expenses (including any personal tax payable) can be reimbursed. 

Opportunity 

No maximum. 

(1)  The Committee operates the annual bonus plan and RSS according to their respective rules and in accordance with the Listing Rules. The Committee, consistent with 

normal market practice, retains discretion over a number of areas relating to the operation and administration of these plans and this discretion forms part of this policy. 

(2)  All historic awards that were granted under any current or previous share scheme operated by the Company that remain outstanding remain eligible to vest based on  

their original award terms and this provision forms part of the policy. 

(3)  Performance measures: these may include the performance indicators shown on pages 18 to 19 or others described within the Annual Report and Accounts Glossary 

commencing on page 153 or any other measure that supports the achievement of the Company’s short to long-term objectives. 

(4)  Share ownership interest equivalent is defined as wholly owned shares or the net of taxes value of RSS awards which have vested but are unexercised and the net of tax 

value of deferred bonus RSS awards. Shares include those owned by persons closely associated with the relevant Executive Director. 

Illustrations of annual application of Remuneration Policy 
The charts below show the potential total remuneration opportunities for the Executive Directors in 2018 at different levels of performance 
under the Directors’ Remuneration Policy. 

)

M
$
(

I

N
O
T
A
S
N
E
P
M
O
C
L
A
T
O
T

7

6

5

4

3

2

1

0

6.01
42%

42%

16%

Maximum

3.48
36%

36%

28%

On-target
CEO

0.95
100%

Fixed pay

Fixed pay

Annual bonus

LTI Awards (RSS)

4.13
39%

42%

19%

Maximum

2.46
32%

35%

33%

On-target
CFO

0.79
100%

Fixed pay

Fixed pay = 2018 Salary + Actual Value of 2017 Benefits + 2018 Pension Contribution. 

On-target = Fixed Pay + Target Bonus (being half the Maximum Bonus Opportunity) + Target Value of 2018 RSS grant (assuming 50 per cent 
vesting with face values of grant).  

Maximum = Fixed Pay + Maximum Bonus Opportunity + Maximum Value of 2018 RSS grant (assuming 100 per cent vesting with the face 
values of grant). 

No account has been taken of any share price growth or dividend equivalent accruals. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

67 
65

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued 

Approach to recruitment remuneration 
The remuneration package for a new Executive Director would be set in accordance with the terms of the Company’s prevailing approved 
Remuneration Policy at the time of appointment and take into account the skills and experience of the individual, the market rate for a 
candidate of that experience and the importance of securing the relevant individual. 

Salary would be provided at such a level as is required to attract the most appropriate candidate. The Committee retains the flexibility to set 
base salary for a newly appointed Executive Director below the mid-market level and allow them to progress quickly to or around mid-market 
level once expertise and performance have been proven. This decision would take into account all relevant factors noted above. 

The annual bonus and LTI potential would be in line with the Policy. Depending on the timing of the appointment, the Committee may deem 
it appropriate to set different bonus performance measures for the performance year during which he or she became an Executive Director. 
The Committee may grant an LTI award shortly after joining, up to the plan limits set out in the Remuneration Policy table (assuming the 
Company is not in a closed period). 

In addition, the Committee may offer additional cash and/or share-based elements to replace deferred or incentive pay forfeited by an 
executive leaving a previous employer. It would seek to ensure, where possible, that these awards would be consistent with awards forfeited  
in terms of vesting periods (which may be less than three years), expected value and performance conditions. 

For an internal Executive Director appointment, any variable pay element awarded in respect of the prior role may be allowed to pay out 
according to its terms, adjusted as relevant to take into account the appointment. In addition, any other ongoing remuneration obligations 
existing prior to appointment may continue.  

The Committee may agree that the Company will meet certain relocation expenses as appropriate and is able to provide expatriate benefits 
including housing, a relocation allowance, assignment-related costs or tax equalisation. 

Service contracts and loss of office payment policy for Executive Directors 
Executive Directors have service contracts with six-month notice periods. In the event of termination, the Executive Directors’ contracts provide 
for compensation up to a maximum of base salary plus the value of benefits to which the Executive Directors are contractually entitled for the 
unexpired portion of the notice period. The Company may pay statutory claims. No Executive Director has a contractual right to a bonus for 
any period of notice not worked.  

The service contract for a new appointment will be on similar terms as existing Executive Directors, with the facility to include a notice period 
of no more than 12 months from either party. 

The Company seeks to apply the principle of mitigation in the payment of compensation on the termination of the service contract of any 
Executive Director. There are no special provisions in the service contracts for payments to Executive Directors on a change of control of  
the Company. 

In the event of an exit of an Executive Director, the overriding principle will be to honour contractual remuneration entitlements and 
determine, on an equitable basis, the appropriate treatment of deferred and performance-linked elements of the package, taking account  
of the circumstances. Failure will not be rewarded.  

Depending on the leaver classification, an Executive Director may be eligible for certain payments or benefits continuation after cessation  
of employment. 

If an Executive Director resigns or is summarily dismissed, salary, pension and benefits will cease on the last day of employment and there will 
be no further payments. 

68 
66

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
Leaver on arranged terms or good leaver 
If an Executive Director leaves on agreed terms, including compassionate circumstances, there may be payments after cessation of employment. 
Salary, pension and benefits will be paid up to the length of the agreed notice period or agreed period of gardening leave.  

Subject to performance, a bonus may be payable at the discretion of the Committee pro-rata for the portion of the financial year worked.  

Vested but unexercised deferred bonus RSS awards will remain exercisable. Unvested deferred bonus RSS awards will ordinarily vest in full, 
relative to the normal vesting period. All such vested awards must be exercised within 12 months of the vesting date.  

Vested but unexercised RSS awards may remain exercisable for 12 months. Unvested awards may vest on the normal vesting date unless  
the Committee determines that such awards shall instead vest at the time of cessation. Unvested awards will only vest to the extent that the 
performance conditions have been satisfied (over the full or curtailed period as relevant). A pro-rata reduction in the size of awards may apply, 
based upon the period of time after the grant date and ending on the date of cessation of employment relative to the three-year or other 
relevant vesting period.  

The Committee has discretion to permit unvested RSS awards to vest early rather than continue on the normal vesting timetable and also 
retains discretion as to whether or not to apply (or to apply to a lesser extent) the pro-rata reduction to the RSS awards where it feels the 
reduction would be inappropriate. 

Depending upon circumstances, the Committee may consider other payments in respect of any claims in connection with a termination of 
employment where deemed appropriate, including an unfair dismissal award, outplacement support and assistance with legal fees. 

Terms of appointment for Non-Executive Directors  
The Non-Executive Directors serve subject to the Company’s Bye-laws and under letters of appointment. They are appointed subject  
to re-election at the AGM and are also terminable by either party on six months’ notice except in the event of earlier termination in  
accordance with the Bye-laws. The Non-Executive Directors are typically expected to serve for up to six years, although the Board may invite  
a Non-Executive Director to serve for an additional period. Their letters of appointment are available for inspection at the Company’s 
registered office and at each AGM.  

In accordance with best practice under the Code, the Board ordinarily submits the Directors individually for re-election by the shareholders at 
each AGM.  

Legacy arrangements  
In approving the Policy, authority is given to the Company for the duration of the Policy to honour commitments paid, promised to be paid  
or awarded to: (i) current or former Directors prior to the date of this Policy being approved (provided that such payments or promises were 
consistent with any Remuneration Policy of the Company which was approved by shareholders and was in effect at the time they were made); or 
(ii) to an individual (who subsequently is appointed as a Director of the Company) at a time when the relevant individual was not a Director of 
the Company and, in the opinion of the Committee, was not paid, promised to be paid or awarded as financial consideration of that individual 
becoming a Director of the Company, even where such commitments are inconsistent with the provisions of the revised Policy. 

For the avoidance of doubt, this includes all awards granted under the 2008 RSS rules in accordance with the Policy approved at the 2014 AGM 
and the current Policy which was subsequently approved by shareholders at the 2017 AGM, and to employees of the Company who are not 
Directors at the date of grant. Outstanding RSS awards that remain unvested or unexercised at the date of this report (including for current 
Executive Directors as detailed on page 74 of the Annual Report on Remuneration) remain eligible for vesting or exercise based on their 
original award terms. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

69 
67

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued 

Annual Report on Remuneration  
This Annual Report on Remuneration together with the Chairman’s Statement, as detailed on pages 60 and 61, will be subject to an advisory 
vote at the 2018 AGM. The information on page 70 with respect to Directors’ emoluments and onwards through page 79 has been audited  
by KPMG. 

Implementation of Remuneration Policy for 2018 
In relation to the Policy described in the previous section, the following section sets out additional disclosure on the expected application of the 
Policy for 2018. 

Base salary and fees 
Executive Directors 
Increases and resulting salaries effective from 1 January 2018 are set out below: 

•  CEO – salary increased by 3 per cent to $844,135. 
•  CFO – salary increased by 3 per cent to $579,640. 
•  For 2018, increases of 3 per cent are in line with the salary increases for Group employees. 

Non-Executive Directors 
The Chairman’s and Non-Executive Directors’ fees are as follows for 2018: 

•  The fee for the Chairman (Peter Clarke) will remain at $350,000 per annum.  
•  The Non-Executive Director fee will remain at $175,000 per annum.  

Other Fees 
•  Samantha Hoe-Richardson is a Non-Executive Director of LUK in which capacity she will receive a fee of $64,500 per annum. 
•  Simon Fraser is a Non-Executive Director of CUL in which capacity he will receive a fee of $80,000 per annum. 

Annual bonus 
For 2018, the CEO and CFO will have a target bonus of 150 per cent of salary and, therefore, a maximum opportunity of 300 per cent of  
salary. This is within the approved policy limit and it is in line with last year’s opportunity and represents a maximum bonus opportunity  
which is 100 per cent of salary less than the set policy limit. 

The financial and personal portions of the annual bonus will remain unchanged with 75 per cent on financial performance and 25 per cent on 
personal performance.  

Financial Performance (75 per cent) 
The Company’s most important financial KPI is RoE, which is the core indicator of the delivery of our strategic priorities of ensuring 
underwriting comes first, effectively balancing risk and return and managing capital nimbly through the insurance cycle (see the strategic 
overview on pages 14 and 15 of this Annual Report and Accounts). For 2018, the financial component for annual bonus is to be based on  
the performance of the Group’s RoE, measured as the internal rate of return of the change in FCBVS plus accrued dividends. 

A sliding scale range of RoE targets has been set by reference to the Risk Free Rate of Return as follows: 

•  25 per cent of target bonus shall be payable at a threshold level of RoE equal to RFRoR + 6 per cent (0 per cent will be payable below  

this threshold). 

•  50 per cent of target bonus shall be payable at a level of RoE equal to RFRoR + 7 per cent.  
•  100 per cent of target bonus shall be payable at a level of RoE equal to RFRoR + 8 per cent. 
•  200 per cent of target bonus shall be payable at a level of RoE equal to RFRoR + 14 per cent. 

There shall be linear interpolation between these points. The Board considers that these target ranges are appropriately challenging, given  
the current insurance market conditions, and will help to ensure a strong link between remuneration for the Executive Directors and the 
Company’s financial performance, the strategy and risk profile of the business and the investment return environment, without encouraging 
excessive risk-taking. In future years, the Committee would not normally expect to set reference points below the levels outlined above and, 
when appropriate, will set higher targets.  

70 
68

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
Personal Performance (25 per cent) 
This element of the bonus plan is based upon the individual achievement of clearly articulated objectives created at the beginning of each year. 
The table below sets out a broad summary of the 2018 personal objectives for each Executive Director. 

Executive Director 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan 

Personal Performance 

Effective leadership and management of the senior executive team and Group. 
Development of the general business strategy. 
Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Group Values. 
Effective leadership and management of the finance function and the Bermuda office. 
Development of the general business strategy. 
Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Group Values. 

The personal targets are broadly common among the Executive Directors, with variances being attributable to the specifics of their respective 
roles. Specific granular areas for personal development within the set broad personal objectives are discussed between the Chairman and the 
Executive Directors and agreed by the Committee. As part of the 2018 annual performance reviews, each Executive Director will receive a 
performance rating which will determine the level of personal performance bonus payout for which each Executive Director will be eligible. 

Restricted Share Scheme 
Performance Conditions 
For Executive Directors, 2018 RSS awards are subject to a range based on (i) annual growth in FCBVS plus accrued dividends and (ii) absolute 
TSR performance conditions, both measured by reference to a period ending on 31 December 2020. These metrics aim to provide an 
appropriate focus on the Company’s underlying financial performance and cycle management, and in the case of absolute TSR to provide  
an objective reward for delivering value to shareholders. 

Weighting  
For 2018, the weighting is 85 per cent on annual growth in FCBVS plus accrued dividends and 15 per cent on absolute TSR. 

Target ranges  
The annual growth in FCBVS plus accrued dividends target range for 2018 awards is: 

•  threshold – 6 per cent; and 
•  maximum – 13 per cent. 

Within the three-year performance period each of the separate financial years will be treated as a separate element, each one contributing  
one-third to the overall outcome of the vesting of this element of the RSS award. In each year performance will be measured against the target 
range to determine the ultimate level of vesting in respect of one-third of the RSS award. Vesting will only occur after completion of the full 
three-year performance period, and continued employment of the Executive Director at the time of vesting. This change in the 2018 RSS  
award is intended to ensure that any single year which is significantly affected by catastrophe losses does not substantially diminish the  
long-term incentive and retention value of all subsisting RSS awards. Please see the Chairman’s Statement on pages 60 and 61 for a  
further discussion of the rationale for the changes to the 2018 RSS awards. 

The relevant element of the RSS award will not vest if annual growth in FCBVS plus accrued dividends is below threshold, 25 per cent of the 
relevant element of the RSS award will vest at threshold, and 100 per cent of the relevant element of the RSS award will vest at maximum. 
Performance between threshold and maximum is determined on a straight-line basis. 

The Board and Committee consider that the maximum target represents exceptional performance, particularly in light of the challenging 
market conditions and significant insured loss environment experienced in 2017. The target range closely aligns the longer-term remuneration 
of our Executive Directors with strong performance, the implementation of the business strategy and the interests of our shareholders, but is 
not so stretching as to encourage excessive risk taking. 

Overriding downwards discretion 
If any year produces a return that the Committee believes is significantly worse than competitors and reflects poor management decisions, the 
Remuneration Committee will use its discretion to determine that no part (or a lesser part) of the RSS award accrued over the full three-year 
period shall vest. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

71 
69

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued 

The TSR target range for 2018 awards is: 

•  threshold – 8 per cent compound annual growth; and 
•  maximum – 12 per cent compound annual growth. 

Absolute TSR will be measured over the full three-year performance period rather than looking at each year separately. 

None of the award will vest if TSR is below threshold, 25 per cent of the award will vest at threshold, and 100 per cent of the award will vest at 
maximum. Performance between threshold and maximum is determined on a straight-line basis. 

Shareholder consultation in respect of 2018 RSS awards 
The Chairman of the Remuneration Committee consulted with a number of major shareholders before the Committee and Board  
approved these changes. The Board considers that these developments improve long-term alignment between Executive Directors and  
the Company’s shareholders. 

Award levels 
2018 RSS award levels are as follows: 

•  CEO – shares to the value of $2,532,405 (being 300 per cent of salary) 
•  CFO – shares to the value of $1,594,010 (being 275 per cent of salary) 

The number of shares awarded shall be determined based on the closing average share price for a period of five trading days immediately prior 
to the date of the award.  

Post-vesting holding period 
For RSS awards made in 2016 or subsequent years, Executive Directors are expected to hold vested RSS awards (or the resultant net of  
tax shares) which had a performance period of at least three years, for a further period of not less than two years following vesting. 

Single figure on remuneration 
The following table presents the Executive Directors’ emoluments in U.S. dollars in respect of the years ended 31 December 2017 and  
31 December 2016. 

Executive Directors  

Alex Maloney4,, CEO 

Elaine Whelan4, CFO 

Salary
$

811,311
810,266
562,268

547,423

2017 
2016 
2017 

2016 

Pension
$

81,227
81,027
56,275

54,636

Taxable  
Benefits1
$  

21,910 
20,127 
155,960 

Annual Bonus5,6 
$    

420,000   
1,825,627   
310,000   

Long-Term      
 Incentives      
 (RSS)2,3
$     

601,925  
1,063,364  
414,458  

Total4
$ 

1,936,373 
3,800,411 
1,498,961 

114,445 

1,253,598   

880,831  

2,850,933 

(1)  Benefits comprise Bermudian payroll taxes, social insurance, medical, dental and vision coverage and housing and other allowances paid by the Company for expatriates 

(as is the case for the CFO), but exclude UK National Insurance contributions.  

(2)  For 2017, the long-term incentive values are based on the 2015 RSS awards which vest at 22.5 per cent on 15 February 2018 and are based on a three-year performance 

period that ended on 31 December 2017. The values are based on the average share price for the last quarter of 2017 and include the value of dividends accrued on  
vested shares. 

(3)  For 2016, the long-term incentive values were based on the 2014 RSS awards which vested at 67.4 per cent on 16 February 2017 and were based on a three-year 

performance period that ended on 31 December 2016. The values are re-presented from the 2016 Annual Report and Accounts based on the share price at the  
vesting date, 16 February 2017, and include the value of dividends accrued on vested shares. 

(4)  Some amounts were paid in Sterling and converted at the average exchange rate of 1.2806 for the year as they are set in U.S. dollars. 
(5)  Bonus targets were set at the beginning of 2017 and based on a clear split between Company financial performance and personal performance on a 75:25 basis. Company 
financial performance is based on absolute financial performance against the RFRoR. The Company financial performance component paid out at 0 per cent of target as 
the RoE was negative 5.9 per cent against a target level of RFRoR +8 per cent. The personal element of Executive Directors’ bonus opportunity was the only bonus element 
to payout; however this element was also paid out at a modified rate considering the significant loss year experienced. Final bonus payout to Executive Directors will be  
17 per cent of the maximum for the CEO and 18 per cent of the maximum for the CFO. For full details of Executive Directors’ bonuses and the associated performance 
delivered see pages 71 and 72. 25 per cent of Executive Directors’ annual bonus is deferred into RSS awards without performance conditions, vesting at 33.3 per cent over 
a three-year period. 

(6)  Annual bonus figures for the Executive Directors for 2016 have been re-presented to reflect final relative performance data which was used to calculate the bonus figures 
and were finalised after all peer data was released in 2017, after the 2016 Directors’ Remuneration Report was published. For 2016, the relative component had been 
provisionally stated to pay out at 50 per cent of the maximum, however after final results of all peers were released, this element paid out at 188 per cent of target  
(with final bonus payout being 76 per cent of the maximum for the CEO and CFO). 

72 
70

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
Non-Executive Directors’ fees 

Current Non-Executive Directors 

Peter Clarke1 

Michael Dawson2 

Simon Fraser3 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson4 

Robert Lusardi5 

Tom Milligan6 

Former Non-Executive Directors 

Emma Duncan7 

Martin Thomas8 

Fee  
$ 

Other 
$

Total 
$

350,000 
290,769 
175,000 

28,269 

175,000 
175,000 

175,000 

175,000 
175,000 

84,808 

175,000 

175,000 

– 
91,538 
– 

–
–
–

–

80,000
66,974

64,500

13,350
–

–

–

–

–
–
–

350,000
290,769
175,000

28,269

255,000
241,974

239,500

188,350
175,000

84,808

175,000

175,000

–
91,538
–

111,250 

34,375

145,625

2017
2016
2017

2016

2017
2016

2017

2016
2017

2016

2017

2016

2017
2016
2017

2016

(1)  Peter Clarke was appointed as a Non-Executive Director with effect from 9 June 2014 and as LHL Chairman with effect from 4 May 2016 and his 2016 fees were 

proportionally pro-rated for the year. 

(2)  Michael Dawson was appointed as a Non-Executive Director with effect from 3 November 2016 and his 2016 fees were proportionally pro-rated for the year. 
(3)  Simon Fraser was additionally appointed as a Non-Executive Director of CUL with effect from 29 February 2016 and his 2016 fees were proportionally pro-rated for  

the year. 

(4)  Samantha Hoe-Richardson was additionally appointed as a Non-Executive Director of LUK with effect from 18 October 2016 and her 2016 fees were proportionally pro-

rated for the year.  

(5)  Robert Lusardi was appointed as a Non-Executive Director with effect from 8 July 2016 and his 2016 fees were proportionally pro-rated for the year. 
(6)  Tom Milligan was appointed as a Non-Executive Director with effect from 3 February 2015. 
(7)  Emma Duncan retired from the Board on 8 July 2016 and her 2016 fees were proportionally pro-rated for the year.  
(8)  Martin Thomas retired from the Board on 4 May 2016 and his 2016 fees were proportionally pro-rated for the year. 

2018 annual bonus payments in respect of 2017 performance 
As detailed in the Policy Report, each Executive Director participates in the annual bonus plan, under which performance is measured over  
a single financial year.  

The target value of bonus was 150 per cent of salary for the CEO and CFO respectively, and the maximum payable was two times the target 
value. The RoE is negative 5.9 per cent. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

73 
71

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued 

Financial performance 
75 per cent of the 2017 bonus was based on Company performance conditions and the extent to which these were achieved is as follows:  

Performance Measure 

Absolute RoE 

Financial Performance Weighting  
(of total bonus) 
% 

75 

Threshold
%

RFRoR 
+6%

Target
%

Max
%

Actual 
performance
%

% payout

 RFRoR 
+8%

 RFRoR 
+14%

-5.9 0% of target payable in respect of 
Company performance

In 2017 there was a higher than average frequency and severity of material natural catastrophe losses which resulted in the Lancashire Group 
delivering the lowest financial return since its inception in 2005. Bonus targets were set at the beginning of 2017 and based on a clear split 
between Company financial performance and personal performance on a 75:25 basis. The Company financial performance component did not 
payout at all (i.e. zero per cent of target) as RoE was negative 5.9 per cent against a target level of RFRoR +8 per cent and a threshold of RFRoR 
+6 per cent.  

Personal performance 
25 per cent of the 2017 bonus was based on performance against clearly defined personal objectives set at the start of the year.  

The table below sets out a summary of the 2017 personal objectives for each Executive Director. 

Executive Director 

Alex Maloney 

Elaine Whelan 

Personal Performance 

Effective leadership and management of the senior executive team and Group. 
Development of the general business strategy. 
Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Group Values. 
Effective leadership and management of the finance function and the Bermuda office. 
Development of the general business strategy. 
Contribution aligned to the Lancashire Group Values. 

The personal targets were broadly common among the Executive Directors, with variances being attributable to the specifics of their respective 
roles and performance targets relating to areas of personal development. 

During the 2017 annual performance reviews of each Executive Director, a performance rating was assigned to determine the level of bonus 
payout for which each Executive Director was eligible; however this element was paid out at a modified rate considering the significant loss  
year experienced.  

Notwithstanding the financial performance of the Group in what was a significant year for catastrophe loss activity (in this regard please see  
the strategy and performance sections on pages 12 to 41 of this Annual Report and Accounts) the Executive Directors each achieved a strong 
performance rating against their objectives, in particular in delivering an underwriting portfolio which operated in such a way as to moderate 
loss exposures through a combination of underwriting discipline and a carefully structured reinsurance programme. The leadership of the 
Executive Directors in delivering a team of employees with strong professional skills at all levels throughout the Group is considered by the 
Board to position the business well for the challenges and opportunities which lie ahead. For the 2017 performance against personal objectives, 
the ratings were determined following a process for the evaluation of performance of the Executive Directors against the agreed personal 
targets and discussion and agreement of the outcomes with the Chairman and members of the Board. The outcomes are expressed as a 
percentage of the maximum award as illustrated in the table below.  

A table of performance measures and total 2017 bonus achievement is set out below:  

Executive Director 

Alex Maloney 
Elaine Whelan 

Financial 
performance
 (max % of
 total bonus)
%

Personal 
performance 
(max % of 
total bonus)
%

Bonus
% of maximum 
awarded 
%

75
75

25
25

17
18

Value of bonus 
paid in cash
 (75 per cent of 
total bonus)
$

Value of bonus   
 deferred into   
RSS awards   
(25 per cent of   
total bonus)1
$   

315,000
232,500

105,000 
77,500 

Total  
bonus value1 
$  

420,000  
310,000  

(1)  25 per cent of total bonus award will be deferred into RSS awards with one third vesting annually, each year, over a three-year period with the first third becoming 
exercisable in February 2019, subject to the Company not being in a closed period. These awards vest on the relevant dates subject to continued employment only. 

74 
72

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
Long-term share awards with performance periods ending in the year – 2015 RSS awards 
The 2015 RSS awards were based on a three-year performance period ending on 31 December 2017 and vest following the determination of 
financial results by the Board. The tables below set out the achievement against the performance conditions attached to the award, resulting in 
aggregate vesting of 22.5 per cent, and the actual number of awards vesting (with their estimated value). 

Performance level 

Below threshold 
Threshold 
Stretch or above 
Actual achieved 

TSR  
(relative to a comparator group of 11 companies) 
(relevant to 25% of the 2015 RSS awards) 

Average annual RoE  
(over three years in excess of 13-week Treasury bill rate) 
(relevant to 75% of the 2015 RSS awards) 

Performance required

% vesting

Performance required (%)

% vesting

Below median
Median
Upper quartile or above
Below median

0
25
100
0

Below 6
6
15 or above
7.0

0
25
100
30.1

Details of the vesting for each Executive Director, based on the above, are shown in the table below: 

Executive Director 

Alex Maloney 
Elaine Whelan  

Number of 
shares at grant

Number of
 shares to lapse

Number of  
shares to vest 

Dividend accrual  
on vested shares  
value2 
$ 

Value of shares 
 including dividend 
 accrual1
$  

244,208
168,149

189,261
130,315

54,947 
37,834 

129,799 
89,373 

601,925 
414,458 

(1)  The value of the vested shares is based on the 2015 RSS awards which vest at 22.5 per cent on 15 February 2018 and are based on a three-year performance period that 

ended on 31 December 2017. The values are provisionally based on the average share price of the last quarter of 2017 (being $8.59 based on the exchange rate of 1.242). 
The values will be re-presented in 2018 with the value at the vesting date. The vested awards are subject to the clawback provision set out on page 64.  

(2)  Dividends accrue on awards at the record date of a dividend payment and upon exercise the cash value of the accrued dividends is paid to the employee on the number of 

vested awards net of tax required. 

Scheme interests awarded during the year 
The table below sets out the performance RSS awards that were granted as nil-cost options on 14 March 2017.  

Executive Director 

Alex Maloney 
Elaine Whelan 

Number of awards  
granted during  
the year 

Face value    
of awards    
 granted during    
the year1,3
$    

 286,666   2,458,640   
1,547,583   
180,441 

% vesting 
at threshold 
performance

25
25

Grant date2

14-Mar-2017 
14-Mar-2017 

(1)  The awards were based on the five-day average closing share price prior to the award date, being £7.02 (a share price of $8.57 based on the exchange rate of 1.2214) and 

the awards were granted as nil-cost options. 

(2)  These awards are due to vest subject to performance conditions being met at the end of the performance period ending 31 December 2019 and become exercisable in the 

first open period following the release of the Company’s 2019 year-end results after the meeting of the Board in February 2020. 

(3)  The exercise share price is determined once an award has vested on the basis of the share price on the date an award is exercised. 

Loss of office payments 
There were no loss of office payments during the 2017 year. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

75 
73

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued 

Details of all outstanding share awards 
In addition to awards made during the 2017 financial year, the table below sets out details of all outstanding RSS awards held by  
Executive Directors. 

Performance and deferred bonus awards under the nil-cost option Restricted Share Scheme (RSS) 

Grant date1 

Exercise 
price

Awards 
held at 
1-Jan-17

Awards 
granted 
during the year

Awards 
vested 
during the year

Awards  
lapsed  
during the year

Awards 
exercised 
during the year  

Awards
 held at 
31-Dec-17

End of 
performance 
period

Alex Maloney, 
Group CEO 

Total 
Elaine Whelan, 
Group CFO & 
LICL CEO 

Total 

Performance RSS2,3 
Deferred Bonus RSS4 
Performance RSS2,3 
Deferred Bonus RSS4 
Performance RSS2,3 
Deferred Bonus RSS4 
Performance RSS2,3 
Deferred Bonus RSS4 

Performance RSS2,3 
Deferred Bonus RSS4 
Performance RSS2,3 
Deferred Bonus RSS4 
Performance RSS2,3 
Deferred Bonus RSS4 
Performance RSS2,3 
Deferred Bonus RSS4 

19-Feb-14  
5-Mar-14  
12-Feb-15  
20-Mar-15  
18-Feb-16  
11-Mar-16  
14-Mar-17  
14-Mar-17  

19-Feb-14  
5-Mar-14  
12-Feb-15  
20-Mar-15  
18-Feb-16  
11-Mar-16  
14-Mar-17  
14-Mar-17  

 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
–
–

 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 

124,333
9,810
244,208
27,953
219,254
56,224
–
–
681,782
102,989
7,986
168,149
19,693
157,104
38,607
–
–
494,528

–
–
–
–
–
–
286,666
53,215
339,881
–
–
–
–
–
–
180,441
36,541
216,982

 83,801 
9,810 
–
13,977
–
18,741
–
–
126,329
69,416
7,986
–
9,846
–
12,869
–
–
100,117

 40,532  
 –  
–
–
–
–
–
–
40,532
33,573
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
33,573

83,801  
9,810 
– 
13,977 
– 
18,741 
– 
– 
126,329 
69,416 
7,986 
– 
9,846 
– 
12,869 
– 
– 
100,117 

– 31-Dec-16
–

244,208 31-Dec-17
13,976
219,254 31-Dec-18
37,483
286,666 31-Dec-19
53,215
854,802

– 31-Dec-16
–

168,149 31-Dec-17

9,847

157,104 31-Dec-18
25,738
180,441  31-Dec-19
36,541
577,820  

(1)  The market values of the common shares on the dates of grant were: 

(3)  The vesting dates of the RSS performance awards are subject to being out of a 

•  19 February 2014 £7.34 

•  5 March 2014 £7.26 

•  12 February 2015 £6.36 

•  20 March 2015 £6.30 

•  18 February 2016 £6.17 

•  11 March 2016 £5.37 

closed period and are as follows: 

•  2014 – 16 February 2017; 

•  2015 – 15 February 2018; 

•  14 March 2017 £7.02 

•  2016 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2018 year-end results; and

(2)  The vesting of the RSS performance awards above is subject to two performance 

•  2017 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2019 year-end results. 

conditions as follows:  

•  25 per cent of each award is subject to a performance condition measuring the TSR 

performance of the Company against the TSR performance of a select group of comparator 
companies (see page 76 for a list of comparator companies for each grant year), over a three-
year performance period. 25 per cent of this part of the award vests for median performance 
by the Company, rising to 100 per cent vesting of this part of the award for upper quartile 
performance by the Company or better (with proportionate vesting between these  
two points). 

•  The other 75 per cent of each award is subject to a performance condition based on average 
annual RoE over a three-year performance period. 25 per cent of this part of the award will 
vest if average annual RoE over the performance period exceeds the criteria set out in the 
table on page 75, whilst all of this part of the award will vest if the Company’s average RoE  
is equal to the more stringent criteria set out in the table on page 75. Between these two  
points vesting will take place on a straight-line basis from 25 per cent to 100 per cent for  
RoE performance.  

(4)  The vesting dates of the RSS Deferred Bonus awards are subject to being out  
of a closed period and, for the 2014 to 2017 Deferred Bonus awards, are  
as follows: 

•  2014 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three-year period at the first open period following the 

release of the Company’s year-end results for 2014, 2015 and 2016; 

•  2015 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three-year period at the first open period following the 

release of the Company’s year-end results for 2015, 2016 and 2017;  

•  2016 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three-year period at the first open period following the 

release of the Company’s year-end results for 2016, 2017 and 2018; and 

•  2017 – vest 33.33 per cent over a three-year period at the first open period following the 

release of the Company’s year-end results for 2017, 2018 and 2019. 

76 
74

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Relative TSR targets for RSS (25 per cent weighting) 

100% 
25% 
Nil 

RoE targets for RSS (75 per cent weighting) 

100% 

25% 
Nil 

*  Average annual growth in FCBVS plus accrued dividends. 

Absolute TSR targets for RSS (15 per cent weighting) 

100% 
25% 
Nil 

2014

2015

2016

2017

75th percentile 
= median 
< median 

75th percentile 
 = median 
< median 

75th percentile 
= median 
< median 

75th percentile 
= median 
< median 

2014

2015

2016

RFRoR +15% 
RFRoR + 6% 
< RFRoR + 6% 

RFRoR +15% 
RFRoR + 6% 
< RFRoR + 6% 

RFRoR +15%
RFRoR + 6% 
< RFRoR + 6% 

Annual growth in FCBVS plus accrued dividends targets for RSS (85 per cent weighting) 

100% 

25% 
Nil 

*  See page 69 and 70 for the vesting methodology to be applied for the 2018 RSS awards. 

2017*

13% 
 6%  
< 6%  

2018*

12%
 8% 
< 8% 

2018*

13% 
 6%  
< 6%  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

77 
75

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued 

Historical Peer Group Data for 2017 and prior RSS awards (relative TSR element) 

Peer Companies 11 

Amlin plc1  
Arch Capital Group Limited2, 4 
Argo Group International Holdings, Ltd. 
Aspen Insurance Holdings Limited 
Axis Capital Holdings Limited 
Beazley plc 
Catlin Group Ltd.3 
Endurance Specialty Holdings Ltd.4,7 
Everest Re Group, Ltd.5 
The Hanover Insurance Group6 
Hiscox Ltd. 
Montpelier Re Holdings Ltd.7 
Novae Group plc8,9 
Renaissance Re Holdings Ltd. 
Validus Holdings Ltd. 10 
XL Group Ltd9 

2014 awards

2015 awards 

2016 awards

2017 awards

X
–
X
X
X
X
X
X
–
–
X
X
–
X
X
–

X 
– 
X 
X 
X 
X 
– 
X 
X 
X 
X 
– 
X 
X 
X 
X 

–
X
X
X
X
X
–
X
X
X
X
–
X
X
X
X

–
X
X
X
X
X
–
–
X
X
X
–
X
X
X
X

(1)  Mitsui Sumitomo Insurance Company acquired Amlin plc on 1 February 2016. Accordingly, the Committee decided to use Amlin plc as a comparator company up to  

30 June 2015 and it was replaced with Everest Re Group, Ltd with effect from 1 July 2015. 

(2)  Arch Capital Group Limited was added to the peer group of companies with effect from 1 October 2016 as a replacement for Endurance Specialty Holdings Ltd.  
(3)  Catlin Group Ltd. was acquired by the XL Group Ltd. with effect from 1 May 2015 and so was used as a comparator company up to 31 December 2014 and was replaced  

by Novae Group plc. 

(4)  Sompo Holdings Inc. announced on 5 October 2016 that it intended to acquire Endurance Specialty Holdings Ltd. (‘Endurance’). The transaction subsequently  

achieved shareholder approval. Accordingly, the Committee decided to use Arch Capital Group Limited as a comparator company with effect from 1 October 2016  
as a replacement for Endurance. 

(5)  Everest Re Group, Ltd. was added to the peer group of companies with effect from 1 July 2015 as a replacement for Amlin plc. 
(6)  The Hanover Insurance Group was added to the peer group of companies with effect from 1 January 2015 as a replacement for Montpelier Re Holdings Ltd. 
(7)  Montpelier Re Holdings Ltd. was acquired by Endurance with effect from 31 July 2015 and so was used as a comparator company up to 31 December 2014 and was 

replaced by The Hanover Insurance Group.  

(8)  Novae Group plc was added to the peer group of companies with effect from 1 January 2015 as a replacement for Catlin Group Ltd. 
(9)  Novae Group plc was acquired by Axis Capital Holdings Limited with effect from 2 October 2017 and so was used as a comparator company up to 30 June 2017 and was 

replaced by XL Group Ltd as of 1 July 2017. 

(10) American International Group, Inc. announced on 22 January 2018 that it is set to acquire Validus Holdings Ltd.; a replacement within the peer group of companies 

effective 1 January 2018 has not yet been identified but consideration of this has been initiated. 

(11) For 2018 RSS awards the Board adopted a range of absolute TSR targets. See page 70 for further details. 

78 
76

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
Directors’ shareholdings and share interests 
Formal shareholding guidelines were first introduced in 2012 and have subsequently been modified. The guidelines require the CEO and CFO 
to build and maintain a shareholding in the Company worth two times annual salary as set out in the Policy Report. 

Details of the Directors’ interests in shares are shown in the table below.  

Directors 

Alex Maloney 
Elaine Whelan 
Peter Clarke 
Michael Dawson 
Simon Fraser 
Samantha Hoe-Richardson  
Robert Lusardi 
Tom Milligan 

Total as at 1 January 2017

As at 31 December 2017 

Number of Common Shares 

Legally owned

Subject to deferral 
under the RSS

Subject to 
performance 
conditions 
under the RSS

Vested but 
unexercised 
awards under 
other share- 
based plans 

1,195,294
923,504
14,000
–
1,000
3,947
3,000
1,000

580,302
524,370
44,000
7,200
1,000
3,947
3,000
1,000

104,674
72,126
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A

750,128
505,694
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A

N/A 
N/A 
N/A 
N/A 
N/A 
N/A 
N/A 
N/A 

Total

1,435,104
1,102,190
44,000
7,200
1,000
3,947
3,000
1,000

Shareholding
guideline
achieved?

Yes
Yes
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A

Note: Share ownership interest equivalent is defined as wholly owned shares or the net of taxes value of RSS awards which have vested but are unexercised and the net of tax 
value of deferred bonus RSS awards. Shares include those owned by persons closely associated with the relevant Executive Director. 

Performance graph  
The following graph shows the Company’s performance, measured by TSR, compared with the performance of the FTSE 250 Index.  
The Company’s common shares commenced trading on the main market of the LSE on 16 March 2009 and the Company joined the  
FTSE 250 Index on 22 June 2009 and is currently a constituent of this. 

TOTAL SHAREHOLDER RETURN

£

500

450

400

350

300

250

200

150

100

50

0

2008

2009

2010

2011

2012

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

Lancashire Holdings

FTSE 250 Index

Source: Datastream (Thomson Reuters)

This graph shows the value, by 31 December 2017, of £100 invested in LHL on 31 December 2008 compared with the value of £100 invested in 
the FTSE 250 Index. The other points plotted are the values at intervening financial year ends. 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

79 
77

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued 

Total Remuneration History for CEO 
The table below sets out the total single figure remuneration for the CEOs over the last nine years with the annual bonus paid as a percentage 
of the maximum and the percentage of long-term share awards vesting in each year. 

2009 

2010 

2011

2012

2013

Total remuneration ($000s) 
Annual bonus (%) 
LTI vesting (%) 

7,244 
68 
N/A 

9,945 
94 
99.6 

9,623 10,460 10,175
80
100

73
100

73
99

Richard Brindle 
20141

Alex Maloney 
20142

10,072 
80 
613

2,405 
73 
50 

2015 

2016

3,853 
72 
75 

3,8004
764
67

2017

1,936
17
22.5

(1)  Richard Brindle was the CEO from 2005 until he retired from the Group and as a Director on 30 April 2014.  
(2)  Alex Maloney was appointed CEO effective 1 May 2014, after the retirement of Mr Brindle. For the purposes of this table his numbers have been pro-rated to account for 

only his time in office as CEO for 2014.  

(3)  Mr Brindle was afforded good leaver status and all RSS award interests were vested upon his departure, using estimated TSR and RoE values at the time of his retirement. 
The amounts in the table above reflect all awards which vested in 2014. Further particulars of the vesting were reported in the Group’s 2014 Annual Report and Accounts. 

(4)  Alex Maloney’s 2016 total remuneration and annual bonus percentage have been re-presented in the above table to reflect changes made after the publication of the  
2016 Annual Report and Accounts. These changes are primarily due to the disclosed relative RoE performance which impacted his annual bonus figure for 2016 and  
the re-presentation of his LTI award vesting and dividend accrual value at the vesting date, as disclosed on page 70.  

The table above shows the total remuneration figure for the former CEO during each of the relevant financial years; figures for the current 
CEO are shown since his appointment to the position on 1 May 2014. The total remuneration figure includes the annual bonus and LTI awards 
which vested based on performance in those years. The annual bonus and LTI percentages show the payout for each year as a percentage of 
the maximum. 

Percentage change in CEO remuneration 
The following table sets out the percentage change in the aggregate value of salary, benefits and bonus for the CEO from the preceding year 
and the average percentage change in respect of the employees of the Group taken as a whole. 

Base salary 
Benefits 
Bonus 

Year-on-year  
change 
CEO2
% 

Average    
year-on-year    
change employees1,3
%   

0
2
(77)

8 
8 
(79) 

(1)  Employee numbers were calculated on a per permanent employee headcount basis for the years ending 31 December 2017 and 31 December 2016, adjusted for any 

joiners and leavers during this period. 

(2)  The underlying salary increase from 2016 to 2017 for the CEO was 3 per cent. However some amounts were paid in Sterling and converted at the average exchange rate of 

1.2806 for the year, which has resulted in the overall 0 per cent base salary year-on-year change above. 

(3)  The underlying salary increase from 2016 to 2017 for Group employees was 3 per cent. The 8 per cent increase reflects staff promotions and other adjustments made 

during the year. 

Relative importance of the spend on pay 
The following table sets out the percentage change in dividends and overall spend on pay in the year ended 31 December 2017 compared with  
the year ended 31 December 2016.  

Employee remuneration costs 
Dividends 

2017 
$m 

39.8 
29.9 

2016
$m

Percentage change
%

72.1
178.9

(45)
(83)

80 
78

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
 
 
 
Committee members, attendees and advice 
For Remuneration Committee membership and attendance at meetings through 2017, please refer to page 59 of this Annual Report  
and Accounts. The Remuneration Committee’s responsibilities are contained in its Terms of Reference, a copy of which is available on the 
Company’s website. These responsibilities include determining the framework for the remuneration, including pension arrangements, for  
all Executive Directors, the Chairman and senior executives. The Committee is also responsible for approving employment contracts for  
senior executives. 

Remuneration Committee adviser 
The Remuneration Committee is advised by NBS, a trading name of Aon Hewitt, being a subsidiary of Aon plc. NBS was appointed by the 
Remuneration Committee in 2007. NBS has discussions with the Remuneration Committee Chairman regularly on Committee process and 
topics which are of particular relevance to the Company.  

Aon Benfield (which is part of Aon but is a separate business division from Aon Hewitt) provides reinsurance broking services to the Group.  

The primary role of NBS is to provide independent and objective advice and support to the Committee’s Chairman and members. In order  
to manage any possible conflict of interest, NBS operates as a distinct business within the Aon Group and there is a robust separation between 
the business activities and management of NBS and all other parts of Aon Hewitt and the wider Aon Group. The Committee is satisfied that the 
advice that it receives is objective and independent. NBS is also a signatory to the Remuneration Consultants Group (‘RCG’) Code of Conduct 
which sets out guidelines for managing conflicts of interest, and has confirmed to the Committee its compliance with the RCG Code.  

The total fees paid to NBS in respect of its services to the Committee for the year ended 31 December 2017 were $68,072 (2016 – $159,473). 
Fees are predominantly charged on a ‘time spent’ basis.  

Engagement with shareholders 
Details of votes cast for and against the resolution to approve last year’s Remuneration Report are shown below along with the votes to approve 
the 2017 Remuneration Policy which have been stated below; any matters discussed with shareholders during the year are provided in the 
Implementation of Remuneration Policy for 2018 section of the report starting on page 68.  

Vote to approve 2016 Annual Report  
on Remuneration 

Vote to approve 2017-2019 
Remuneration Policy 

Total number 
of votes

% of 
 votes cast 

Total number 
of votes

143,579,559
8,228,480
151,808,039
9,418,682

94.6 
5.4 
100.0 

144,229,951
7,870,777

152,100,728
9,125,993

% of
 votes cast

94.8
5.2

100.0

For  
Against 

Total 
Abstentions 

Approved by the Board of Directors and signed on behalf of the Board. 

Simon Fraser 
Chairman of the Remuneration Committee 

14 February 2018 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

81 
79

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
Directors’ report 

Overview of the Group 
Lancashire Holdings Limited is a Bermuda incorporated company (Registered Company No. 37415) with operating subsidiaries in Bermuda 
and London, and two Syndicates at Lloyd’s.  

The Company’s common shares were admitted to trading on AIM in December 2005 and were subsequently moved up to the Official List 
and to trading on the main market of the LSE on 16 March 2009. The shares have been included in the FTSE 250 Index since 22 June 2009. 

Principal activities 
The Company’s principal activity, through its wholly owned subsidiaries, is the provision of global specialty insurance and reinsurance 
products. On 7 November 2013, the Company completed the acquisition of CCL, an established Lloyd’s insurance group, and in June 2013 
established Kinesis, a third party capital and underwriting management facility, to complement the Group’s longstanding specialty insurance 
activities. An analysis of the Group’s business performance can be found in the Business Review on pages 24 to 30. 

Dividends  
For the year ended 31 December 2017, the following dividends were declared:  

•  an interim dividend of $0.05 per common share was declared on 26 July 2017 and paid on 6 September 2017 in pounds sterling at  

the pound/U.S. dollar exchange rate of 1.2965 or £0.0386 per common share; and 

•  a final dividend of $0.10 per common share was declared on 14 February 2018 to be paid on 21 March 2018 in pounds sterling at  

the pound/U.S. dollar exchange rate on the record date of 23 February 2018 or approximately £0.07 per common share. 

Dividend policy 
The Group intends to maintain a strong balance sheet at all times, while generating an attractive risk-adjusted total return for shareholders. 
We actively manage capital to achieve those aims. Capital management is expected to include the payment of a sustainable annual (interim 
and final) dividend, supplemented by special dividends from time to time. Dividends will be linked to past performance and future prospects. 

Under most scenarios, the annual dividend is not expected to reduce from one year to the next. Special dividends are expected to vary 
substantially in size and in timing. The Board may cancel the payment of any dividend between declaration and payment for purposes of 
compliance with regulatory requirements or for exceptional business reasons. 

at a price of £6.90 realising £32,606. 

Transactions in own shares 

Current Directors 
•  Peter Clarke (Non-Executive Chairman)  
•  Michael Dawson (Non-Executive Director)  
•  Simon Fraser (Senior Independent Non-Executive Director) 
•  Samantha Hoe-Richardson (Non-Executive Director) 
•  Robert Lusardi (Non-Executive Director)  
•  Alex Maloney (Chief Executive Officer) 
•  Tom Milligan (Non-Executive Director) 
•  Elaine Whelan (Chief Financial Officer) 

82 
80

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The Directors’ beneficial interests in the Company’s common shares as at 31 December 2017 and 2016 including interests held by family 

There have been no changes in Directors’ shareholdings between the end of the financial year and the date of this Report. 

(1) Peter Clarke conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2017: 

•  2 November – purchase of 30,000 shares at a price of £7.46 costing £223,791. 

(2) Michael Dawson conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2017: 

•  28 February – purchase of 7,200 shares at a price of £6.93 costing £49,896. 

(3) Includes 100,000 shares owned by his spouse, Amanda Maloney. Alex Maloney conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2017: 

•  29 March – exercise of 83,801 RSS awards and 42,528 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 59,539 shares to cover tax liabilities,  

at a price of £6.72 realising £400,310. 

(4) Includes 11,590 shares owned by her spouse, Kilian Whelan. Elaine Whelan conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2017: 

•  27 February – exercise of 69,416 RSS awards and 30,701 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 4,723 shares to cover tax liabilities,  

The Company did not repurchase any of its own common shares during 2017 or 2016. 

The Group’s current repurchase programme has 20,134,191 common shares remaining to be purchased as at 31 December 2017 

(approximately $172.7 million at the 31 December 2017 share price). The purpose of the Company’s repurchase programme is to acquire 

shares to use in the future towards satisfying its obligations under its RSS awards. Further details of the share repurchase authority and 

programme are set out in note 18 to the consolidated financial statements on page 147. The repurchase programme is subject to renewal  

at the 2018 AGM in an amount of up to 10 per cent of the then issued common share capital. 

Details of the Directors’ remuneration are set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 60 to 79. 

As at 14 February 2018, the Company was aware of the following interests of 3 per cent or more in the Company’s issued share capital: 

Directors’ interests 

members were as follows: 

Directors 

Peter Clarke1 

Michael Dawson2 

Simon Fraser 

Robert Lusardi 

Alex Maloney3 

Tom Milligan 

Elaine Whelan4 

Samantha Hoe-Richardson 

Directors’ remuneration 

Substantial shareholders 

Name 

Invesco Limited 

Setanta Asset Management Limited 

Wellington Management 

Dimensional Fund Advisors LP 

Frank W. Cawood 

Franklin Mutual Advisers, LLC 

The Vanguard Group, Inc 

BlackRock, Inc. 

Troy Asset Management Limited 

Common shares 

Common shares 

held as at

held as at 

31 December 2017

31 December 2016

44,000

14,000

7,200

1,000

3,947

3,000

580,302

1,000

524,370

–

1,000

3,947

3,000

513,512

1,000

428,976

Number of shares as 

at 14 February 2018

% of shares

 in issue

18.1

36,515,214

18,023,741

11,359,428

9,501,507

9,302,300

7,639,246

7,397,922

6,990,810

6,864,893

9.0

5.6

4.7

4.6

3.8

3.7

3.5

3.4

www.lancashiregroup.com 

83 

 
 
 
 
 
Directors’ interests 
The Directors’ beneficial interests in the Company’s common shares as at 31 December 2017 and 2016 including interests held by family 
members were as follows: 

Directors 

Peter Clarke1 
Michael Dawson2 
Simon Fraser 
Samantha Hoe-Richardson 
Robert Lusardi 
Alex Maloney3 
Tom Milligan 
Elaine Whelan4 

Common shares 
held as at
31 December 2017

Common shares 
held as at 
31 December 2016

44,000
7,200
1,000
3,947
3,000
580,302
1,000
524,370

14,000
–
1,000
3,947
3,000
513,512
1,000
428,976

There have been no changes in Directors’ shareholdings between the end of the financial year and the date of this Report. 
(1) Peter Clarke conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2017: 

•  2 November – purchase of 30,000 shares at a price of £7.46 costing £223,791. 

(2) Michael Dawson conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2017: 

•  28 February – purchase of 7,200 shares at a price of £6.93 costing £49,896. 

(3) Includes 100,000 shares owned by his spouse, Amanda Maloney. Alex Maloney conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2017: 

•  29 March – exercise of 83,801 RSS awards and 42,528 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 59,539 shares to cover tax liabilities,  

at a price of £6.72 realising £400,310. 

(4) Includes 11,590 shares owned by her spouse, Kilian Whelan. Elaine Whelan conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2017: 

•  27 February – exercise of 69,416 RSS awards and 30,701 deferred bonus RSS awards and related sale of 4,723 shares to cover tax liabilities,  

at a price of £6.90 realising £32,606. 

Transactions in own shares 
The Company did not repurchase any of its own common shares during 2017 or 2016. 

The Group’s current repurchase programme has 20,134,191 common shares remaining to be purchased as at 31 December 2017 
(approximately $172.7 million at the 31 December 2017 share price). The purpose of the Company’s repurchase programme is to acquire 
shares to use in the future towards satisfying its obligations under its RSS awards. Further details of the share repurchase authority and 
programme are set out in note 18 to the consolidated financial statements on page 147. The repurchase programme is subject to renewal  
at the 2018 AGM in an amount of up to 10 per cent of the then issued common share capital. 

Directors’ remuneration 
Details of the Directors’ remuneration are set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 60 to 79. 

Substantial shareholders 
As at 14 February 2018, the Company was aware of the following interests of 3 per cent or more in the Company’s issued share capital: 

Name 

Invesco Limited 
Setanta Asset Management Limited 
Wellington Management 
Dimensional Fund Advisors LP 
Frank W. Cawood 
Franklin Mutual Advisers, LLC 
The Vanguard Group, Inc 
BlackRock, Inc. 
Troy Asset Management Limited 

Number of shares as 
at 14 February 2018

% of shares
 in issue

36,515,214
18,023,741
11,359,428
9,501,507
9,302,300
7,639,246
7,397,922
6,990,810
6,864,893

18.1
9.0
5.6
4.7
4.6
3.8
3.7
3.5
3.4

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

83 
81

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
Directors’ report continued 

Corporate governance – compliance statement 
The Company’s compliance with the Code is summarised in the Corporate Governance section of this Annual Report and Accounts  
on pages 47 to 49.  

The Company confirms, in accordance with the principle of ‘comply or explain’, that the Board considers that the Company has complied 
with the principles and provisions as set out in the Code throughout the year ended 31 December 2017. With regard to the diversity policy  
for the Group and its implementation please see the report of the Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee, specifically page 56. 

Donations 
In June 2017 the Company made a cash donation of $702,358 to the Lancashire Foundation. 

The Foundation owns 330,713 common shares in the Company and during the 2017 calendar year received dividends of £39,090 declared on 
those shares. 

Lancashire established the Lancashire Foundation as a Bermuda charitable trust in 2007, with the aim of creating a trust for the benefit  
of charitable causes in Bermuda, the UK and worldwide. During 2012, the assets of the Lancashire Foundation were transferred to the 
Lancashire Foundation charitable trust established in England and Wales and registered with the Charity Commission. The Lancashire 
Foundation’s trustees are two senior employees and a subsidiary Non-Executive Director. The Trustees make donations following 
recommendations made by the Company’s Donations Committee consisting of some of the Group’s employees.  

A summary of the work of the Lancashire Foundation during 2017 can be found in the Corporate Responsibility section on pages 36 to 41. 

The Group did not make any political donations or expenditure during 2017 or 2016. 

Health and safety 
The Group considers the health and safety of its employees to be a management responsibility equal to that of any other function.  

The Group operates in compliance with health and safety legislative requirements in Bermuda and the UK. 

Greenhouse gas emissions 
The Group’s greenhouse gas emissions are detailed in the Corporate Responsibility section on page 39. 

Employees 
The Group is an equal opportunity employer, and does not tolerate unfair discrimination, bullying or harassment of any kind in any area  
of employment or corporate life. The Group believes that education and training for employees is a continuous process and employees are 
encouraged to discuss training needs with their managers. The Group’s health and safety, equal opportunities, training and other policies, 
including labour standards, working conditions and benefits, are available to all employees in the staff handbook, which is available on the 
Group’s intranet and provided to all new staff during their induction. 

Creditor payment policy 
The Group aims to pay all creditors promptly and in accordance with contractual and legal obligations. 

Financial instruments and risk exposures  
Information regarding the Group’s risk exposures is included in the ERM report on pages 31 to 33 and in the risk disclosures section  
on pages 100 to 125 of the consolidated financial statements. The Group’s use of derivative financial instruments can be found on  
pages 114 to 116. 

Accounting standards 
The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted under IFRS as 
adopted by the European Union. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement of insurance products, 
the IFRS framework allows reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Group’s management 
determines appropriate measurement bases, to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, using 
their judgement and considering U.S. GAAP. 

84 
82

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
Directors’ report continued 

Corporate governance – compliance statement 

on pages 47 to 49.  

The Company’s compliance with the Code is summarised in the Corporate Governance section of this Annual Report and Accounts  

The Company confirms, in accordance with the principle of ‘comply or explain’, that the Board considers that the Company has complied 

with the principles and provisions as set out in the Code throughout the year ended 31 December 2017. With regard to the diversity policy  

for the Group and its implementation please see the report of the Nomination and Corporate Governance Committee, specifically page 56. 

Donations 

those shares. 

In June 2017 the Company made a cash donation of $702,358 to the Lancashire Foundation. 

The Foundation owns 330,713 common shares in the Company and during the 2017 calendar year received dividends of £39,090 declared on 

Lancashire established the Lancashire Foundation as a Bermuda charitable trust in 2007, with the aim of creating a trust for the benefit  

of charitable causes in Bermuda, the UK and worldwide. During 2012, the assets of the Lancashire Foundation were transferred to the 

Lancashire Foundation charitable trust established in England and Wales and registered with the Charity Commission. The Lancashire 

Foundation’s trustees are two senior employees and a subsidiary Non-Executive Director. The Trustees make donations following 

recommendations made by the Company’s Donations Committee consisting of some of the Group’s employees.  

A summary of the work of the Lancashire Foundation during 2017 can be found in the Corporate Responsibility section on pages 36 to 41. 

The Group did not make any political donations or expenditure during 2017 or 2016. 

Health and safety 

The Group considers the health and safety of its employees to be a management responsibility equal to that of any other function.  

The Group operates in compliance with health and safety legislative requirements in Bermuda and the UK. 

The Group’s greenhouse gas emissions are detailed in the Corporate Responsibility section on page 39. 

Greenhouse gas emissions 

Employees 

The Group is an equal opportunity employer, and does not tolerate unfair discrimination, bullying or harassment of any kind in any area  

of employment or corporate life. The Group believes that education and training for employees is a continuous process and employees are 

encouraged to discuss training needs with their managers. The Group’s health and safety, equal opportunities, training and other policies, 

including labour standards, working conditions and benefits, are available to all employees in the staff handbook, which is available on the 

Group’s intranet and provided to all new staff during their induction. 

Creditor payment policy 

The Group aims to pay all creditors promptly and in accordance with contractual and legal obligations. 

Financial instruments and risk exposures  

Information regarding the Group’s risk exposures is included in the ERM report on pages 31 to 33 and in the risk disclosures section  

on pages 100 to 125 of the consolidated financial statements. The Group’s use of derivative financial instruments can be found on  

pages 114 to 116. 

Accounting standards 

The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted under IFRS as 

adopted by the European Union. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement of insurance products, 

the IFRS framework allows reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Group’s management 

determines appropriate measurement bases, to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, using 

their judgement and considering U.S. GAAP. 

Annual General Meeting 
The notice of the 2018 AGM, to be held on 2 May 2018 at the Company’s head office, 29th Floor, 20 Fenchurch Street, London EC3M 3BY, 
UK, is contained in a separate circular to shareholders which is made available to shareholders at the same time as this Annual Report and 
Accounts. The notice of the AGM is also available on the Company’s website. 

Electronic and web communications 
Provisions of the Bermuda Companies Act 1981 enable companies to communicate with shareholders by electronic and/or website 
communications. The Company will notify shareholders (either in writing or by other permitted means) when a relevant document  
or other information is placed on the website and a shareholder may request a hard copy version of the document or information. 

Going concern and viability statement 
The Business Review section on pages 24 to 30 sets out details of the Group’s financial performance, capital management, business 
environment and outlook. In addition, further discussion of the principal risks and material uncertainties affecting the Group can be found 
on pages 34 and 35. Starting on page 100, the risk disclosures section of the consolidated financial statements sets out the principal risks to 
which the Group is exposed, including insurance, market, liquidity, credit, operational and strategic, together with the Group’s policies for 
monitoring, managing and mitigating its exposures to these risks. The Board considers annually and on a rolling basis a three-year strategic 
plan for the business which the Company progressively implements via a detailed three-year business plan considered by the Board at the 
November and February meetings. A three-year plan period aligns to the short-tail nature of the Group’s liabilities and the agility in the 
business model, allowing the Group to adapt capital and solvency quickly in response to market cycles, events and opportunities. This is 
consistent with the outlook period in the Group’s 2018 ORSA report. The three-year strategic plan was last approved by the Board in July 
2017 and the detailed business plan was approved by the Board at the November 2017 meeting. The Board receives quarterly reports from 
the Group CRO and sets, approves and monitors risk tolerances for the business. The Board will receive the Group’s 2018 ORSA report 
during the first quarter 2018 for review and challenge. 

During 2017, the Board carried out a robust assessment of the principal risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its 
business model, future performance, solvency or liquidity. As part of this assessment the business plan was stressed for a number of scenarios 
and the impact on capital (on both an IFRS and Solvency II basis) evaluated. The Directors believe that the Group is well placed to manage 
its business risks successfully, having taken into account the current economic outlook. Accordingly, the Board believes that, taking into 
account the Group’s current position, and subject to the principal risks faced by the business, the Group will be able to continue in operation 
and to meet its liabilities as they fall due for the period up to 31 December 2020, being the period considered under the Group’s current 
three-year business plan and the Group’s 2018 ORSA report. 

The Directors have a reasonable expectation that the Company will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due 
over the period to 31 December 2020. Accordingly, the Board has adopted and continues to consider appropriate the going concern basis in 
preparing the Annual Report and Accounts. 

Auditors 
Resolutions will be proposed at the Company’s 2018 AGM to re-appoint KPMG LLP as the Company’s auditors and to authorise the Directors 
to set the auditors’ remuneration. 

Disclosure of information to the auditors 
Each of the persons who is a Director at the date of approval of this Annual Report and Accounts confirms that: 

•  so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the Company’s auditors are unaware; and  
•  the Director has taken all the steps that he or she ought to have taken as a Director in order to make himself or herself aware of any 

relevant audit information and to establish that the Company’s auditors are aware of that information. 

Approved by the Board of Directors and signed on behalf of the Board. 

Christopher Head 
Company Secretary 

14 February 2018 

84 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

85 
83

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
Statement of Directors’ responsibilities 

The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and Accounts and the Group’s consolidated financial statements in 
accordance with applicable law and regulations. 

Company law requires the Directors to prepare financial statements for each financial year that give a true and fair view of the state of  
affairs of the Group and of the profit or loss of the Group for that year. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in 
accordance with IFRS. Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement of insurance products, U.S. 
GAAP is considered. Further detail on the basis of preparation is described in the consolidated financial statements. In preparing the 
consolidated financial statements, the Directors are required to: 

•  select suitable accounting policies and apply them consistently; 
•  make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable and prudent; 
•  state whether they have been prepared in accordance with IFRS; 
•  state whether applicable accounting standards have been followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the 

Group’s consolidated financial statements;  

•  provide additional disclosures where compliance with the specific requirements of IFRS are considered to be insufficient to enable users to 

understand the impact of particular transactions, events and conditions on the financial position and performance; and 

•  prepare the consolidated financial statements on the going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Group will 

continue in business. 

The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain the Group’s transactions and 
disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the Group, and enable them to ensure that the consolidated financial 
statements comply with applicable laws and regulations. They are also responsible for safeguarding the assets of the Group and hence for 
taking reasonable steps for the prevention and detection of fraud and other irregularities. 

Directors’ responsibility statement 
The Directors confirm that to the best of their knowledge: 

1.  the consolidated financial statements, prepared in accordance with IFRS, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial 

position and profit of the Group;  

2.  the Board considers the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, are fair, balanced and understandable and provide  

the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and performance, business model and strategy; and  

3.  the Strategy and the Business Review sections of this Annual Report and Accounts include a fair review of the development and 

performance of the business and the position of the Group, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that  
the Group faces. 

Legislation in Bermuda governing the preparation and dissemination of the consolidated financial statements may differ from legislation  
in other jurisdictions. In addition, the rights of shareholders under Bermuda law may differ from those for shareholders of companies 
incorporated in other jurisdictions. 

By order of the Board 

14 February 2018 

86 
84

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
Independent auditors’ report to the members of Lancashire Holdings Limited 

1  Our opinion is unmodified  
We have audited the consolidated financial statements of Lancashire Holdings Limited (“the Group”) for the year ended 31 December 2017 
which comprise the consolidated balance sheet as at 31 December 2017, the consolidated statements of comprehensive (loss) income, 
changes in shareholders’ equity and cash flows for the year then ended, and the related notes, including the accounting policies. 

In our opinion the consolidated financial statements:  

•  give a true and fair view of the state of the Group’s affairs as at 31 December 2017 and of its loss for the year then ended; and 
•  have been properly prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union.  

Basis for opinion  
We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (“ISAs (UK)”) and applicable law. Our responsibilities 
are described below. We have fulfilled our ethical responsibilities under, and are independent of the Group in accordance with, UK ethical 
requirements including the FRC Ethical Standard as applied to listed entities. We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is a 
sufficient and appropriate basis for our opinion.  

2  Key audit matters: our assessment of risks of material misstatement 
Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most significance in the audit of the consolidated financial 
statements and include the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) identified by us, including 
those which had the greatest effect on: the overall audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of the 
engagement team. These matters were addressed in the context of our audit of the consolidated financial statements as a whole, and in 
forming our opinion thereon, and we do not provide a separate opinion on these matters.  

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

85 
85

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
Independent auditors’ report to the members of Lancashire Holdings Limited continued 

In arriving at our audit opinion above, the key audit matters, in decreasing order of audit significance, were as follows: 

Valuation of gross and net insurance contract liabilities for losses and loss adjustment expenses  
($933.5m gross, $649.4m net; 2016: $679.8m gross, $543.1m net) 
Refer to page 51 (Audit Committee report), page 97 (accounting policy) and pages 140 to 142 (financial disclosures) 

Risk 

Response 

The Group maintains reserves to cover the estimated 
ultimate cost of settling all losses and loss adjustment 
expenses arising from events which have occurred up  
to the balance sheet date, regardless of whether those  
losses have been reported to the Group.  

  We have used our own actuarial specialists to assist us in performing our 

procedures in this area.  

Our procedures included: 

•  Methodology choice 

Subjective valuation 
The valuation of loss reserves is a complex process  
which requires the exercise of significant judgement. Key 
judgements relate to the assumptions applied in setting the 
estimates of both the gross and net liabilities that have been 
incurred but not reported, and assessing the evidence for 
the release or strengthening of provisions for claims.  

We also consider there to be greater judgement associated 
with reserves held for classes of business where losses tend 
to relate to low frequency high severity events, which limits 
the availability of historical loss data for use in calculating 
expected ultimate losses. For these classes in particular, 
there is a greater level of required judgement in estimating 
the initial expected loss ratios in the most recent 
underwriting years. 

Assessing and challenging the reserving methodology (on a gross basis and 
net of outwards reinsurance) based on our knowledge and understanding 
of the reserving policy within the Group. This has also involved comparing 
the Group’s reserving methodology with industry practice and 
understanding the rationale for key differences.  

•  Historical experience 

Challenging the quality of the Group’s historical reserving estimates by 
monitoring the development of losses against initial estimates. 

•  Independent re-performance 

Applying our own assumptions, across all classes of business, to perform re-
projections on the insurance contract liabilities for loss and loss adjustment 
expenses on both a gross and net basis and comparing these to the Group’s 
projected results. Where there were significant variances in the results, we 
have challenged the Group’s assumptions. Our independent re-projections 
focussed on classes of business where losses tend to relate to low frequency 
high severity events. 

•  Benchmarking assumptions  

Assessing and challenging the reserving assumptions by comparing  
the Group’s loss experience to peers in the market, on a gross and net  
basis, including on a contract by contract basis for large loss and  
catastrophe events.  

86 
86

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
 
 
Independent auditors’ report to the members of Lancashire Holdings Limited continued 

Risk 

Response 

The Group maintains reserves to cover the estimated 

  We have used our own actuarial specialists to assist us in performing our 

ultimate cost of settling all losses and loss adjustment 

procedures in this area.  

expenses arising from events which have occurred up  

to the balance sheet date, regardless of whether those  

losses have been reported to the Group.  

Our procedures included: 

•  Methodology choice 

Subjective valuation 

The valuation of loss reserves is a complex process  

which requires the exercise of significant judgement. Key 

judgements relate to the assumptions applied in setting the 

estimates of both the gross and net liabilities that have been 

incurred but not reported, and assessing the evidence for 

Assessing and challenging the reserving methodology (on a gross basis and 

net of outwards reinsurance) based on our knowledge and understanding 

of the reserving policy within the Group. This has also involved comparing 

the Group’s reserving methodology with industry practice and 

understanding the rationale for key differences.  

•  Historical experience 

the release or strengthening of provisions for claims.  

Challenging the quality of the Group’s historical reserving estimates by 

We also consider there to be greater judgement associated 

with reserves held for classes of business where losses tend 

•  Independent re-performance 

monitoring the development of losses against initial estimates. 

to relate to low frequency high severity events, which limits 

Applying our own assumptions, across all classes of business, to perform re-

the availability of historical loss data for use in calculating 

expected ultimate losses. For these classes in particular, 

projections on the insurance contract liabilities for loss and loss adjustment 

expenses on both a gross and net basis and comparing these to the Group’s 

there is a greater level of required judgement in estimating 

projected results. Where there were significant variances in the results, we 

the initial expected loss ratios in the most recent 

underwriting years. 

have challenged the Group’s assumptions. Our independent re-projections 

focussed on classes of business where losses tend to relate to low frequency 

high severity events. 

•  Benchmarking assumptions  

Assessing and challenging the reserving assumptions by comparing  

the Group’s loss experience to peers in the market, on a gross and net  

basis, including on a contract by contract basis for large loss and  

catastrophe events.  

In arriving at our audit opinion above, the key audit matters, in decreasing order of audit significance, were as follows: 

Valuation of gross and net insurance contract liabilities for losses and loss adjustment expenses  

($933.5m gross, $649.4m net; 2016: $679.8m gross, $543.1m net) 

Premiums which are estimated or earned based on non-standard profiles, included in gross premiums written  
(2017: $591.6m, 2016: $633.9m) 
Refer to page 51 (Audit Committee report), page 96 (accounting policy) and pages 102 to 106 (financial disclosures) 

Refer to page 51 (Audit Committee report), page 97 (accounting policy) and pages 140 to 142 (financial disclosures) 

Risk 

Subjective estimate 
Pricing for certain contracts is based on a best estimate of 
ultimate premiums as a result of premiums being based upon 
future events which are unknown at the balance sheet date. 
Judgement is involved in determining the ultimate estimates  
in order to establish the appropriate premium value and, 
ultimately, the cash to be received. As updated information  
is received over the life of the contract, adjustments are  
made to the premium recognised.  

There is also judgement required in determining the 
appropriate earnings profile to be applied to each contract, 
particularly where standard (straight line over the contract 
period) earning profiles are not applied. 

Response 

  Our procedures included: 

•  Control operation 

Testing the design, implementation and operating effectiveness of  
key controls over the periodic review of premium estimates booked. 

•  Historical comparisons 

Performing procedures to understand the development of estimated 
premium income by comparing the Group’s estimated premium 
income to actual premium income once received and verifying  
actual premium income back to source documentation for a  
sample of policies. 

•  Assessing application 

Assessing the appropriateness of non-standard earnings profiles 
applied in the context of the type of contracts being written and 
practice across the market. 

3  Our application of materiality and an overview of the scope of our audit  
Materiality for the consolidated financial statements as a whole was set at $7.0 million, determined with reference to a benchmark of 
normalised profit before tax of $139.2 million, of which it represents 5.0 per cent. This was computed by averaging the last five years of profit 
before tax to allow for fluctuations in the business cycle.  

We agreed to report to the Audit Committee any corrected or uncorrected identified misstatements exceeding $0.3 million, in addition to 
other identified misstatements that warranted reporting on qualitative grounds. 

We subjected 8 of the 9 components, including the parent company, UK insurance company, Bermuda insurance company and Lloyd’s 
operations to full scope audits for group reporting purposes. Including the audit of the consolidation adjustments our scope covered  
100 per cent of gross premiums written, loss before tax and total assets.  

The work on 7 of the 8 components was performed by component auditors and the other one, which was the parent company, was 
performed by the Group audit team. The Group audit team instructed the component auditors, based in the UK and Bermuda, as to  
the significant areas to be covered, including the relevant risks detailed above and the information to be reported back. The Group audit 
team approved the component materialities, which ranged from $9,500 to $3.8 million having regard to the size and risk profile of the 
various components across the Group. The Group audit team visited all component locations in Bermuda and the UK. Video and telephone 
conference meetings were also held with these component auditors. At these visits and meetings, the findings reported to the Group audit 
team were discussed in more detail, and any further work required by the Group audit team was then performed by the component auditors.  

86 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

87 
87

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Independent auditors’ report to the members of Lancashire Holdings Limited continued 

4  We have nothing to report on going concern  
We are required to report to you if we have anything material to add or draw attention to in relation to the Directors’ statement on page 83 of 
the Annual Report and Accounts on the use of the going concern basis of accounting with no material uncertainties that may cast significant 
doubt over the Group’s use of that basis for a period of at least twelve months from the date of approval of the financial statements.  

We have nothing to report in this respect.  

5  We have nothing to report on the other information in the Annual Report and Accounts 
The Directors are responsible for the other information presented in the Annual Report and Accounts. Our opinion on the consolidated 
financial statements does not cover the other information and, accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion or, except as explicitly stated 
below, any form of assurance conclusion thereon.  

Our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether, based on our financial statements audit work, the 
information therein is materially misstated or inconsistent with the consolidated financial statements or our audit knowledge. Based solely on 
that work we have not identified material misstatements in the other information.  

Directors’ Remuneration Report  
In addition to our audit of the consolidated financial statements, the Directors have engaged us to audit the information in the Directors’ 
Remuneration Report that is described as having been audited, which the Directors have decided to prepare as if the Company were required 
to comply with the requirements of Schedule 8 to The Large and Medium-sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 
2008 (SI 2008 No. 410) made under the UK Companies Act 2006.  

In our opinion the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report to be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the UK 
Companies Act 2006, as if those requirements applied to the Company.  

Disclosures of principal risks and longer-term viability  
Based on the knowledge we acquired during our consolidated financial statements audit, we have nothing material to add or draw attention 
to in relation to:  

•  the Directors’ confirmation within the going concern and viability statement on page 83 that they have carried out a robust assessment of 
the principal risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its business model, future performance, solvency and liquidity;  

•  the Risk Disclosures describing these risks and explaining how they are being managed and mitigated; and  
•  the Directors’ explanation in the going concern and viability statement of how they have assessed the prospects of the Group, over what 

period they have done so and why they considered that period to be appropriate, and their statement as to whether they have a reasonable 
expectation that the Group will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the period of their assessment, 
including any related disclosures drawing attention to any necessary qualifications or assumptions.  

Corporate governance disclosures  
We are required to report to you if:  

•  we have identified material inconsistencies between the knowledge we acquired during our consolidated financial statements audit and  
the Directors’ statement that they consider that the Annual Report and Accounts taken as a whole is fair, balanced and understandable  
and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and performance, business model and strategy; or  

•  the section of the Annual Report and Accounts describing the work of the Audit Committee does not appropriately address matters 

communicated by us to the Audit Committee. 

We are required to report to you if the Corporate Governance Statement does not properly disclose a departure from the eleven provisions of 
the UK Corporate Governance Code specified by the Listing Rules for our review.  

We have nothing to report in these respects.  

88 
88

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
 
 
Independent auditors’ report to the members of Lancashire Holdings Limited continued 

4  We have nothing to report on going concern  

We are required to report to you if we have anything material to add or draw attention to in relation to the Directors’ statement on page 83 of 

the Annual Report and Accounts on the use of the going concern basis of accounting with no material uncertainties that may cast significant 

doubt over the Group’s use of that basis for a period of at least twelve months from the date of approval of the financial statements.  

We have nothing to report in this respect.  

5  We have nothing to report on the other information in the Annual Report and Accounts 

The Directors are responsible for the other information presented in the Annual Report and Accounts. Our opinion on the consolidated 

financial statements does not cover the other information and, accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion or, except as explicitly stated 

below, any form of assurance conclusion thereon.  

Our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether, based on our financial statements audit work, the 

information therein is materially misstated or inconsistent with the consolidated financial statements or our audit knowledge. Based solely on 

that work we have not identified material misstatements in the other information.  

In addition to our audit of the consolidated financial statements, the Directors have engaged us to audit the information in the Directors’ 

Remuneration Report that is described as having been audited, which the Directors have decided to prepare as if the Company were required 

to comply with the requirements of Schedule 8 to The Large and Medium-sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 

2008 (SI 2008 No. 410) made under the UK Companies Act 2006.  

In our opinion the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report to be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the UK 

Companies Act 2006, as if those requirements applied to the Company.  

6  Respective responsibilities  
Directors’ responsibilities  
As explained more fully in their statement set out on page 84, the Directors are responsible for: the preparation and fair presentation of the 
consolidated financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union; such 
internal control as they determine is necessary to enable the preparation of the consolidated financial statements that are free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error; assessing the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters 
related to going concern; and using the going concern basis of accounting unless they either intend to liquidate the Group or to cease 
operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.  

Auditors’ responsibilities  
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements as a whole are free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue our opinion in an auditors’ report. Reasonable assurance is a high level of 
assurance, but does not guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) will always detect a material misstatement when  
it exists. Misstatements can arise from fraud, other irregularities or error and are considered material if, individually or in aggregate, they 
could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis of the consolidated financial statements.  

Directors’ Remuneration Report  

A fuller description of our responsibilities is provided on the FRC’s website at www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities.  

7  The purpose of our audit work and to whom we owe our responsibilities  
This report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, in accordance with section 90 of the Bermuda Companies Act 1981 and  
the terms of our engagement. Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company’s members those matters we are 
required to state to them in an auditors’ report, and the further matters we are required to state to them in accordance with the terms agreed 
with the Company, and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone 
other than the Company and the Company’s members, as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed.  

Disclosures of principal risks and longer-term viability  

to in relation to:  

Based on the knowledge we acquired during our consolidated financial statements audit, we have nothing material to add or draw attention 

Rees Aronson  
for and on behalf of KPMG LLP, Statutory Auditor  
Chartered Accountants 

•  the Directors’ confirmation within the going concern and viability statement on page 83 that they have carried out a robust assessment of 

the principal risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its business model, future performance, solvency and liquidity;  

•  the Risk Disclosures describing these risks and explaining how they are being managed and mitigated; and  

•  the Directors’ explanation in the going concern and viability statement of how they have assessed the prospects of the Group, over what 

period they have done so and why they considered that period to be appropriate, and their statement as to whether they have a reasonable 

expectation that the Group will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the period of their assessment, 

including any related disclosures drawing attention to any necessary qualifications or assumptions.  

15 Canada Square 
London, E14 5GL  

14 February 2018 

Corporate governance disclosures  

We are required to report to you if:  

•  we have identified material inconsistencies between the knowledge we acquired during our consolidated financial statements audit and  

the Directors’ statement that they consider that the Annual Report and Accounts taken as a whole is fair, balanced and understandable  

and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and performance, business model and strategy; or  

•  the section of the Annual Report and Accounts describing the work of the Audit Committee does not appropriately address matters 

communicated by us to the Audit Committee. 

We are required to report to you if the Corporate Governance Statement does not properly disclose a departure from the eleven provisions of 

the UK Corporate Governance Code specified by the Listing Rules for our review.  

We have nothing to report in these respects.  

88 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

89 
89

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
 
 
 
 
 
Consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income

For the year ended 31 December 2017

Gross premiums written
Outwards reinsurance premiums
Net premiums written
Change in unearned premiums
Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded
Net premiums earned
Net investment income
Net other investment income
Net realised gains (losses) and impairments
Share of (loss) profit of associate
Other income
Net foreign exchange gains
Total net revenue
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable
Net insurance losses
Insurance acquisition expenses
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded
Other operating expenses
Equity based compensation
Total expenses
Results of operating activities
Financing costs
(Loss) profit before tax
Tax credit
(Loss) profit for the year
(Loss) profit for the year attributable to:
Equity shareholders of LHL
Non-controlling interests
(Loss) profit for the year
Other comprehensive income to be reclassified to profit or loss in subsequent periods
Net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments
Other comprehensive income
Total comprehensive (loss) income for the year
Total comprehensive (loss) income attributable to:
Equity shareholders of LHL
Non-controlling interests
Total comprehensive (loss) income for the year

Notes

2

2

2

2

3

3

3

15

22

2, 12

2, 12

2, 4

2, 4

5, 6, 20

6

7

8

3, 10

2017 
$m
591.6 
(193.6) 
398.0 
22.6 
7.3 
427.9 
30.5 
1.2 
9.1 
(9.4) 
17.2 
2.3 
478.8 
538.0 
(202.6) 
335.4 
120.7 
(5.1) 
83.6 
(0.4) 
534.2 
(55.4) 
17.5 
(72.9) 
2.3 
(70.6) 

(71.1) 
0.5 
(70.6) 

4.9 
4.9 
(65.7) 

(66.2) 
0.5 
(65.7) 

2016 
$m
633.9 
(175.2) 
458.7 
25.7 
3.7 
488.1 
29.8 
6.9 
(2.4) 
5.1 
20.5 
4.4 
552.4 
212.2 
(69.7) 
142.5 
135.1 
(3.0) 
98.5 
10.7 
383.8 
168.6 
18.2 
150.4 
3.9 
154.3 

153.8 
0.5 
154.3 

4.1 
4.1 
158.4 

157.9 
0.5 
158.4 

(Loss) earnings per share
Basic
Diluted

21

21

($0.36)
($0.36)

$0.77
$0.76

90

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Consolidated balance sheet

As at 31 December 2017

Assets
Cash and cash equivalents
Accrued interest receivable
Investments
Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants
Reinsurance assets
 – Unearned premiums on premiums ceded
 – Reinsurance recoveries
 – Other receivables
Other receivables
Corporation tax receivable
Investment in associate
Property, plant and equipment
Deferred acquisition costs
Intangible assets
Total assets
Liabilities
Insurance contracts
 – Losses and loss adjustment expenses
 – Unearned premiums
 – Other payables
Amounts payable to reinsurers
Deferred acquisition costs ceded
Other payables
Corporation tax payable
Deferred tax liability
Interest rate swap
Long-term debt
Total liabilities
Shareholders’ equity
Share capital
Own shares
Other reserves
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
Retained earnings
Total shareholders’ equity attributable to equity shareholders of LHL
Non-controlling interests
Total shareholders’ equity
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

Notes

9, 17

10, 11, 17

13

12

13 

13

11, 15

16

12

14

17

17

18

18

19

10

22

2017  
$m

2016  
$m

256.5 
6.1 
1,654.6 
297.9 

41.2 
284.1 
20.7 
42.4 
–
59.4 
2.6 
76.7 
153.8 
2,896.0 

933.5 
350.9 
40.7 
65.5 
2.5 
48.0 
2.8 
16.5 
2.0 
326.3 
1,788.7 

100.7 
(12.1) 
866.2 
(1.5) 
153.6 
1,106.9 
0.4 
1,107.3 
2,896.0 

308.8 
6.6 
1,648.4 
270.0 

33.9 
136.7 
16.5 
43.6 
1.1 
49.7 
5.3 
81.5 
153.8 
2,755.9 

679.8 
373.5 
37.4 
52.7 
0.4 
61.0 
–
18.7 
3.7 
320.9 
1,548.1 

100.7 
(23.2) 
881.6 
(6.4) 
254.6 
1,207.3 
0.5 
1,207.8 
2,755.9 

The consolidated financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 14 February 2018 and signed on its behalf by:

Peter Clarke 
Director/Chairman   

Elaine Whelan
Director/CFO

www.lancashiregroup.com

91

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
Consolidated statement of changes in shareholders’ equity

For the year ended 31 December 2017

Balance as at 31 December 2015
Total comprehensive income for the year
Shares donated to trust
Distributed by trust
Dividends on common shares
Dividends paid to minority interest holders
Equity based compensation – expense
Balance as at 31 December 2016
Total comprehensive (loss) for the year
Shares donated to trust
Distributed by trust
Dividends on common shares
Dividends paid to minority interest holders
Equity based compensation – credit
Balance as at 31 December 2017

Notes

18, 19, 22

18, 19

18 

22 

19 

18, 19, 22

18, 19

18

22

19 

Share capital  
$m
100.7
–
–
–
–
–
–
100.7
–
–
–
–
–
–
100.7

Own  
 shares  
$m
(30.4)
–
0.6
6.6
–
–
–
(23.2)
–
1.2
9.9
–
–
–
(12.1)

Other reserves  
$m
880.8
–
(0.6)
(9.5)
–
–
10.9
881.6
–
(1.2)
(13.8)
–
–
(0.4)
866.2

Accumulated 
other 
comprehensive 
loss  
$m
(10.5)
4.1
–
–
–
–
–
(6.4)
4.9
–
–
–
–
–
(1.5)

Shareholders’ 
equity 
attributable  
to equity 
shareholders 
of LHL  
$m
1,220.3
157.9
–
(2.9)
(178.9)
–
10.9
1,207.3
(66.2)
–
(3.9)
(29.9)
–
(0.4)
1,106.9

Retained 
earnings  
$m
279.7
153.8
–
–
(178.9)
–
–
254.6
(71.1)
–
–
(29.9)
–
–
153.6

Non-
controlling 
interests  
$m
0.5
0.5
–
–
–
(0.5)
–
0.5
0.5
–
–
–
(0.6)
–
0.4

Total 
shareholders’ 
equity  
$m
1,220.8
158.4
–
(2.9)
(178.9)
(0.5)
10.9
1,207.8
(65.7)
–
(3.9)
(29.9)
(0.6)
(0.4)
1,107.3

92

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Statement of consolidated cash flows

For the year ended 31 December 2017

Cash flows (used in) from operating activities
(Loss) profit before tax
Tax refunded (paid)
Depreciation
Interest expense on long-term debt
Interest and dividend income
Net amortisation of fixed maturity securities
Equity based compensation
Foreign exchange losses (gains)
Share of loss (profit) of associate
Net other investment income
Net realised (gains) losses and impairments
Net unrealised gains on interest rate swaps
Changes in operational assets and liabilities
 – Insurance and reinsurance contracts
 – Other assets and liabilities
Net cash flows (used in) from operating activities
Cash flows from investing activities
Interest and dividends received
Purchase of property, plant and equipment
Investment in associate
Purchase of investments
Proceeds on sale of investments
Net cash flows from investing activities
Cash flows used in financing activities
Interest paid
Dividends paid
Dividends paid to minority interest holders
Distributions by trust
Net cash flows used in financing activities
Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
Effect of exchange rate fluctuations on cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

Notes

2017  
$m

2016  
$m

(72.9) 
1.3 
1.8 
16.4 
(37.1) 
2.8 
(0.4) 
9.4 
9.4 
(1.2) 
(9.1) 
(1.7) 

52.0 
(9.4) 
(38.7) 

150.4 
(1.3) 
2.3 
15.6 
(38.5) 
5.0 
10.7 
(2.3) 
(5.1) 
(6.9) 
2.4 
(1.1) 

(71.7) 
(10.6) 
48.9 

37.6 
(0.6) 
(19.1) 
(1,196.1)
1,209.5
31.3 

38.4 
(0.4) 
2.9 
(1,214.0) 
1,341.8 
168.7 

(16.3) 
(29.9) 
(0.6) 
(3.9) 
(50.7) 
(58.1) 
308.8 
5.8 
256.5 

(15.4) 
(178.9) 
(0.5) 
(2.9) 
(197.7) 
19.9 
291.8 
(2.9) 
308.8 

5

7

6

15

3

3

22

18

9

www.lancashiregroup.com

93

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsAccounting policies

Summary of significant accounting policies
The basis of preparation, consolidation principles and significant accounting policies adopted in the preparation of these consolidated 
financial statements are set out below.

Basis of preparation
The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted under IFRS as 
adopted by the European Union.

Where IFRS is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement of insurance products, the IFRS framework allows 
reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Group’s management determines appropriate 
measurement bases, to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, using their judgement and 
considering U.S. GAAP. In the course of preparing the consolidated financial statements, no judgements have been made in the process  
of applying the Group’s accounting policies, other than those involving estimations as noted in the ‘Use of Estimates’ section below, that  
have had a significant effect on amounts recognised in the consolidated financial statements.

All amounts, excluding share data or where otherwise stated, are in millions of U.S. dollars.

While a number of new or amended IFRS and IFRIC standards have recently been issued, there are no standards issued that have had a 
material impact on the Group.

IFRS 15, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, is effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018. IFRS 15 will not have a 
material impact on the results and disclosures reported in the consolidated financial statements.

IFRS 17, Insurance Contracts, issued in May 2017, specifies the financial reporting for insurance contracts by an insurer. The new standard is 
effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2021 and will include a number of significant changes regarding the measurement 
and disclosure of insurance contracts both in terms of liability measurement and profit recognition. The Group will continue to assess the 
impact the new standard will have on its results and the presentation and disclosure thereof.

IFRS 9, Financial Instruments: Classification and Measurement, has been issued but is not yet effective, and therefore has not yet been  
adopted by the Group. The Group continues to apply IAS 39, Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement and classifies its fixed 
maturity securities, equity securities and hedge funds as AFS or FVTPL. The new standard is effective for annual periods beginning on or after 
1 January 2018, although it has been deferred for insurers until 1 January 2021 to align with the implementation date of IFRS 17. IFRS 9 is not 
expected to have a material impact on the results and disclosures reported in the consolidated financial statements.

The consolidated balance sheet of the Group is presented in order of decreasing liquidity.

Use of estimates
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires the Group to make estimates and assumptions that affect the 
reported and disclosed amounts at the balance sheet date and the reported and disclosed amounts of revenues and expenses during the 
reporting period. Actual results may differ materially from the estimates made.

The most significant estimate made by management is in relation to losses and loss adjustment expenses. This is discussed on page 96 and 97 
and also in the risk disclosures section from page 108. Estimates in relation to losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable are discussed  
on page 96.

Estimates are also made in determining the estimated fair value of certain financial instruments and equity compensation plans. The 
estimation of the fair value of financial instruments is discussed on pages 97 and 98 and in note 10. Management judgement is applied  
in determining impairment charges. The estimation of the fair value of equity based compensation awards granted is discussed in note 6. 

Intangible assets are recognised on the acquisition of a subsidiary. The fair value of intangible assets arising from the acquisition of a subsidiary 
is largely based on the estimated expected cash flows of the business acquired and the contractual rights of that business. The Group determines 
whether indefinite life intangible assets are impaired at least on an annual basis. This requires an estimation of the recoverable amount of the 
CGU to which the intangible assets are allocated. The assumptions made by management in performing impairment tests of intangible assets 
are subject to estimation uncertainty. Details of the key assumptions used in the estimation of the recoverable amounts of the CGU are 
contained in note 16.

94

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Basis of consolidation
The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries as at and for the year ended 
31 December 2017. Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date of acquisition, being the date on which the Group obtains control, and 
continue to be consolidated until the date when such control ceases. Intercompany balances, profits and transactions are eliminated. Control 
is achieved when the Group is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee and has the ability to affect 
those returns through its power over the investee.

The Group participates on two Syndicates at Lloyd’s, which are managed by the Group’s managing agent subsidiary. In view of the several 
liability of underwriting members at Lloyd’s, the Group recognises its proportion of all the transactions undertaken by the Syndicates in which 
it participates within its consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income. Similarly, the Group’s proportion of the Syndicates’ assets 
and liabilities has been reflected in its consolidated balance sheet. This proportion is calculated by reference to the Group’s participation  
as a percentage of each Syndicate’s total capacity for each year of account.

Subsidiaries’ accounting policies are generally consistent with the Group’s accounting policies. Where they differ, adjustments are made on 
consolidation to bring accounting policies in line.

Associate
Investments, in which the Group has significant influence over the operational and financial policies of the investee, are recognised at cost  
and thereafter accounted for using the equity method. Under this method, the Group records its proportionate share of income and loss  
from such investments in its consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income for the period. Adjustments are made to investment  
in associate accounting policies, where necessary, in order to be consistent with the Group’s accounting policies.

Foreign currency translation
The functional currency, which is the currency of the primary economic environment in which operations are conducted, for all Group 
entities is U.S. dollars. Items included in the financial statements of each of the Group’s entities are measured using the functional currency. 
The consolidated financial statements are also presented in U.S. dollars.

Foreign currency transactions are recorded in the functional currency for each entity using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of  
the transactions, or at the average rate for the period when this is a reasonable approximation. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated  
in foreign currencies are translated at period end exchange rates. The resulting exchange differences on translation are recorded in the 
consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income in profit or loss. Non-monetary assets and liabilities carried at historical cost and 
denominated in a foreign currency are translated at historic rates. Non-monetary assets and liabilities carried at estimated fair value and 
denominated in a foreign currency are translated at the exchange rate at the date the estimated fair value was determined, with resulting 
exchange differences recorded in the consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income in profit or loss.

Intangible assets
The cost of intangible assets acquired in a business combination is their fair value as at the date of acquisition. Following initial recognition, 
intangible assets are carried at cost less any accumulated amortisation and any accumulated impairment losses. The useful lives of intangible 
assets are assessed to be either finite or indefinite depending on the nature of the asset. Intangible assets with finite lives are amortised over 
their useful economic life and assessed for impairment whenever there is an indication that the intangible asset may be impaired. Intangible 
assets with indefinite useful lives are tested for impairment at least annually at the CGU level by comparing the net present value of the future 
earnings stream of the CGU to the carrying value of the intangible asset. Such intangible assets are not amortised. The useful life of an 
intangible asset with an indefinite life is reviewed annually to determine whether the indefinite life assessment continues to be supportable.

Goodwill
Goodwill is deemed to have an indefinite life and, after initial recognition, is measured at cost less any accumulated impairment losses. 
Goodwill is tested for impairment annually, or when events or changes in circumstances indicate that it might be impaired.

Syndicate participation rights
Syndicate participation rights purchased in a business combination are initially measured at fair value and are subsequently measured at cost 
less any accumulated impairment losses. Syndicate participation rights are considered to have an indefinite life as they will provide benefits 
over an indefinite future period and are therefore not subject to an annual amortisation charge. The value of the syndicate participation  
rights is reviewed for impairment at least annually, or when events or changes in circumstances indicate that it might be impaired.

www.lancashiregroup.com

95

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsAccounting policies continued

Insurance contracts
Classification
Insurance contracts are those contracts that transfer significant insurance risk at the inception of the contract. Contracts that do not transfer 
significant insurance risk are accounted for as investment contracts. Insurance risk is transferred when an insurer agrees to compensate a 
policyholder if a specified uncertain future event adversely affects the policyholder.

Premiums and acquisition costs
Premiums are first recognised as written at the later of a contract’s binding or inception date. The group writes both excess of loss and pro-rata 
(proportional) contracts. For the majority of excess of loss contracts, premiums written are recorded based on the minimum and deposit  
or flat premium, as defined in the contract. Subsequent adjustments to the minimum and deposit premium are recognised in the period in 
which they are determined. For pro-rata contracts and excess of loss contracts where no deposit is specified in the contract, premiums written 
are recognised based on estimates of ultimate premiums provided by the insureds or ceding companies. Initial estimates of premiums written 
are recognised in the period in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract is bound if later. Subsequent adjustments, 
based on reports of actual premium by the insureds or ceding companies, or revisions in estimates, are recorded in the period in which  
they are determined.

Premiums written are earned rateably over the term of the underlying risk period of the insurance contract, except where the period of risk 
differs significantly from the contract period. In these circumstances, premiums are recognised over the period of risk in proportion to the 
amount of insurance protection provided. The portion of the premium related to the unexpired portion of the risk period is reflected in 
unearned premiums.

Where contract terms require the reinstatement of coverage after an insured’s or ceding company’s loss, the estimated mandatory 
reinstatement premiums are recorded as premiums written when a specific loss event occurs. Reinstatement premiums are not recorded  
for losses included within the provision for IBNR that do not relate to a specific loss event.

Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants are recorded net of commissions, brokerage, premium taxes and other levies on 
premiums, unless the contract specifies otherwise. These balances are reviewed for impairment, with any impairment loss recognised as an 
expense in the period in which it is determined.

Acquisition costs represent commissions, brokerage, profit commissions and other variable costs that relate directly to the successful securing 
of new contracts and the renewing of existing contracts. They are generally deferred over the period in which the related premiums are 
earned to the extent they are recoverable out of expected future revenue margins. All other acquisition costs are recognised as an expense 
when incurred.

Outwards reinsurance
Outwards reinsurance premiums comprise the cost of reinsurance contracts entered into. Outwards reinsurance premiums are accounted  
for in the period in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract is bound if later. The provision for the reinsurers’ share  
of unearned premiums represents that part of reinsurance premiums ceded which are estimated to be earned in future financial periods. 
Unearned reinsurance commissions are recognised as a liability using the same principles.

Any amounts recoverable from reinsurers are estimated using the same methodology as for the underlying losses. The Group monitors the 
creditworthiness of its reinsurers on an ongoing basis and assesses any reinsurance assets for impairment, with any impairment loss recognised 
as an expense in the period in which it is determined.

Losses
Losses comprise losses and loss adjustment expenses paid in the period and changes in the provision for outstanding losses and ACR, 
including the provision for IBNR and related expenses. Losses and loss adjustment expenses are charged to income as they are incurred.

A portion of the Group’s business is in classes with high attachment points of coverage, including property catastrophe excess of loss. 
Reserving for losses in such programmes is inherently complicated in that losses in excess of the attachment level of the Group’s policies are 
characterised by high severity and low frequency and other factors which could vary significantly as losses are settled. This limits the volume  
of industry loss experience available from which to reliably predict ultimate losses following a loss event.

96

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Losses and loss adjustment expenses represent the estimated ultimate cost of settling all losses and loss adjustment expenses arising from 
events which have occurred up to the balance sheet date, including a provision for IBNR. The Group does not discount its liabilities for  
unpaid losses. Outstanding losses are initially set on the basis of reports of losses received from third parties. ACRs are determined where the 
Group’s best estimate of the reported loss is greater than that reported. Estimated IBNR reserves may also consist of a provision for additional 
development in excess of losses reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for losses which have occurred but which have 
not yet been reported by insureds or ceding companies. IBNR reserves are set on a best estimate basis and are estimated by management using 
various actuarial methods as well as a combination of the Group’s own loss experience, historical insurance industry loss experience, 
underwriters’ experience, estimates of pricing adequacy trends and management’s professional judgement.

The estimation of the ultimate liability arising is a complex process which incorporates a significant amount of judgement. It is reasonably 
possible that uncertainties inherent in the reserving process, delays in insureds or ceding companies reporting losses to the Group, together 
with the potential for unforeseen adverse developments, could lead to a material change in losses and loss adjustment expenses.

Liability adequacy tests
At each balance sheet date, the Group performs a liability adequacy test using current best estimates of future cash outflows generated by its 
insurance contracts, plus any investment income thereon. If, as a result of these tests, the carrying amount of the Group’s insurance liabilities is 
found to be inadequate, the deficiency is charged to income for the period, initially by writing off deferred acquisition costs and subsequently 
by establishing a provision.

Financial instruments
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents are carried in the consolidated balance sheet at amortised cost and include cash in hand, deposits held on call  
with banks and other short-term highly liquid investments with a maturity of three months or less at the date of purchase. Carrying amounts 
approximate fair value due to the short-term nature and high liquidity of the instruments.

Interest income earned on cash and cash equivalents is recognised on the effective interest rate method. The carrying value of accrued interest 
income approximates estimated fair value due to its short-term nature and high liquidity.

Investments
The Group’s fixed maturity and equity securities are quoted or unquoted investments that are classified as AFS or at FVTPL and are carried at 
estimated fair value. The classification of the Group’s financial assets is determined at the time of initial purchase and depends on the nature 
of the investment. A financial asset is classified at FVTPL if it is managed and evaluated on a fair value basis and if acquired principally for the 
purpose of selling in the short-term, or if it forms part of a portfolio of financial assets in which there is evidence of short-term profit taking. 
Equity securities classified as AFS are those that are neither classified as held for trading nor designated at FVTPL. Fixed maturity securities 
classified as AFS are those that are intended to be held for an indefinite period of time and that may be sold in response to needs for liquidity 
or in response to changes in market conditions.

The Group’s hedge funds are unquoted investments classified at FVTPL and are carried at estimated fair value. Estimated fair values are 
determined using a combination of the most recent NAVs provided by each fund’s independent administrator and the estimated performance 
provided by each hedge fund manager.

Regular way purchases and sales of investments are recognised at estimated fair value including, in the case of investments not carried  
at FVTPL, transaction costs attributable to the acquisition of that investment on the trade date and are subsequently carried at estimated  
fair value. The estimated fair values of quoted and unquoted investments are determined based on bid prices from recognised exchanges, 
broker-dealers, recognised indices or pricing vendors. Unrealised gains and losses from changes in the estimated fair value of AFS investments 
are included in accumulated other comprehensive loss in shareholders’ equity. Changes in estimated fair value of investments classified at 
FVTPL are recognised in current period net other investment income.

Investments are derecognised when the Group has transferred substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership. On derecognition of  
an AFS investment, previously recorded unrealised gains and losses are removed from accumulated other comprehensive loss in shareholders’ 
equity and included in current period profit or loss. Realised gains and losses are included in net investment income in the period in which 
they arise.

www.lancashiregroup.com

97

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsAccounting policies continued

Amortisation and accretion of premiums and discounts on AFS fixed maturity securities are calculated using the effective interest rate method 
and are recognised in current period net investment income. Interest income is recognised on the effective interest rate method. The carrying 
value of accrued interest income approximates estimated fair value due to its short-term nature and high liquidity. Dividends on equity 
securities are recorded as income on the date the dividends become payable to the holders of record.

The Group regularly reviews the carrying value of its AFS investments for evidence of impairment. An investment is impaired if its carrying 
value exceeds the estimated fair value and there is objective evidence of impairment to the asset. Such evidence would include a prolonged 
decline in estimated fair value below cost or amortised cost, where other factors, such as expected cash flows, do not support a recovery in 
value. If an impairment is deemed appropriate, the difference between cost or amortised cost and estimated fair value is removed from 
accumulated other comprehensive loss in shareholders’ equity and charged to current period profit or loss. Impairment losses on fixed 
maturity securities may be subsequently reversed through profit or loss while impairment losses on equity securities are not subsequently 
reversed through profit or loss.

Derivative financial instruments
Derivatives are classified as financial assets or liabilities at FVTPL and are recognised at estimated fair value on the date a contract is entered 
into, the trade date, and are subsequently carried at estimated fair value. Derivative instruments with a positive estimated fair value are 
recorded as derivative financial assets and those with a negative estimated fair value are recorded as derivative financial liabilities.

Derivative financial instruments include exchange-traded future and option contracts, forward foreign currency contracts, interest rate  
swaps, credit default swaps and interest rate swaptions. They derive their value from the underlying instrument and are subject to the same 
risks as that underlying instrument, including liquidity, credit and market risk. Estimated fair values are based on exchange or broker-dealer 
quotations, where available, or discounted cash flow models, which incorporate the pricing of the underlying instrument, yield curves and 
other factors. Changes in the estimated fair value of instruments are recognised in profit or loss. The Group does not currently hold any 
derivatives classified as hedging instruments. For discounted cash flow techniques, estimated future cash flows are based on management’s 
best estimates and the discount rate used is an appropriate market rate.

Derivative financial assets and liabilities are offset and the net amount is reported in the consolidated balance sheet only to the extent there  
is a legally enforceable right of offset and there is an intention to settle on a net basis, or to realise the assets and liabilities simultaneously. 
Derivative financial assets and liabilities are derecognised when the Group has transferred substantially all of the risks and rewards of 
ownership or the liability is discharged, cancelled or expired.

Other income
Fees are recognised in line with services provided. Profit commissions are recognised in line with the underlying performance. Contingent 
profit commissions due on open years of account are recognised when it is virtually certain that they will be realised.

Long-term debt
Long-term debt is recognised initially at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Thereafter it is held at amortised cost, with the 
amortisation calculated using the effective interest rate method. Derecognition occurs when the obligation has been extinguished.

Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment is carried at historical cost, less accumulated depreciation and any impairment in value. Depreciation  
is calculated to write off the cost over the estimated useful economic life on a straight-line basis as follows:

IT equipment
Office furniture and equipment
Leasehold improvements

33% per annum
20% to 33% per annum
20% per annum

The assets’ residual values, useful lives and depreciation methods are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date.

An item of property, plant or equipment is derecognised on disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise from the 
continued use of the asset.

Gains and losses on the disposal of property, plant and equipment are determined by comparing proceeds with the carrying amount of the 
asset, and are included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income. Costs for repairs and maintenance are charged to profit 
or loss as incurred.

98

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Leases
Rentals payable under operating leases are charged to profit or loss on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

Employee benefits
Equity compensation plans
The Group currently operates an RSS under which nil-cost options have been granted. The fair value of the equity instruments granted  
is estimated on the date of grant. The estimated fair value is recognised as an expense pro-rata over the vesting period of the instrument, 
adjusted for the impact of any non-market vesting conditions. No adjustment to vesting assumptions is made in respect of market vesting 
conditions.

At each balance sheet date, the Group revises its estimate of the number of RSS nil-cost options that are expected to become exercisable.  
It recognises the impact of the revision of original estimates, if any, in the consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income, and a 
corresponding adjustment is made to other reserves in shareholders’ equity over the remaining vesting period.

On exercise, the differences between the expense charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income and the actual cost 
to the Group, if any, is transferred to other reserves.

Pensions
The Group operates a defined contribution plan. On payment of contributions to the plan there is no further obligation for the Group. 
Contributions are recognised as employee benefits in the consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income in the period when  
the services are rendered.

Tax
Income tax represents the sum of the tax currently payable and any deferred tax. The tax payable is calculated based on taxable profit for  
the period using tax rates and tax laws enacted or substantively enacted at the year end reporting date and any adjustments to tax payable  
in respect of prior periods. Taxable profit for the period can differ from that reported in the consolidated statement of comprehensive  
(loss) income due to non-taxable income and certain items which are not tax deductible or which are deferred to subsequent periods.

Deferred tax is recognised on all temporary differences between the assets and liabilities in the consolidated balance sheet and their tax base, 
except when the deferred tax liability arises from the initial recognition of goodwill. Deferred tax assets or liabilities are accounted for using 
the balance sheet liability method. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that realising the related tax benefit through future taxable 
profits is likely and are reassessed each year for recognition.

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets against current tax liabilities and 
when the deferred income taxes relate to the same fiscal authority.

Where the current estimated fair value of equity based compensation awards differs from the estimated fair value at the time of grant, adjusted 
where applicable for dividends, the related corporation tax and deferred tax charge or credit is recognised directly in other reserves.

Own shares
Own shares include shares repurchased under share repurchase authorisations and held in treasury, plus shares repurchased and held in  
trust, for the purposes of employee equity based compensation schemes. Own shares are deducted from shareholders’ equity. No gain or loss 
is recognised on the purchase, sale, cancellation or issue of own shares and any consideration paid or received is recognised directly in equity.

www.lancashiregroup.com

99

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures

Risk disclosures: Introduction
The Group is exposed to risks from several sources. These include insurance risk, market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk, operational risk and 
strategic risk. The primary risk to the Group is insurance risk.

The primary objective of the Group’s ERM framework is to ensure that the capital resources held are matched to the risk profile of the Group 
and that the balance between risk and return is considered as part of all key business decisions. The Group has formulated, and keeps under 
review, a risk appetite which is set by the Board of Directors. The Group’s appetite for risk will vary marginally from time to time to reflect the 
potential risks and returns that present themselves. However, protecting the Group’s capital and providing investors with a superior risk-
adjusted return over the long term are constants. The risk appetite of the Group is central to how the business is run and permeates into the 
risk appetites that the individual operating entity boards of directors have adopted. These risk appetites are expressed through detailed risk 
tolerances at both a Group and an operating entity level. Risk tolerances represent the maximum amount of capital, generally on a modeled 
basis, that the Group and its entities are prepared to expose to certain risks.

The Board of Directors is responsible for setting and monitoring the Group’s risk appetite and tolerances, whereas the individual entity  
boards of directors are responsible for setting and monitoring entity level risk tolerances. All risk tolerances are subject to at least an annual 
review and consideration by the respective boards of directors. The LHL Board and individual entity boards of directors review actual risk 
levels versus tolerances, emerging risks and any risk learning events at least quarterly. In addition, on at least a monthly basis, management 
reviews the output from SHARP in order to assess modeled potential losses against risk tolerances and ensure that risk levels are managed  
in accordance with them.

Economic capital model
The foundation of the Lancashire Companies’ risk-based capital approach to decision making is their economic capital model, BLAST, which 
is based on the widely accepted economic capital modeling tool, ReMetrica. Management uses BLAST primarily for monitoring its insurance 
risks. However, BLAST is also used to monitor other risks including market, credit and operational risks.

BLAST covers the risks for LICL, LUK and Kinesis but does not cover Cathedral’s risks. Due to the particular requirements of Lloyd’s 
regulations, Cathedral has its own internal model which is vetted by Lloyd’s as part of its own capital and solvency regulations. To formulate  
an overall Group view of risk, exposures from Cathedral are combined with LICL, LUK and Kinesis.

BLAST produces data in the form of a stochastic distribution for all classes, including non-elemental classes. The distribution includes the 
mean outcome and the result at various return periods, including very remote events. BLAST calculates projected financial outcomes for each 
insurance class, as well as the overall portfolio including diversification credit. Diversification credit arises as individual risks are generally not 
strongly correlated and are unlikely to all produce profits or losses at the same time. BLAST also measures the Group’s aggregate insurance 
exposures. It therefore helps senior management and the Board of Directors to determine the level of capital required to meet the combined 
risk from a wide range of categories. Assisted by BLAST, the Group seeks to achieve an improved risk-adjusted return over time.

BLAST is used in strategic underwriting decisions, as part of the Group’s annual business planning process, reforecasting and to assist in 
portfolio optimisation, taking account of inwards business and all major reinsurance purchases. Management also utilises BLAST in assessing 
the impact of strategic decisions on individual classes of business that the Group writes, or is considering writing, as well as the overall resulting 
financial impact to the Group. BLAST output, covering all of the risk groups to which the Group is exposed, is reviewed, including the 
anticipated loss curves, combined ratios and risk-adjusted profitability, to determine profitability and risk tolerance headroom by class.

The six primary risk categories, insurance risk, market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk, operational risk and strategic risk, are discussed in detail 
on page 101 to 125.

100

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

A. Insurance risk
The Group underwrites worldwide, predominantly short-tail, insurance and reinsurance contracts that transfer insurance risk, including  
risks exposed to both natural and man-made catastrophes. The Group’s exposure in connection with insurance contracts is, in the event of 
insured losses, whether premiums will be sufficient to cover the loss payments and expenses. Insurance and reinsurance markets are cyclical 
and premium rates and terms and conditions vary by line of business depending on market conditions and the stage of the cycle. Market 
conditions are impacted by capacity and recent loss events, and broader economic cycle impacts amongst other factors. The Group’s 
underwriters assess likely losses using their experience and knowledge of past loss experience, industry trends and current circumstances.  
This allows them to estimate the premiums sufficient to meet likely losses and expenses and desired levels of profitability consistent with  
the Group’s risk-adjusted RoE targets.

The Group considers insurance risk at an individual contract level, at a segment level, a geographic level and at an aggregate portfolio level. 
This ensures careful risk selection, limits on concentration and appropriate portfolio diversification are accomplished. The four principal 
classes of business for the Group, excluding the Lloyd’s segment, are Property, Energy, Marine and Aviation. These classes, plus the Group’s 
Lloyd’s segment, are deemed to be the Group’s five operating segments. The level of insurance risk tolerance per peril is set by the respective 
boards of directors at both the LHL and individual entity level.

A number of controls are deployed to manage the amount of insurance exposure assumed:

 • the Group has a rolling three-year strategic plan that helps establish the over-riding business goals that the Board of Directors aims  

to achieve;

 • a detailed business plan is produced annually, which includes expected premiums and combined ratios by class and considers risk-adjusted 

profitability, capital usage and requirements. The plan is approved by the Board of Directors and is monitored, reviewed and updated on an 
ongoing basis;

 • for Cathedral, the Syndicate business forecast and business plan are subject to review and approval by Lloyd’s;
 • BLAST, SHARP and Cathedral’s internal models are used to measure occurrence risks, aggregate risks and correlations between classes and 

other non-insurance risks, and the outputs and assumptions from BLAST and SHARP are reviewed periodically by the RRC;

 • each authorised class has a predetermined normal maximum line structure;
 • each underwriter has a clearly defined limit of underwriting authority;
 • the Group and individual operating entities have predetermined tolerances on probabilistic and deterministic losses of capital for certain 

single events;

 • risk levels versus tolerances are monitored on a regular basis;
 • a daily underwriting call is held for LICL and LUK to peer review insurance proposals, opportunities and emerging risks;
 • a daily post-binding review process with exception reporting to management based on underwriting authority operates at Cathedral;
 • sophisticated pricing and aggregation models are utilised in certain areas of the underwriting process, and are updated frequently;
 • BLAST and other modeling tools are deployed to model catastrophes and resultant losses to the portfolio and the Group; and
 • reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate both frequency and severity of losses on a treaty or facultative basis and to improve  

risk-adjusted RoE as modeled in BLAST.

Some of the Group’s business provides coverage for natural catastrophes (e.g. hurricanes, earthquakes, wildfires and floods) and is subject to 
potential seasonal variation. A proportion of the Group’s business is exposed to large catastrophe losses in North America, Europe and Japan 
as a result of windstorms. The level of windstorm activity, and landfall thereof, during the North American, European and Japanese wind 
seasons may materially impact the Group’s loss experience. The North American and Japanese wind seasons are typically June to November 
and the European wind season November to March. The Group also bears exposure to large losses arising from other non-seasonal natural 
catastrophes, such as earthquakes, tsunamis, droughts, floods and tornadoes, from risk losses throughout the year and from war, terrorism and 
political risk and other events. The Group’s associate bears exposure to catastrophe losses and any significant loss event could potentially result 
in impairment in the value of the Group’s investment in associate.

www.lancashiregroup.com

101

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

The Group’s exposures to certain peak zone elemental losses, as a percentage of tangible capital, including long-term debt, are shown below. 
Net loss estimates are before income tax and net of reinstatement premiums and outwards reinsurance. The exposure to catastrophe losses 
that would result in an impairment to the investment in associate is included in the figures below.

As at 31 December 2017
Zones
Gulf of Mexico1
Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S.
California
Pan-European
Japan
Japan
Pacific North West

(1) Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas.

As at 31 December 2016
Zones
Gulf of Mexico1
Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S.
California
Pan-European
Japan
Japan
Pacific North West

(1) Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas.

100 year return period  
estimated net loss

250 year return period  
estimated net loss

$m

% of tangible  
capital

$m

% of tangible  
capital

173.8 
140.9 
96.1 
77.2 
51.6 
46.6 
33.1 

13.6 
11.0 
7.5 
6.0 
4.0 
3.6 
2.6 

253.6 
306.5 
181.1 
125.1 
68.1 
85.6 
79.6 

19.8 
24.0 
14.2 
9.8 
5.3 
6.7 
6.2 

100 year return period  
estimated net loss

250 year return period  
estimated net loss

$m

% of tangible  
capital

$m

% of tangible  
capital

176.7 
156.1 
87.0 
69.0 
48.7 
48.6 
27.6 

12.9 
11.4 
6.3 
5.0 
3.5 
3.5 
2.0 

259.0 
326.1 
145.8 
115.7 
67.3 
114.3 
65.7 

18.8 
23.7 
10.6 
8.4 
4.9 
8.3 
4.8 

Perils
Hurricane
Hurricane
Earthquake
Windstorm
Typhoon
Earthquake
Earthquake

Perils
Hurricane
Hurricane
Earthquake
Windstorm
Typhoon
Earthquake
Earthquake

There can be no guarantee that the modeled assumptions and techniques deployed in calculating these figures are accurate. There could also 
be an unmodeled loss which exceeds these figures. In addition, any modeled loss scenario could cause a larger loss to capital than the 
modeled expectation.

Details of annual gross premiums written by geographic area of risks insured are provided below:

U.S. and Canada
Worldwide offshore
Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada1
Europe
Far East
Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada2
Middle East
Rest of world
Total

2017

2016

$m
177.6 
162.5 
98.6 
38.9 
27.9 
11.5 
6.9 
67.7 
591.6 

%
30.0 
27.5 
16.7 
6.6 
4.7 
1.9 
1.2 
11.4 
100.0 

$m
179.7 
161.1 
115.6 
46.9 
29.2 
15.4 
13.5 
72.5 
633.9 

%
28.4 
25.5 
18.2 
7.4 
4.6 
2.4 
2.1 
11.4 
100.0 

(1) Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area.
(2) Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area, but that 

specifically exclude the U.S. and Canada.

102

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Details of annual gross premiums written by business segment are provided below:

Lloyd’s
Property
Energy
Marine
Aviation
Total

2017

2016

$m
207.3 
198.0 
101.8 
67.6 
16.9 
591.6 

%
35.0 
33.5 
17.2 
11.4 
2.9 
100.0 

$m
215.0 
219.5 
126.0 
37.2 
36.2 
633.9 

%
33.9 
34.6 
19.9 
5.9 
5.7 
100.0 

Further details of the gross premiums written and the risks associated with each of these five principal business segments are described on the 
following pages.

I. Lloyd’s
Gross premiums written, for the year:

Property reinsurance
Property direct and facultative
Aviation and satellite
Marine cargo
Energy
Terrorism
Other
Total

2017  
$m
88.5 
56.1 
25.0 
22.5 
10.8 
4.4 
–
207.3 

2016  
$m
88.6 
56.1 
24.3 
21.2 
14.9 
6.3 
3.6 
215.0 

Property reinsurance predominantly includes property catastrophe excess of loss, property per risk excess of loss and property retrocession 
lines of business. Property catastrophe excess of loss and property per risk excess of loss provide protection for elemental and non-elemental 
risks and are written on an excess of loss treaty basis within the U.S. and internationally. The U.S. property catastrophe excess of loss book  
is particularly focused on regional clients. Property retrocession is written on an excess of loss basis through treaty arrangements. It provides 
coverage for elemental risks when sold on a catastrophe basis and both elemental and non-elemental risks when sold on a per risk retrocession 
basis. Protection is generally given on a regional basis and may cover specific property risks or all catastrophe perils. It is also generally written 
on an UNL basis, meaning loss payments are linked to the ceding company’s own loss.

Property direct and facultative is a worldwide book of largely commercial property business, written both in the open market and under 
delegated authorities. The account spans small individual locations to Fortune 500 accounts but with a bias towards small to medium sized 
risks. Policies are generally provided both for non-elemental and elemental perils, although not all risks include both elemental and non-
elemental coverage. Coverage is generally written on a full value, primary or excess of loss basis, although the very largest accounts are 
currently seldom written at the primary level.

Aviation and satellite includes aviation reinsurance, aviation war, general aviation and aviation satellite lines of business. Aviation reinsurance 
provides excess of loss catastrophe cover to the insurers of the world’s major airlines and aircraft and aircraft manufacturers. This includes 
cover for the aircraft themselves as well as losses arising from passenger and third-party liability claims against airlines and/or manufacturers. 
Aviation war covers loss or damage to aviation assets from war, terrorism and similar causes. General aviation covers fixed wing and rotor wing 
aircraft, typically with 50 passenger seats or less, and covers both commercial and private clients. A significant part of the aviation satellite 
account is written through SATEC, a specialist underwriting agency, to which underwriting authority is delegated. Satellite insurance is 
purchased by launch operators, satellite manufacturers and satellite operators to protect against launch or deployment failure or subsequent 
failure in orbit. Policies are typically written for launch plus one year in orbit. Thereafter, orbit cover is normally provided on an annual basis.

Marine cargo is an international account and is written either on a direct basis or by way of reinsurance. It covers the (re)insurance of 
commodities or goods in transit. Typically, transit cover is provided on an all-risks basis for marine perils for the full value of the goods 
concerned, although higher value or capacity business may be written on a layered basis. Static cover is also provided for losses to cargo,  
from both elemental and non-elemental causes, whilst static at points along its route. In addition, the cargo account can include specie  
and fine art, vault risks, artwork on exhibition and marine war business relating to cargo in transit.

www.lancashiregroup.com

103

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

Energy risks are written mostly on a direct basis and may be ground-up or for primary or excess layers on either a first loss or full value basis. 
Worldwide offshore energy policies are typically package policies which may include physical damage, well control, business interruption and 
third party liability sections. Coverage can include fire and explosion and elemental risks. Individual assets covered can be high-value and are 
therefore mostly written on a subscription basis, meaning that coverage is placed with multiple risk carriers. Construction energy contracts 
generally cover all risks of platforms, FPSO and drilling units under construction at yard and offshore, during towing and installation.  
Onshore construction contracts are generally not written.

Terrorism business can be written either ground-up or for primary or excess layers, with cover provided for U.S. and worldwide property risks, 
but typically excluding nuclear, chemical, biological and cyber coverage in most territories. Cover is generally provided to medium to large 
commercial and industrial enterprises. Policies are typically written for scheduled locations and exposure is controlled by setting limits on 
aggregate exposure within a ‘blast zone’ radius. The term of these contracts may be multi-year, reflecting the term of the underlying 
exposures. Reinsurance may be purchased on a facultative or treaty basis.

Reinsurance may be purchased to reduce the exposure to large risk losses and large natural catastrophe losses in the U.S., Canada and 
worldwide with certain exclusions. Reinsurance may also be purchased to mitigate an accumulation of smaller, attritional losses. Reinsurance 
may be purchased on a facultative, excess of loss treaty or proportional treaty basis.

II. Property
Gross premiums written, for the year:

Property catastrophe excess of loss
Terrorism
Property political risk
Property risk excess of loss
Property retrocession
Other property
Total

2017  
$m
101.9 
34.9 
31.1 
12.9 
10.0 
7.2 
198.0 

2016  
$m
99.8 
41.1 
44.1 
11.3 
12.8 
10.4 
219.5 

Property catastrophe excess of loss covers elemental risks and is written on an excess of loss treaty basis. The property catastrophe excess of loss 
portfolio is written within the U.S. and also internationally. Cover is offered for specific perils and regions or countries.

Terrorism business can be written either ground-up or for primary or excess layers, with cover provided for U.S. and worldwide property risks, 
but typically excluding nuclear, chemical, biological and cyber coverage in most territories. Cover is generally provided to medium to large 
commercial and industrial enterprises. Policies are typically written for scheduled locations and exposure is controlled by setting limits on 
aggregate exposure within a ‘blast zone’ radius. The term of these contracts is often multi-year reflecting the term of the underlying exposures. 
Some national pools are also written, which may include nuclear, chemical and biological coverage and may have an element of life coverage.

Property political risk cover is written either ground-up or on an excess of loss basis. Coverage that the Group provides in the political risk 
book is split between confiscation perils coverage and sovereign/quasi-sovereign obligor coverage. Confiscation perils coverage protects 
against CEND and may be extended to include other perils. Sovereign/quasi-sovereign obligors coverage protects against the non-payment  
or non-honouring of an obligation by a sovereign or quasi-sovereign entity. Cover is provided to medium to large commercial and industrial 
clients as well as bank and commodity trading clients. The term of these contracts is often multi-year reflecting the term of the underlying 
exposures. The Group does not provide cover against purely private obligor credit risk.

Property risk excess of loss is written on an excess of loss basis through UNL treaty arrangements, predominantly covering fire and allied perils 
in addition to natural catastrophe exposure. The portfolio is written on a worldwide basis, with particular focus on the U.S. market.

Property retrocession is written on an excess of loss basis through treaty arrangements and covers elemental risks. Cover may be on a 
worldwide or regional basis and may cover specific risks or all catastrophe perils. Coverage may be given on a UNL basis, meaning that loss 
payments are linked directly to the ceding company’s own loss, or on an ILW basis, meaning that loss payments are linked to the overall 
industry insured loss as measured by independent third-party loss index providers.

104

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The Group is exposed to large natural catastrophe losses, such as windstorm and earthquake losses, primarily from assuming property 
catastrophe excess of loss and property retrocession portfolio risks. Exposure to such events is controlled and measured by setting limits on 
aggregate exposures in certain classes per geographic zone and through loss modeling. The accuracy of the latter exposure analysis is limited 
by the quality of data and the effectiveness of the modeling. It is possible that a catastrophic event significantly exceeds the expected modeled 
event loss. The Group’s appetite and exposure guidelines for large losses are set out on pages 101 and 102.

Reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate exposures to large natural catastrophe losses in the U.S., Canada and worldwide with certain 
exclusions. Reinsurance may also be purchased to reduce the Group’s worldwide exposure to large risk losses. Reinsurance is typically 
purchased on an excess of loss basis, however ILWs or quota share arrangements may be entered into.

III. Energy
Gross premiums written, for the year:

Worldwide offshore energy
Gulf of Mexico offshore energy
Onshore energy
Energy liabilities
Construction energy
Other energy
Total

2017  
$m
66.6 
24.4 
3.5 
3.0 
(1.1) 
5.4 
101.8 

2016  
$m
88.7 
20.1 
4.9 
3.5 
4.8 
4.0 
126.0 

Energy risks are written mostly on a direct basis and may be ground-up or for primary or excess layers on either a first loss or full value basis. 
Worldwide offshore energy policies are typically package policies which may include physical damage, business interruption and third-party 
liability sections. Coverage can include fire and explosion and elemental risks. Individual assets covered can be high-value and are therefore 
mostly written on a subscription basis, meaning that coverage is placed with multiple risk carriers.

Gulf of Mexico offshore energy programmes cover elemental and non-elemental risks. Most policies have sub-limits on coverage for elemental 
losses. These programmes are exposed to Gulf of Mexico windstorms. Exposure to such events is controlled and measured through loss 
modeling. The accuracy of this exposure analysis is limited by the quality of data and the effectiveness of the modeling. It is possible that a 
catastrophic event significantly exceeds the expected modeled event loss. The Group’s appetite and exposure guidelines to large losses are  
set out on pages 101 and 102.

Onshore energy risks can include onshore Gulf of Mexico and worldwide energy installations and are largely subject to the same loss events as 
described above.

The Group writes energy liability business on a stand-alone basis. Unlike the liability contained within the energy packages that Lancashire 
writes, stand-alone energy liability is written on an excess of loss basis only. Coverage is worldwide and provides coverage for all kinds of 
damages and loss to third parties. Coverage is generally restricted to offshore assets.

Construction energy contracts generally cover all risks of platform and drilling units under construction at yards and offshore, during towing 
and installation. Onshore construction contracts are generally not written.

Reinsurance protection may be purchased to protect a portion of loss from elemental and non-elemental energy claims, and from the 
accumulation of smaller, attritional losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on an excess of loss basis but, from time to time, quota share 
arrangements may be entered into. Reinsurance may be purchased on a facultative or treaty basis.

www.lancashiregroup.com

105

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

IV. Marine
Gross premiums written, for the year:

Marine hull and total loss
Marine builders’ risk
Marine excess of loss
Marine P&I clubs
Marine hull war
Other marine
Total

2017  
$m
20.0 
13.9 
13.4 
10.1 
7.1 
3.1 
67.6 

2016  
$m
13.1 
8.7 
–
8.4 
4.1 
2.9 
37.2 

With the exception of the marine P&I clubs, where excess layers are written, most policies are written on a ground-up basis. Marine hull and 
total loss is generally written on a direct basis and covers marine risks on a worldwide basis, primarily for physical damage. Marine builders’  
risk covers the building of ocean-going vessels in specialised yards worldwide and their testing and commissioning. Marine excess of loss is 
written on a treaty basis and covers ocean and inland marine risks. Marine P&I clubs is mostly the reinsurance of the International Group of 
Protection and Indemnity Clubs and covers marine liabilities. Marine hull war is mostly direct insurance of loss of vessels from war, piracy or 
terrorist attack, with a very limited amount of facultative reinsurance.

The largest expected exposure in the marine class is from physical loss rather than from elemental loss events, although there is exposure to 
elemental perils and to the costs for removal of wreck.

Reinsurance may be purchased to reduce the Group’s exposure to both large risk losses and an accumulation of smaller, attritional losses. 
Reinsurance is typically purchased on a treaty excess of loss basis.

V. Aviation
Gross premiums written, for the year:

AV52
Aviation satellite
Other aviation
Total

2017  
$m
16.8 
(0.2) 
0.3 
16.9 

2016  
$m
24.0 
9.8 
2.4 
36.2 

AV52 is written on a risk attaching excess of loss basis and provides coverage for third-party liability, excluding own passenger liability, resulting 
from acts of war or hijack of aircraft. Cover excludes countries whose governments provide a backstop coverage, but does, since 2014, include 
some U.S. commercial airlines.

Aviation satellite cover is written on a full value, primary or excess of loss basis and can provide cover for satellite launch, satellite in-orbit or 
both satellite launch and in-orbit. The Lancashire companies stopped writing new satellite business in 2016.

Reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate exposures to an AV52 event loss. Reinsurance is typically purchased on a treaty excess of loss basis.

106

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Reinsurance
The Group, in the normal course of business and in accordance with its risk management practices, seeks to reduce certain types of loss  
that may arise from events that could cause unfavourable underwriting results, and to improve the modeled risk-adjusted RoE by entering into 
reinsurance arrangements. Reinsurance does not relieve the Group of its obligations to policyholders. Under the Group’s reinsurance security 
policy, reinsurers are assessed and approved as appropriate security based on their financial strength ratings, amongst other factors. The RSC 
considers reinsurers that are not rated or do not fall within the predefined rating categories on a case-by-case basis, and would usually require 
collateral to be posted to support such obligations. There are specific guidelines for these collateralised contracts. The RSC monitors its 
reinsurers on an ongoing basis and formally reviews the Group’s reinsurance arrangements at least quarterly.

Reinsurance protection is typically purchased on an excess of loss basis, however it may also include ILW covers or quota share arrangements. 
The mix of reinsurance cover is dependent on the specific loss mitigation requirements, market conditions and available capacity. Reinsurance 
may also be purchased to optimise the risk-adjusted return of the underwriting portfolio. The structure varies between types of peril and 
sub-class. The Group regularly reviews its catastrophe and other exposures and may purchase reinsurance in order to reduce the Group’s  
net exposure to a large natural catastrophe loss and/or to reduce net exposures to other large losses. The Group can purchase both facultative 
and treaty reinsurance with varying cover and attachment points. The reinsurance coverage is not intended to be available to meet all potential 
loss circumstances. The Group will retain some losses, as the cover purchased is unlikely to transfer the totality of the Group’s exposure.  
Any loss amount which exceeds the programme would be retained by the Group. Some parts of the reinsurance programme have limited 
reinstatements, therefore the number of claims which may be recovered from second or subsequent losses in those particular circumstances  
is limited.

Insurance liabilities
For most insurance and reinsurance companies, the most significant judgement made by management is the estimation of losses and loss 
adjustment expenses. The estimation of the ultimate liability arising from claims made under insurance and reinsurance contracts is a critical 
estimate for the Group, particularly given the nature of the business written.

Under GAAP, loss reserves are not permitted until the occurrence of an event which may give rise to a claim. As a result, only loss reserves 
applicable to losses incurred up to the reporting date are established, with no allowance for the provision of a contingency reserve to account 
for expected future losses or for the emergence of new types of latent claims. Claims arising from future events can be expected to require the 
establishment of substantial reserves from time to time. All reserves are reported on an undiscounted basis.

Losses and loss adjustment expenses are maintained to cover the Group’s estimated liability for both reported and unreported claims. 
Reserving methodologies that calculate a point estimate for the ultimate losses are utilised, and then a range is developed around these  
point estimates. The point estimate represents management’s best estimate of ultimate loss and loss adjustment expenses. The Group’s 
internal actuaries review the reserving assumptions and methodologies on a quarterly basis with loss estimates being subject to a semi-annual 
independent review by external actuaries. The results of the independent review is presented to the Group’s Audit Committee. The Group  
has also established Reserve Committees at the operating entity level, which have responsibility for the review of large claims and IBNR levels, 
their development and any changes in reserving methodology and assumptions.

The extent of reliance on management’s judgement in the reserving process differs as to whether the business is insurance or reinsurance, 
whether it is short-tail or long-tail and whether the business is written on an excess of loss or on a pro-rata basis. Over a typical annual period, 
the Group expects to write the large majority of programmes on a direct excess of loss basis. The Group does not currently write a significant 
amount of long-tail business.

Insurance versus reinsurance
Loss reserve calculations for direct insurance business are not precise in that they deal with the inherent uncertainty of assumptions  
regarding future reporting and development patterns, frequency and severity trends, claims settlement practices, potential changes in the  
legal environment and other factors, such as inflation. These estimates and judgements are based on numerous factors and may be revised  
as additional experience or other data becomes available or reviewed as new or improved methodologies are developed or as current laws  
or regulations change.

Furthermore, as a broker market reinsurer, management must rely on loss information reported to brokers by other insurers and their  
loss adjusters, who must estimate their own losses at the policy level, often based on incomplete and changing information. The information 
management receives varies by cedant and may include paid losses, estimated case reserves and an estimated provision for IBNR reserves. 
Additionally, reserving practices and the quality of data reporting may vary among ceding companies, which adds further uncertainty to  
the estimation of the ultimate losses.

www.lancashiregroup.com

107

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

Short-tail versus long-tail
In general, claims relating to short-tail risks, such as the majority of risks underwritten by the Group, are reported more promptly than those 
relating to long-tail risks, including the majority of casualty risks. However, the timeliness of reporting can be affected by such factors as the 
nature of the event causing the loss, the location of the loss, and whether the losses are from policies in force with insureds, primary insurers, 
reinsurers or vendor binding authorities.

Excess of loss versus proportional
For excess of loss contracts, which make up the majority of the Group’s business, management are aided by the fact that each policy has  
a defined limit of liability arising from one event. Once that limit has been reached, there is no further exposure to additional losses from  
that policy for the same event. For proportional business, an initial estimated loss and loss expense ratio is generally used. This is based upon 
information provided by the insured or ceding company and/or their broker and management’s historical experience of that treaty, if any, 
and the estimate is adjusted as actual experience becomes known.

Time lags
There is a time lag inherent in reporting from the original claimant to the primary insurer or binding authority holder to the broker and then 
to the reinsurer. Also, the combination of low claims frequency and high severity makes the available data more volatile and less useful for 
predicting ultimate losses. In the case of proportional contracts, reliance is placed on an analysis of a contract’s historical experience, industry 
information, and the professional judgement of underwriters in estimating reserves for these contracts. In addition, if available, reliance is 
placed partially on ultimate loss ratio forecasts as reported by insureds or cedants, which are normally subject to a quarterly or six-month lag.

Uncertainty
As a result of the time lag described above, an estimation must be made of IBNR reserves, which consist of a provision for additional 
development in excess of the case reserves reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for claims which have occurred  
but which have not yet been reported by insureds or ceding companies. Due to the degree of reliance that is necessarily placed on insureds or 
ceding companies for claims reporting, the associated time lag, the low frequency/high severity nature of much of the business that the Group 
underwrites, and the varying reserving practices among ceding companies, reserve estimates are highly dependent on management judgement 
and are therefore uncertain. During the loss settlement period, which may be years in duration, additional facts regarding individual claims 
and trends often will become known, and current laws and case law may change as well as regulatory directives, with a consequent impact  
on reserving.

For certain catastrophic events there are greater uncertainties underlying the assumptions and associated estimated reserves for losses and  
loss adjustment expenses. Complexity resulting from problems such as policy coverage issues, multiple events affecting one geographic area 
and the resulting impact on claims adjusting (including the allocation of claims to the specific event and the effect of demand surge on the 
cost of building materials and labour) by, and communications from, insureds or ceding companies, can cause delays to the timing with  
which the Group is notified of changes to loss estimates.

As at 31 December 2017, management’s estimates for IBNR represented 44.8 per cent of total net loss reserves (31 December 2016 – 34.6 per 
cent). The majority of the estimate relates to the recent catastrophe events during the latter part of 2017, in addition to potential claims on 
non-elemental risks where timing delays in insured or cedant reporting may mean losses could have occurred of which the Group was not 
made aware by the balance sheet date.

108

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

B. Market risk
The Group is at risk of loss due to movements in market factors. The main risks include:

i. 

Insurance risk;

ii.  Investment risk;

iii.  Debt risk; and

iv.  Currency risk.

These risks, and the management thereof, are described below.

I. Insurance risk
The Group is exposed to insurance market risk from several sources, including the following:

 • the advent or continuation of a soft market, which may result in a stabilisation or decline in premium rates and/or terms and conditions  

for certain lines, or across all lines;

 • the actions and reactions of key competitors, which may directly result in volatility in premium volumes and rates, fee levels and other  

input costs;

 • market events, including unusual inflation in rates, may result in a limit in the availability of cover, causing political intervention or  

national remedies;

 • failure to maintain broker, binding authority and client relationships, leading to a limited or substandard choice of risks inconsistent with 

the Group’s risk appetite;

 • changes in regulation including capital, governance or licensing requirements;
 • changes in the geopolitical environment including the UK’s impending exit from the EU and the implications for business passporting 

within the EEA; and

 • changes in U.S. tax legislation, which came into effect from 1 January 2018. The new rules introduce significant changes to the  

corporate tax regime. The most significant change to impact the global (re)insurance sector is the base erosion and anti-abuse tax.  
While the Lancashire Group has no U.S. affiliates, there may be wider implications as this provision will directly impact those foreign 
reinsurers that have significant intra-group reinsurance arrangements between U.S. and overseas affiliates.

The most important method to mitigate insurance market risk is to maintain strict underwriting standards. The Group manages insurance 
market risk in numerous ways, including the following:

 • reviews and amends underwriting plans and outlook as necessary;
 • reduces exposure to market sectors where conditions have reached unattractive levels;
 • purchases appropriate, cost-effective reinsurance cover to mitigate exposures;
 • closely monitors changes in rates and terms and conditions;
 • ensures through continuous capital management that it does not allow surplus capital to drive underwriting appetite;
 • holds a daily underwriting meeting for LICL and LUK to discuss, inter alia, market conditions and opportunities;
 • reviews all new and renewal business post-underwriting for Cathedral;
 • regularly reviews output from BLAST to assess up-to-date profitability of classes and sectors;
 • holds a quarterly Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee meeting to review underwriting strategy;
 • holds a fortnightly RRC meeting to monitor estimated exposures to peak zone elemental losses and RDSs; and
 • holds regular meetings with regulators.

Insurance contract liabilities are not directly sensitive to the level of market interest rates, as they are undiscounted and contractually  
non-interest bearing.

www.lancashiregroup.com

109

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

II. Investment risk
Movements in investments resulting from changes in interest and inflation rates and currency exchange rates, amongst other factors, may lead 
to an adverse impact on the value of the Group’s investment portfolio. Investment guidelines are established by the Investment Committee of 
the Board of Directors to manage this risk. Investment guidelines set parameters within which the Group’s external investment managers must 
operate. Important parameters include guidelines on permissible asset classes, duration ranges, credit quality, currency, maturity, sectors, 
geographical, sovereign and issuer exposures. Compliance with guidelines is monitored on a monthly basis. Any adjustments to the investment 
guidelines are approved by the Investment Committee and the Board of Directors.

The Group’s fixed maturity portfolios are managed by five external investment managers. The Group also has a diversified low volatility 
multi-strategy portfolio of hedge funds, and a small equity portfolio. The performance of the managers is monitored on an ongoing basis.

Within the Group guidelines is a subset of guidelines for the portion of funds required to meet near-term obligations and cash flow needs 
following an extreme event. The subset of guidelines adds a further degree of requirements, including fewer allowable asset classes, higher 
credit quality, shorter duration and higher liquidity. The primary objectives for this portion of assets are capital preservation and providing 
liquidity to meet insurance and other near-term obligations. In addition to cash managed internally, funds held in the investment portfolio  
to cover this potential liability are designated as the ‘core’ portfolio and the portfolio duration is matched to the duration of the insurance 
liabilities, within an agreed range. The core portfolio is invested in fixed maturity securities, fixed maturity funds and cash and cash 
equivalents. The core portfolio may, at times, contain assets significantly in excess of those required to meet insurance liabilities or other 
defined funding needs.

Assets in excess of those required to be held in the core portfolio are typically held in the ‘core plus’ or the ‘surplus’ portfolios. The core plus 
portfolio is invested in fixed maturity securities and cash and cash equivalents. The surplus portfolio is invested in fixed maturity securities, 
principal protected equity linked notes, derivative instruments, cash and cash equivalents, equity securities and hedge funds. In general,  
the duration of the surplus portfolio is slightly longer than the core or core plus portfolio.

The Group reviews the composition, duration and asset allocation of its investment portfolio on a regular basis in order to respond to changes 
in interest rates and other market conditions. If certain asset classes are anticipated to produce a higher return within management’s risk 
tolerance, an adjustment in asset allocation may be made. Conversely, if the risk profile is expected to move outside of tolerance levels, 
adjustments may be made to reduce the risks in the portfolio.

The investment portfolio is currently structured to perform better in a risk-on environment in order to mitigate the impact of a potential rise 
in interest rates. The Group endeavours to limit losses in risk-on, risk-off and interest rate hike scenarios. The Group models various periods  
of significant stress in order to better understand the investment portfolio’s risks and exposures. The scenarios represent what could, and most 
likely will occur (albeit not in the exact form of the scenarios, which are based on historic periods of volatility). The Group also monitors the 
portfolio impact of more severe disaster scenarios consisting of extreme shocks.

The IRRC meets quarterly to ensure that the Group’s strategic and tactical investment actions are consistent with investment risk preferences, 
appetite, risk and return objectives and tolerances. The IRRC also helps further develop the risk tolerances to be incorporated into the  
ERM framework.

110

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The investment mix of the fixed maturity portfolios is as follows:

As at 31 December 2017
 – Short-term investments
 – Fixed maturity funds
 – U.S. treasuries
 – Other government bonds
 – U.S. municipal bonds
 – U.S. government agency debt
 – Asset backed securities
 – U.S. government agency mortgage  

backed securities

 – Non-agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency commercial mortgage  

backed securities

 – Bank loans
 – Corporate bonds
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL
Total fixed maturity securities

As at 31 December 2016
 – Short-term investments
 – Fixed maturity funds
 – U.S. treasuries
 – Other government bonds
 – U.S. municipal bonds
 – U.S. government agency debt
 – Asset backed securities
 – U.S. government agency mortgage  

backed securities

 – Non-agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency commercial mortgage  

backed securities

 – Bank loans
 – Corporate bonds
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL
Total fixed maturity securities

Core

Core plus

Surplus

Total

$m
8.8 
31.0 
100.7 
16.4 
1.9 
17.1 
15.9 

8.4 
2.2 

–
–
168.7 
371.1 
–
371.1 

%
0.6 
2.1 
6.8 
1.1 
0.1 
1.2 
1.1 

0.6 
0.1 

–
–
11.4 
25.1 
–
25.1 

$m
98.7 
–
118.2 
13.4 
4.1 
34.5 
56.7 

22.4 
3.3 

0.2 
–
264.7 
616.2 
–
616.2 

%
6.7 
–
8.0 
0.9 
0.3 
2.3 
3.8 

1.5 
0.2 

–
–
18.0 
41.7 
–
41.7 

$m
3.6 
–
16.8 
41.6 
–
18.9 
71.4 

110.2 
7.7 

–
106.7 
88.0 
464.9 
25.7 
490.6 

%
0.2 
–
1.1 
2.8 
–
1.3 
4.8 

7.6 
0.5 

$m
111.1 
31.0 
235.7 
71.4 
6.0 
70.5 
144.0 

141.0 
13.2 

–
7.2 
6.0 
31.5 
1.7 
33.2 

0.2 
106.7 
521.4 
1,452.2 
25.7 
1,477.9 

Core

Core plus

Surplus

Total

$m
–
14.5 
120.6 
15.6 
0.6 
17.1 
13.4 

10.3 
4.5 

3.0 
–
151.6 
351.2 
–
351.2 

%
–
1.0 
8.1 
1.0 
–
1.2 
0.9 

0.7 
0.3 

0.2 
–
10.1 
23.5 
–
23.5 

$m
1.3 
–
158.2 
36.3 
–
34.9 
69.9 

30.5 
7.9 

2.9 
–
292.3 
634.2 
–
634.2 

%
0.1 
–
10.6 
2.4 
–
2.3 
4.7 

2.0 
0.5 

0.2 
–
19.5 
42.3 
–
42.3 

$m
4.0 
–
26.7 
14.7 
0.5 
29.9 
26.9 

77.5 
1.9 

3.7 
121.6 
153.4 
460.8 
51.6 
512.4 

%
0.3 
–
1.8 
1.0 
–
2.0 
1.8 

5.2 
0.1 

0.2 
8.1 
10.2 
30.7 
3.5 
34.2 

$m
5.3 
14.5 
305.5 
66.6 
1.1 
81.9 
110.2 

118.3 
14.3 

9.6 
121.6 
597.3 
1,446.2 
51.6 
1,497.8 

%
7.5 
2.1 
15.9 
4.8 
0.4 
4.8 
9.7 

9.7 
0.8 

–
7.2 
35.4 
98.3 
1.7 
100.0 

%
0.4 
1.0 
20.5 
4.4 
–
5.5 
7.4 

7.9 
0.9 

0.6 
8.1 
39.8 
96.5 
3.5 
100.0 

www.lancashiregroup.com

111

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

Bank loans, corporate bonds, fixed maturity securities at FVTPL and other government bonds by country are as follows:

Other  
 industries  
 $m
300.2 
13.6 
12.3 
10.4 
5.7 
3.5 
0.2 
2.6 
–
5.3 
0.3 
2.6 
–
0.7 
1.2 
3.1 
361.7 

Other  
 industries  
 $m
388.2 
10.3 
13.2 
17.7 
8.3 
4.0 
9.3 
0.5 
–
7.1 
–
4.8 
1.5 
–
–
4.2 
469.1 

Other  
government  
 bonds  
$m
–
19.3 
2.0 
6.3 
13.9 
5.1 
1.0 
–
5.1 
–
3.9 
–
4.2 
–
2.7 
7.9 
71.4 

Other  
government  
 bonds  
$m
–
2.0 
15.5 
7.4 
12.9 
–
4.2 
4.2 
–
–
5.3 
–
–
2.8 
2.4 
9.9 
66.6 

Total1
$m
483.6 
27.0 
27.8 
20.0 
10.9 
18.5 
14.7 
15.2 
6.9 
6.8 
2.4 
5.6 
–
4.2 
1.2 
9.0 
653.8 

Total1
$m
557.1 
51.8 
27.1 
34.1 
17.0 
27.4 
14.3 
7.1 
9.6 
8.9 
1.0 
4.8 
4.3 
–
–
6.0 
770.5 

Total2
$m
483.6 
46.3 
29.8 
26.3 
24.8 
23.6 
15.7 
15.2 
12.0 
6.8 
6.3 
5.6 
4.2 
4.2 
3.9 
16.9 
725.2 

Total2
$m
557.1 
53.8 
42.6 
41.5 
29.9 
27.4 
18.5 
11.3 
9.6 
8.9 
6.3 
4.8 
4.3 
2.8 
2.4 
15.9 
837.1 

As at 31 December 2017
United States
Canada
United Kingdom
Netherlands
Germany
France
Australia
Japan
Sweden
Luxembourg
Denmark
Switzerland
India
Spain
China
Other
Total

Financials  
$m
183.4 
13.4 
15.5 
9.6 
5.2 
15.0 
14.5 
12.6 
6.9 
1.5 
2.1 
3.0 
–
3.5 
–
5.9 
292.1 

(1) Includes bank loans, corporate bonds and fixed maturity securities at FVTPL.
(2) Includes bank loans, corporate bonds, fixed maturity securities at FVTPL and other government bonds.

As at 31 December 2016
United States
United Kingdom
Canada
Netherlands
Germany
Australia
France
Sweden
Japan
Luxembourg
Norway
Hong Kong
Switzerland
Russian Federation
Denmark
Other
Total

Financials  
$m
168.9 
41.5 
13.9 
16.4 
8.7 
23.4 
5.0 
6.6 
9.6 
1.8 
1.0 
–
2.8 
–
–
1.8 
301.4 

(1) Includes bank loans, corporate bonds and fixed maturity securities at FVTPL.
(2) Includes bank loans, corporate bonds, fixed maturity securities at FVTPL and other government bonds.

112

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The sector allocation of bank loans, corporate bonds and fixed maturity securities at FVTPL is as follows:

As at 31 December
Industrial
Financial
Utility
Supranationals
Total

2017

2016

$m
329.1 
289.5 
32.6 
2.6 
653.8 

%
50.3 
44.3 
5.0 
0.4 
100.0 

$m
425.4 
300.9 
43.7 
0.5 
770.5 

%
55.2 
39.1 
5.7 
–
100.0 

The Group’s net asset value is directly impacted by movements in the value of investments held. Values can be impacted by movements in 
interest rates, credit ratings, exchange rates and economic environment and outlook.

The Group’s investment portfolio is mainly comprised of fixed maturity securities and cash and cash equivalents. The fixed maturity funds are 
overseas deposits held by Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 in trust for the benefit of the policyholders in those overseas jurisdictions. They 
consist of high quality, short duration fixed maturity securities. The Group also has small equity and hedge fund portfolios. The estimated fair 
value of the Group’s fixed maturity portfolio is generally inversely correlated to movements in market interest rates. If market interest rates 
fall, the fair value of the Group’s fixed maturity securities would tend to rise and vice versa.

The sensitivity of the price of fixed maturity securities, and certain derivatives, to movements in interest rates is indicated by their duration. 
The greater a security’s duration, the greater its price volatility to movements in interest rates. The sensitivity of the Group’s fixed maturity  
and derivative investment portfolio to interest rate movements is detailed below, assuming linear movements in interest rates:

As at 31 December
Immediate shift in yield (basis points)
100
75
50
25
(25)
(50)
(75)
(100)

2017

$m

(28.5) 
(21.4) 
(14.3) 
(7.1) 
7.2 
14.4 
21.6 
28.8 

%

(1.9) 
(1.4) 
(1.0) 
(0.5) 
0.5 
1.0 
1.5 
1.9 

2016

$m

(28.7) 
(21.6) 
(14.4) 
(7.2) 
7.8 
15.6 
23.4 
31.2 

%

(1.9) 
(1.4) 
(1.0) 
(0.5) 
0.5 
1.0 
1.6 
2.1 

The Group mitigates interest rate risk on the investment portfolio by establishing and monitoring duration ranges in its investment guidelines. 
The Group may manage duration through the use of interest rate futures and swaptions from time to time. The duration of the core portfolio 
is matched to the modeled duration of the insurance reserves, within a permitted range. The permitted duration range for the core plus 
portfolio is between zero and four years and the surplus portfolio is between one and five years.

The total durations of the externally managed portfolios which are comprised of fixed maturity, cash and cash equivalents and certain 
derivatives, are as follows:

As at 31 December
Core portfolio
Core plus portfolio
Surplus portfolio1
Overall external portfolio1

(1) Including duration overlay.

2017  
years
1.7
1.7
2.0
1.8

2016  
years
1.6
1.8
2.2
1.9

The overall duration for fixed maturity, managed cash and cash equivalents and certain derivatives is 1.7 years (2016 – 1.8 years).

www.lancashiregroup.com

113

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

In addition to duration management, the Group uses VaR on a monthly basis to measure potential losses in the estimated fair values of its  
cash and invested assets and to understand and monitor risk. The VaR calculation is performed using variance/covariance risk modeling to 
capture the cash flows and embedded optionality of the portfolio. Securities are valued individually using standard market pricing models. 
These security valuations serve as the input to many risk analytics, including full valuation risk analyses, as well as parametric methods that  
rely on option-adjusted risk sensitivities to approximate the risk and return profiles of the portfolio.

The principal VaR measure that is produced is an annual VaR at the 99th percentile confidence level. Under normal conditions, the portfolio 
is not expected to lose more than the VaR metric listed in the table below, 99 per cent of the time over a one-year time horizon.

The Group’s annual VaR calculations are as follows:

As at 31 December
99th percentile confidence level1

(1) Including the impact of internal foreign exchange hedges.

2017

2016

% of  
shareholders’ 
equity
2.4 

$m
27.0 

% of  
shareholders’ 
equity
2.8 

$m
33.3 

Derivative financial instruments
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the investment managers to utilise exchange-traded futures and options contracts, and OTC 
instruments including interest rate swaps, credit default swaps, interest rate swaptions and forward foreign currency contracts. Derivatives are 
used for yield enhancement, duration management, interest rate and foreign currency exposure management or to obtain an exposure to a 
particular financial market. These positions are monitored regularly. The Group may also use OTC or exchange-traded managed derivatives 
to mitigate interest rate risk and foreign currency exposures. The Group principally has exposure to derivatives related to the following types 
of risks: foreign currency risk, interest rate risk and credit risk.

The Group currently invests in the following derivative financial instruments:

a.  Futures;

b.  Options;

c.  Forward foreign currency contracts; and

d.  Swaps.

The net losses on the Group’s derivative financial instruments recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income are  
as follows:

Net realised  
losses 
$m
(0.7) 
–
–
(0.7) 

Net realised  
losses  
$m
(2.1) 
–
–
(2.1) 

Net foreign  
exchange  
losses  
$m
–
(0.7) 
–
(0.7) 

Net foreign  
exchange  
losses  
$m
–
(1.8) 
–
(1.8) 

Financing  
losses  
$m
–
–
–
–

Financing  
losses  
$m
–
–
(1.0) 
(1.0) 

As at 31 December 2017
Treasury futures
Forward foreign currency contracts
Interest rate swaps
Total

As at 31 December 2016
Treasury futures
Forward foreign currency contracts
Interest rate swaps
Total

114

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The estimated fair values of the Group’s derivative instruments are as follows:

As at 31 December
Forward foreign currency contracts
Interest rate swaps
Total

Other  
investments  
$m
(0.5) 
–
(0.5) 

2017

Other  
receivables  
$m
1.6 
–
1.6 

Other  
payables  
$m
(0.1) 
–
(0.1) 

Interest  
rate swaps  
 $m
–
(2.0) 
(2.0) 

Other  
receivables  
$m
0.6 
–
0.6 

2016

Other  
payables  
$m
(0.6) 
–
(0.6) 

Interest  
rate swaps  
 $m
–
(3.7) 
(3.7) 

A. Futures
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the use of futures which provide the Group with participation in market movements, determined 
by the underlying instrument on which the futures contract is based, without holding the instrument itself or the individual securities. This 
approach allows the Group more efficient and less costly access to the exposure than would be available by the exclusive use of individual  
fixed maturity and money market securities. Exchange-traded futures contracts may also be used as substitutes for ownership of the  
physical securities.

All futures contracts are held on a non-leveraged basis. An initial margin is provided, which is a deposit of cash and/or securities in an  
amount equal to a prescribed percentage of the contract value. The fair value of futures contracts is estimated daily and the margin is  
adjusted accordingly with unrealised gains and/or losses settled daily in cash and/or securities. A realised gain or loss is recognised when  
the contract is closed.

Futures contracts expose the Group to market risk to the extent that adverse changes occur in the estimated fair values of the underlying 
securities. Exchange-traded futures are, however, subject to a number of safeguards to ensure that obligations are met. These include the use 
of clearing houses (thus reducing counterparty credit risk), the posting of margins and the daily settlement of unrealised gains and losses. The 
amount of credit risk is therefore considered low. The investment guidelines restrict the maximum notional futures position as a percentage of 
the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value.

As at 31 December, the Group had the following exposure to treasury futures:

As at 31 December
Treasury futures
Total

Notional  
long  
$m
100.1 
100.1 

2017

Notional  
short  
$m
103.5 
103.5 

Net notional  
long (short)  
$m
(3.4) 
(3.4) 

Notional  
long  
$m
76.4 
76.4 

2016

Notional  
 short  
 $m
104.1 
104.1 

Net notional  
long (short)  
$m
(27.7) 
(27.7) 

B. Options
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the use of exchange-traded options on U.S. treasury futures and Eurodollar futures, which are  
used to manage exposure to interest rate risk and also to hedge duration. Exchange-traded options are held on a similar basis to futures and 
are subject to similar safeguards. Options are contractual arrangements that give the purchaser the right, but not the obligation, to either buy 
or sell an instrument at a specific set price at a predetermined future date. The Group may enter into option contracts that are secured by 
holdings in the underlying securities or by other means which permit immediate satisfaction of the Group’s obligations. The notional  
amount of options is $nil as at 31 December 2017 and 2016.

The investment guidelines also restrict the maximum notional options exposure as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated  
fair value.

www.lancashiregroup.com

115

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

C. Forward foreign currency contracts
A forward foreign currency contract is a commitment to purchase or sell a foreign currency at a future date, at a defined rate. The Group  
may utilise forward foreign currency contracts to gain exposure to a certain currency or market rate or manage the impact of fluctuations  
in foreign currencies on the value of its foreign currency denominated investments, debt and/or insurance related currency exposures.

Forward contracts expose the Group to credit, market and liquidity risks. Credit risk arises from the potential inability of counterparties  
to perform under the terms of the contract. The Group is exposed to market risk to the extent that adverse changes occur in the exchange 
rate of the underlying foreign currency. Liquidity risk represents the possibility that the Group may not be able to rapidly adjust the size of  
its forward positions at a reasonable price in times of high volatility and financial stress. These risks are mitigated by requiring a minimum 
counterparty credit quality, restricting the maximum notional exposure as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value and 
restricting exposures to foreign currencies, individually and in aggregate, as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value.

The notional amount of a derivative contract is the underlying quantity upon which payment obligations are calculated. A long position is 
equivalent to buying the underlying currency whereas a short position is equivalent to having sold the underlying currency.

The Group has the following open forward foreign currency contracts:

As at 31 December
Canadian Dollar
Euro
Australian Dollar
Japanese Yen
Swedish Krona
Mexican Peso
Malaysian Ringgit
British Pound
Total

2017

2016

Notional  
long  
$m
–
24.0 
–
–
–
1.7 
4.9 
53.5 
84.1 

Notional  
short  
$m
26.9 
44.6 
7.2 
3.9 
3.0 
–
–
4.0 
89.6 

Net notional  
long (short)  
$m
(26.9) 
(20.6) 
(7.2) 
(3.9) 
(3.0) 
1.7 
4.9 
49.5 
(5.5) 

Notional  
long  
$m
–
–
–
–
–
–
2.7 
13.4 
16.1 

Notional  
 short  
 $m
29.8 
0.6 
–
–
2.7 
–
–
0.9 
34.0 

Net notional  
long (short)  
$m
(29.8) 
(0.6) 
–
–
(2.7) 
–
2.7 
12.5 
(17.9) 

D. Swaps
The Group’s investment guidelines permit the use of interest rate swaps and credit default swaps which are traded primarily OTC.

Interest rate swaps are used to manage interest rate exposure, portfolio duration or capitalise on anticipated changes in interest rate  
volatility without investing directly in the underlying securities. Interest rate swap agreements entail the exchange of commitments to pay  
or receive interest, such as an exchange of floating rate payments for fixed rate payments, with respect to a notional amount of principal. 
These agreements involve elements of credit and market risk. Such risks include the possibility that there may not be a liquid market, that  
the counterparty may default on its obligation to perform, or that there may be unfavourable movements in interest rates. These risks are 
mitigated through defining a minimum counterparty credit quality and a maximum notional exposure to interest rate swaps as a percentage 
of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value. The notional amount of interest rate swaps held in the investment portfolio is not material  
as at 31 December 2017 and 2016. Through the use of interest rate swaps, the Group has fixed the interest rate on Lancashire’s subordinated 
loan notes until December 2020. As at 31 December 2017 the notional amount of interest rate swaps held for hedging purposes was $125.8 
million (31 December 2016 – $122.3 million).

116

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

III. Debt risk
The Group has issued long-term debt as described in note 17. The LHL subordinated loan notes due in 2035 bear interest at a floating rate 
that is reset on a quarterly basis, plus a fixed margin of 3.70 per cent. The Group is subject to interest rate risk on the coupon payments of 
these subordinated loan notes. The Group has mitigated the interest rate risk on the LHL debt by entering into interest rate swap contracts  
on the following loan notes:

Subordinated loan notes $97.0 million
Subordinated loan notes €24.0 million

Maturity date
15 December 2035
15 June 2035

Interest hedged
100%
100%

The interest rate swaps expire on 15 December 2020, therefore until 2020 the Group has no cash flow interest rate risk on the LHL 
subordinated loan notes due in 2035.

The senior unsecured notes maturing 1 October 2022 bear interest at a fixed rate of 5.70 per cent and therefore the Group is not exposed to 
cash flow interest rate risk on this long-term debt.

On the acquisition of Cathedral, the Group assumed subordinated loan notes as described in note 17. The Group is subject to cash flow 
interest rate risk on the coupon payment of this long-term debt. An increase of 100 basis points on the EURIBOR and LIBOR three-month 
deposit rates would result in an increase in the interest expense on long-term debt for the Group of approximately $0.7 million on an  
annual basis.

IV. Currency risk
The Group underwrites from two locations, Bermuda and London, although risks are assumed on a worldwide basis. Risks assumed are 
predominantly denominated in U.S. dollars.

The Group is exposed to currency risk to the extent its assets are denominated in different currencies to its liabilities. The Group is also 
exposed to non-retranslation risk on non-monetary assets such as unearned premiums and deferred acquisition costs. Exchange gains and 
losses can impact profit or loss.

The Group hedges monetary non-U.S. dollar liabilities primarily with non-U.S. dollar assets, but may also use derivatives to mitigate foreign 
currency exposures. The Group’s main foreign currency exposure relates to its insurance obligations, cash holdings, investments, premiums 
receivable, dividends payable and the Euro denominated subordinated loan notes discussed in note 17. See page 116 for a listing of the 
Group’s open forward foreign currency contracts.

www.lancashiregroup.com

117

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

The Group’s assets and liabilities, categorised by currency at their translated carrying amount, are as follows:

Assets
Cash and cash equivalents
Accrued interest receivable
Investments
Inwards premiums receivable from insureds  
and cedants
Reinsurance assets
Other receivables
Investment in associate
Property, plant and equipment
Deferred acquisition costs
Intangible assets
Total assets as at 31 December 2017

Liabilities
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Unearned premiums
Insurance contracts – other payables
Amounts payable to reinsurers
Deferred acquisition costs ceded
Other payables
Corporation tax payable
Deferred tax liability
Interest rate swap
Long-term debt
Total liabilities as at 31 December 2017

U.S. $  
$m
158.1 
6.1 
1,538.2 

252.1 
331.9 
39.3 
59.4 
0.3 
55.2 
153.8 
2,594.4 

U.S. $  
$m
773.5 
259.7 
30.4 
62.8 
2.1 
30.8 
–
7.8 
0.2 
283.3 
1,450.6 

Sterling  
$m
16.9 
–
20.8 

13.4 
6.1 
2.5 
–
2.3 
6.5 
–
68.5 

Sterling  
$m
38.5 
20.7 
5.8 
1.5 
–
16.4 
2.8 
8.7 
–
–
94.4 

Euro  
$m
33.6 
–
82.1 

19.7 
6.1 
–
–
–
9.4 
–
150.9 

Euro  
$m
72.9 
37.9 
2.6 
1.0 
0.3 
0.7 
–
–
1.8 
43.0 
160.2 

Japanese Yen  
$m
11.7 
–
–

2.3 
–
–
–
–
0.9 
–
14.9 

Japanese Yen  
$m
8.6 
8.6 
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
17.2 

Other  
$m
36.2 
–
13.5 

10.4 
1.9 
0.6 
–
–
4.7 
–
67.3 

Other  
$m
40.0 
24.0 
1.9 
0.2 
0.1 
0.1 
–
–
–
–
66.3 

Total  
$m
256.5 
6.1 
1,654.6 

297.9 
346.0 
42.4 
59.4 
2.6 
76.7 
153.8 
2,896.0 

Total  
$m
933.5 
350.9 
40.7 
65.5 
2.5 
48.0 
2.8 
16.5 
2.0 
326.3 
1,788.7 

118

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Assets
Cash and cash equivalents
Accrued interest receivable
Investments
Inwards premiums receivable from insureds  
and cedants
Reinsurance assets
Other receivables
Corporation tax receivable
Investment in associate
Property, plant and equipment
Deferred acquisition costs
Intangible assets
Total assets as at 31 December 2016

Liabilities
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Unearned premiums
Insurance contracts – other payables
Amounts payable to reinsurers
Deferred acquisition costs ceded
Other payables
Deferred tax liability
Interest rate swap
Long-term debt
Total liabilities as at 31 December 2016

U.S. $  
$m
201.0 
6.6 
1,593.9 

235.4 
177.3 
41.1 
–
49.7 
0.6 
60.8 
153.8 
2,520.2 

U.S. $  
$m
548.8 
287.7 
27.0 
51.4 
0.4 
31.0 
7.8 
1.5 
283.3 
1,238.9 

Sterling  
$m
15.9 
–
14.8 

8.4 
5.3 
1.9 
1.1 
–
4.7 
6.5 
–
58.6 

Sterling  
$m
34.1 
19.8 
5.6 
0.9 
–
29.9 
10.9 
–
–
101.2 

Euro  
 $m
25.0 
–
27.4 

17.1 
3.5 
–
–
–
–
7.4 
–
80.4 

Euro  
$m
41.1 
34.6 
3.0 
0.4 
–
–
–
2.2 
37.6 
118.9 

Japanese Yen  
$m
14.0 
–
–

2.7 
0.3 
–
–
–
–
0.7 
–
17.7 

Japanese Yen  
$m
20.1 
7.4 
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
27.5 

Other  
$m
52.9 
–
12.3 

6.4 
0.7 
0.6 
–
–
–
6.1 
–
79.0 

Other  
$m
35.7 
24.0 
1.8 
–
–
0.1 
–
–
–
61.6 

Total  
$m
308.8 
6.6 
1,648.4 

270.0 
187.1 
43.6 
1.1 
49.7 
5.3 
81.5 
153.8 
2,755.9 

Total  
$m
679.8 
373.5 
37.4 
52.7 
0.4 
61.0 
18.7 
3.7 
320.9 
1,548.1 

The impact on net income of a proportional foreign exchange movement of 10.0 per cent up and 10.0 per cent down against the U.S. dollar 
at the year end spot rates would be an increase or decrease of $3.5 million (2016 – $1.5 million).

The Group uses forward foreign currency contracts for the purposes of managing currency exposures. See page 116 for details of the Group’s 
open forward foreign currency contracts.

www.lancashiregroup.com

119

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

C. Liquidity risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that cash may not be available to pay obligations when they are due without incurring an unreasonable cost. The 
Group’s main exposures to liquidity risk are with respect to its insurance and investment activities. The Group is exposed if proceeds from 
financial assets are not sufficient to fund obligations arising from its insurance contracts. The Group can be exposed to daily calls on its 
available investment assets, principally to settle insurance claims and to fund trust accounts following a large catastrophe loss.

Exposures in relation to insurance activities are as follows:

 • large catastrophic events, or multiple medium-sized events in quick succession, resulting in a requirement to pay a large value of claims 

within a relatively short time frame or fund trust accounts;

 • failure of insureds or cedants to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of premiums in a timely manner; and
 • failure of reinsurers to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of claims in a timely manner.

Exposures in relation to investment activities are as follows:

 • adverse market movements and/or a duration mismatch to obligations, resulting in investments being disposed of at a significant realised 

loss; and

 • an inability to liquidate investments due to market conditions.

The maturity dates of the Group’s fixed maturity portfolio are as follows:

As at 31 December 2017
Less than one year
Between one and two years
Between two and three years
Between three and four years
Between four and five years
Over five years
Asset backed and mortgage backed securities
Total fixed maturity securities

As at 31 December 2016
Less than one year
Between one and two years
Between two and three years
Between three and four years
Between four and five years
Over five years
Asset backed and mortgage backed securities
Total fixed maturity securities

Core  
$m
89.5 
102.7 
95.6 
18.8 
27.3 
10.7 
26.5 
371.1 

Core  
 $m
75.7 
108.7 
71.7 
26.3 
13.8 
23.8 
31.2 
351.2 

Core plus  
$m
211.0 
84.1 
103.1 
44.1 
49.4 
41.9 
82.6 
616.2 

Core plus  
$m
128.1 
164.0 
116.1 
62.8 
35.8 
16.2 
111.2 
634.2 

Surplus  
$m
12.6 
45.5 
27.2 
40.4 
48.9 
126.7 
189.3 
490.6 

Surplus  
 $m
47.8 
20.4 
32.4 
42.9 
75.6 
183.3 
110.0 
512.4 

Total  
$m
313.1 
232.3 
225.9 
103.3 
125.6 
179.3 
298.4 
1,477.9 

Total  
$m
251.6 
293.1 
220.2 
132.0 
125.2 
223.3 
252.4 
1,497.8 

120

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The maturity profile of the insurance contracts and financial liabilities of the Group is as follows:

As at 31 December 2017
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Insurance contracts – other payables
Amounts payable to reinsurers
Other payables
Interest rate swap
Long-term debt
Total

As at 31 December 2016
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
Insurance contracts – other payables
Amounts payable to reinsurers
Other payables
Interest rate swap
Long-term debt
Total

Balance sheet  
$m
933.5 
40.7 
65.5 
48.0 
2.0 
326.3 
1,416.0 

Balance sheet  
$m
679.8 
37.4 
52.7 
61.0 
3.7 
320.9 
1,155.5 

Years until liability becomes due – undiscounted values

Less than one  
$m
524.3 
37.5 
65.5 
48.0 
0.9 
15.1 
691.3 

One to three  
$m
265.6 
3.2 
–
–
1.1 
36.2 
306.1 

Three to five  
$m
88.0 
–
–
–
–
167.6 
255.6 

Years until liability becomes due – undiscounted values

Less than one  
$m
269.0 
34.4 
52.7 
61.0 
1.6 
14.0 
432.7 

One to three  
$m
255.2 
3.0 
–
–
1.8 
34.6 
294.6 

Three to five  
$m
90.6 
–
–
–
0.3 
36.8 
127.7 

Over five  
$m
55.6 
–
–
–
–
354.8 
410.4 

Over five  
$m
65.0 
–
–
–
–
496.5 
561.5 

Total  
$m
933.5 
40.7 
65.5 
48.0 
2.0 
573.7 
1,663.4 

Total  
$m
679.8 
37.4 
52.7 
61.0 
3.7 
581.9 
1,416.5 

Actual maturities of the above may differ from contractual maturities because certain borrowers have the right to call or prepay certain 
obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. While the estimation of the ultimate liability for losses and loss adjustment expenses  
is complex and incorporates a significant amount of judgement, the timing of payment of losses and loss adjustment expenses is also uncertain 
and cannot be predicted as simply as for other financial liabilities. Actuarial and statistical techniques, past experience and management’s 
judgement have been used to determine a likely settlement pattern.

The Group manages its liquidity risks via its investment strategy to hold high quality, highly liquid securities, sufficient to meet its insurance 
liabilities and other near-term liquidity requirements. The creation of the core portfolio with its subset of guidelines aims to ensure funds are 
readily available to meet potential insurance liabilities in an extreme event plus other near-term liquidity requirements. In addition, the Group 
has established asset allocation and maturity parameters within the investment guidelines such that the majority of the investments are in high 
quality assets which could be converted into cash promptly and at minimal expense. The Group monitors market changes and outlook and 
reallocates assets as deemed necessary.

www.lancashiregroup.com

121

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

D. Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk that a counterparty may fail to pay, or repay, a debt or obligation. The Group is exposed to credit risk on its fixed 
maturity investment portfolio and derivative instruments, its inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants, and on any amounts 
recoverable from reinsurers.

Credit risk on the fixed maturity portfolio is mitigated through the Group’s policy to invest in instruments of high credit quality issuers and to 
limit the amounts of credit exposure with respect to particular ratings categories and any one issuer. Securities rated below an S&P or equivalent 
rating of BBB-/Baa3 may comprise no more than 10.0 per cent of shareholders’ equity. In addition, no one issuer, with the exception of U.S. 
government and agency securities, other G10 government guaranteed securities (excluding Italy) and Australian sovereign debt should  
exceed 5.0 per cent of shareholders’ equity. The Group is therefore not exposed to any significant credit concentration risk on its investment 
portfolio, except for fixed maturity securities issued by the U.S. government and government agencies and other highly-rated governments.

Credit risk on exchange-traded derivative instruments is mitigated by the use of clearing houses to reduce counterparty credit risk,  
requiring the posting of margins and settling of unrealised gains and losses daily. Credit risk on OTC derivatives is mitigated by monitoring  
the creditworthiness of the counterparties and by requiring collateral amounts exceeding predetermined thresholds to be posted for  
positions which have accrued gains.

Credit risk on inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants is managed by conducting business with reputable broking 
organisations, with whom the Group has established relationships, and by rigorous cash collection procedures. The Group also has a broker 
approval process in place. Binding authorities are subject to standard market controls including credit control. Credit risk from reinsurance 
recoverables is primarily managed by the review and approval of reinsurer security, as discussed on page 107.

The table below presents an analysis of the Group’s major exposures to counterparty credit risk, based on their rating. The table includes 
amounts due from policyholders and unsettled investment trades. The quality of these receivables is not graded but, based on management’s 
historical experience, there is limited default risk associated with these amounts.

As at 31 December 2017
AAA
AA+, AA, AA-
A+, A, A-
BBB+, BBB, BBB-
Other1
Total

(1) Reinsurance recoveries classified as ‘other’ include $93.6 million of reserves that are fully collateralised.

As at 31 December 2016
AAA
AA+, AA, AA-
A+, A, A-
BBB+, BBB, BBB-
Other1
Total

(1) Reinsurance recoveries classified as ‘other’ include $5.6 million of reserves that are fully collateralised.

The counterparty to the Group’s long-term debt interest rate swaps is currently rated A by S&P.

Cash and  
fixed maturity 
securities  
 $m
368.0 
621.8 
403.7 
237.3 
103.6 
1,734.4 

Inwards premiums  
receivable and  
other receivables  
$m
–
–
69.5 
–
291.5 
361.0 

Cash and  
fixed maturity 
securities  
 $m
221.6 
735.8 
502.5 
231.7 
115.0 
1,806.6 

Inwards premiums  
 receivable and  
other receivables  
$m
–
–
84.5 
–
245.6 
330.1 

Reinsurance  
recoveries  
$m
–
2.7 
177.0 
–
104.4 
284.1 

Reinsurance  
 recoveries  
 $m
–
2.6 
126.4 
–
7.7 
136.7 

122

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The following table shows inwards premiums receivable that are past due but not impaired:

Less than 90 days past due
Between 91 and 180 days past due
Over 180 days past due
Total

2017  
$m
15.3 
5.3 
14.0 
34.6 

2016  
$m
12.3 
5.9 
16.1 
34.3 

Provisions of $2.4 million (2016 – $1.0 million) have been made for impaired or irrecoverable balances and $1.4 million (2016 – $1.2 million 
release) was charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income in respect of bad debts.

E. Operational risk
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes or systems. The Group and its subsidiaries  
have identified and evaluated their key operational risks and these are incorporated in the risk registers and modeled directly within the 
subsidiaries’ capital models. The Group has also established, and monitors compliance with, internal operational risk tolerances. The RRC 
reviews operational risk on at least an annual basis and operational risk is covered in the Group CRO’s quarterly ORSA report to the LHL 
Board and entity boards and in the Cathedral Risk, Capital and Compliance Committee reporting.

In order to manage operational risks, the Group has implemented a robust governance framework. Policies and procedures are documented 
and identify the key risks and controls within processes. The Group’s internal audit function provides independent feedback with regard  
to the accuracy and completeness of key risks and controls, and independently verifies the effective operation of these through substantive 
testing. All higher risk areas are subject to an annual audit while compliance with tax operating guidelines is audited quarterly. Frequency  
of audits for all other areas varies from quarterly at the most frequent to a minimum of once every four years, on a rotational basis.

F. Strategic risk
The Group has identified several strategic risks. These include:

 • the risks that either the poor execution of the business plan or an inappropriate business plan in itself results in a strategy that fails to 

adequately reflect the trading environment, resulting in an inability to optimise performance, including reputational risk;

 • the risks of the failure to maintain adequate capital, accessing capital at an inflated cost or the inability to access capital. This includes 
unanticipated changes in vendor, regulatory and/or rating agency models that could result in an increase in capital requirements or  
a change in the type of capital required; and

 • the risks of succession planning, staff retention and key man risks.

I. Business plan risk
The Group addresses the risks associated with the planning and execution of the business plan through a combination of the following:

 • an iterative annual forward-looking business planning process with cross departmental involvement;
 • evaluation and approval of the annual business plan by the Board of Directors;
 • regular monitoring of actual versus planned results;
 • periodic review and re-forecasting as market conditions change; and
 • feedback to senior management via the daily UMCC and fortnightly RRC meetings.

www.lancashiregroup.com

123

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsRisk disclosures continued

II. Capital management risk
The total capital of the Group is as follows:

As at 31 December
Shareholders’ equity
Long-term debt
Total capital
Intangible assets
Total tangible capital

2017  
$m
1,106.9 
326.3 
1,433.2 
(153.8) 
1,279.4 

2016  
$m
1,207.3 
320.9 
1,528.2 
(153.8) 
1,374.4 

Risks associated with the effectiveness of the Group’s capital management, are mitigated as follows:

 • regular monitoring of current and prospective regulatory and rating agency capital requirements;
 • regular discussion with the Cathedral management team regarding Lloyd’s capital requirements;
 • oversight of capital requirements by the Board of Directors;
 • ability to purchase sufficient, cost effective reinsurance;
 • maintaining contact with vendors, regulators and rating agencies in order to stay abreast of upcoming developments; and
 • participation in industry groups such as the International Underwriting Association, the Association of Bermuda Insurers and Reinsurers 

and the Lloyd’s Market Association.

The Group reviews the level and composition of capital on an ongoing basis with a view to:

 • maintaining sufficient capital for underwriting opportunities and to meet obligations to policyholders;
 • maximising the risk-adjusted return to shareholders within predetermined risk tolerances;
 • maintaining adequate financial strength ratings; and
 • meeting internal and regulatory capital requirements.

Capital is increased or returned as appropriate. The retention of earnings generated leads to an increase in capital. Capital raising can include 
debt or equity and returns of capital may be made through dividends, share repurchases, a redemption of debt or any combination thereof. 
Other capital management tools and products available to the Group may also be utilised. All capital actions require approval by the Board  
of Directors.

Internal methods have been developed to review the profitability of classes of business and their estimated capital requirements plus the capital 
requirements of the combination of a wide range of other risk categories. These approaches are used by management in decision making.

The Group’s aim is to provide its shareholders with an RoE of 13.0 per cent in excess of a risk-free rate over the longer term. The return  
is generated within a broad framework of risk parameters. The return is measured by management in terms of the IRR of the increase in 
FCBVS in the period adjusted for dividends accrued. This aim is a long-term goal, acknowledging that management expects both higher  
and lower results in the shorter term. The cyclicality and volatility of the insurance market is expected to be the largest driver of this pattern. 
Management monitors these peaks and troughs – adjusting the Group’s portfolio to make the most effective use of available capital and 
seeking to maximise the risk-adjusted return.

124

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

IRR achieved is as follows:

31 December 2016
31 December 2017

IRR achieved in excess of the three-month treasury yield is as follows:

31 December 2016
31 December 2017

Annual  
return  
%
13.5 
(5.9) 

Compound  
annual return  
%
18.4 
17.7 

Inception to  
date return  
 %
541.1 
608.2 

Annual  
return  
%
13.2 
(6.8) 

Compound  
annual return  
%
17.4 
16.7 

Inception to  
date return  
%
529.2 
595.2 

The primary source of capital used by the Group is equity shareholders’ funds and borrowings (note 17). As a holding company, LHL relies on 
dividends from its operating entities to provide the cash flow required for debt service and dividends to shareholders. The operating entities’ 
ability to pay dividends and make capital distributions is subject to the legal and regulatory restrictions of the jurisdictions in which they operate.

Under Solvency II the basis for assessing capital and solvency comprises a market-consistent economic balance sheet and an SCR, using  
either an internal model or the standard formula. Both the Group and LUK calculate their SCR using the standard formula. As the Group’s 
long-term debt is excluded from Solvency II capital (‘own funds’) both the Group’s and LUK’s Solvency II own funds are comprised entirely of 
Tier 1 items for the years ended 31 December 2017 and 31 December 2016. Tier 1 capital is the highest quality capital under Solvency II with 
the greatest loss absorbing capacity, comprising share capital and retained earnings. For the years ended 31 December 2017 and 2016 the 
Group and LUK were more than adequately capitalised under the Solvency II regime.

LICL is regulated by the BMA and is required to monitor its solvency capital requirement under the BMA’s regulatory framework, which is 
considered equivalent to the Solvency II regime. LICL’s capital requirement is calculated using the BSCR standard formula model. For the 
years ended 31 December 2017 and 2016, LICL was more than adequately capitalised under the BMA regulatory regime.

The Group’s underwriting capacity in its Lloyd’s syndicates must be supported by providing a deposit in the form of cash, securities or LOCs, 
which are referred to as FAL. The capital framework at Lloyd’s requires each managing agent to calculate the capital requirement for each 
syndicate they manage. Solvency II internal models are used to determine capital requirements for Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 based 
on the uSCR. Lloyd’s has the discretion to take into account other factors at syndicate or member level to uplift the calculated uSCR. This  
may include perceived deficiencies in the internal model result as well as the need to maintain Lloyd’s overall security rating. Currently,  
as a minimum, Lloyd’s applies a 35.0 per cent uplift to each syndicate’s uSCR to arrive at the Economic Capital Assessment (ECA).

Lloyd’s then uses each syndicate’s ECA as a basis for determining member level capital requirements, which is backed by FAL. For the  
2018 calendar year the Group’s corporate member’s FAL requirement was set at 66.5 per cent (2017 – 75.6 per cent) of underwriting capacity 
supported. The reduction was driven by a combination of factors including a change in categorisation of future reserves, improved reinsurance 
planning and actively reducing exposures to less profitable business. Further solvency adjustments are made to allow for open year profits  
and losses of the syndicates on which the corporate member participates. The Group has met its FAL requirement of £184.3 million as at  
31 December 2017 (31 December 2016 – £209.4 million).

For the years ended 31 December 2017 and 2016 the capital requirements of all the Group’s regulatory jurisdictions were met.

III. Retention risk
Risks associated with succession planning, staff retention and key man risks are mitigated through a combination of resource planning 
processes and controls, including:

 • the identification of key personnel with appropriate succession plans;
 • the identification of key team profit generators and function holders with targeted retention packages;
 • documented recruitment procedures, position descriptions and employment contracts;
 • resource monitoring and the provision of appropriate compensation, including equity based compensation which vests over a defined  

time horizon; and
 • training schemes.

www.lancashiregroup.com

125

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts

1. General information
The Group is a provider of global specialty insurance and reinsurance products with operations in London and Bermuda. LHL was 
incorporated under the laws of Bermuda on 12 October 2005. On 16 March 2009, LHL was added to the Official List and its common shares 
were admitted to trading on the main market of the LSE; previously LHL’s shares were listed on AIM, a subsidiary market of the LSE. Since 
21 May 2007, LHL’s shares have had a secondary listing on the BSX. LHL’s registered office is Power House, 7 Par-la-Ville Road, Hamilton  
HM 11, Bermuda. LHL’s head office is Level 29, 20 Fenchurch Street, London, EC3M 3BY, United Kingdom.

The consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2017 include the Company’s subsidiary companies, the Company’s 
interest in associate, and the Group’s share of the Syndicates’ assets and liabilities and income and expenses. A full listing of the Group’s 
related parties can be found in note 22.

2. Segmental reporting
Management and the Board of Directors review the Group’s business primarily by its five principal segments: Property, Energy, Marine, 
Aviation and Lloyd’s. These segments are therefore deemed to be the Group’s operating segments for the purposes of segmental reporting. 
Further sub-classes of business are underwritten within each operating segment. The nature of these individual sub-classes is discussed further 
in the risk disclosures section on pages 103 to 106. Operating segment performance is measured by the net underwriting profit or loss and the 
combined ratio.

All amounts reported are transactions with external parties and associates. There are no significant inter-segmental transactions and there are 
no significant insurance or reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in Bermuda, the Group’s country of domicile.

126

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Revenue and expense by operating segment

For the year ended 31 December 2017
Gross premiums written by geographic area
U.S. and Canada
Worldwide offshore
Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada1
Europe
Far East
Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada2
Middle East
Rest of world
Total
Outwards reinsurance premiums
Change in unearned premiums
Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded
Net premiums earned
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 
recoverable
Insurance acquisition expenses
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded
Net underwriting (loss) profit
Net unallocated income and expenses
(Loss) before tax
Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio
Combined ratio

Aviation  
$m

Lloyd’s  
$m

Total  
$m

Property  
$m

80.0 
0.2 
30.3 
23.1 
16.5 
6.0 
5.3 
36.6 
198.0 
(66.3)
11.6
3.2
146.5
(254.9)

87.3
(30.2)
2.6
(48.7)

Energy  
$m

4.7 
94.8 
2.5 
–
–
0.1 
–
(0.3)
101.8 
(45.1)
7.5
6.2
70.4
(34.7)

23.6
(32.4)
1.4
28.3

Marine  
$m

–
67.5 
–
–
–
–
–
0.1 
67.6 
(11.3)
(5.6)
–
50.7
(17.3)

0.6
(19.0)
0.6
15.6

–
–
16.9 
–
–
–
–
–
16.9 
(7.2)
4.4
(2.5)
11.6
1.6

0.6
(3.3)
0.1
10.6

92.9 
–
48.9 
15.8 
11.4 
5.4 
1.6 
31.3 
207.3 
(63.7)
4.7
0.4
148.7
(232.7)

90.5
(35.8)
0.4
(28.9)

114.4%
18.8%
–
133.2%

15.8%
44.0%
–
59.8%

32.9%
36.3%
–
69.2%

(19.0%)
27.6%
–
8.6%

95.6%
23.8%
–
119.4%

177.6 
162.5 
98.6 
38.9 
27.9 
11.5 
6.9 
67.7 
591.6 
(193.6)
22.6
7.3
427.9
(538.0)

202.6
(120.7)
5.1
(23.1)
(49.8)
(72.9) 
78.4%
27.0%
19.5%
124.9%

(1) Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area.
(2) Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area, but that 

specifically exclude the U.S. and Canada.

www.lancashiregroup.com

127

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

2. Segmental reporting continued
Revenue and expense by operating segment

For the year ended 31 December 2016
Gross premiums written by geographic area
U.S. and Canada
Worldwide offshore
Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada1
Europe
Far East
Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada2
Middle East
Rest of world
Total
Outwards reinsurance premiums
Change in unearned premiums
Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded
Net premiums earned
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 
recoverable
Insurance acquisition expenses
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded
Net underwriting profit
Net unallocated income and expenses
Profit before tax
Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio
Combined ratio

Property  
$m

84.0 
0.9 
23.5 
27.7 
20.0 
9.4 
11.5 
42.5 
219.5 
(62.2)
(15.0)
6.2 
148.5 
(14.6)

0.9
(29.4)
1.4 
106.8 

Energy  
$m

0.4 
123.4 
2.0 
–
–
0.1 
–
0.1 
126.0 
(40.2)
20.9
(1.2)
105.5 
(91.3)

49.8 
(48.2)
0.6 
16.4 

Marine  
 $m

Aviation  
$m

–
36.6 
–
–
–
–
–
0.6 
37.2 
(8.3)
6.6
(0.1) 
35.4 
(15.1)

0.3 
(10.2)
0.5 
10.9 

–
0.2 
36.0 
–
–
–
–
–
36.2 
(9.5)
0.6
(1.8) 
25.5 
1.1

0.1 
(8.1)
0.3 
18.9 

Lloyd’s  
$m

95.3 
–
54.1 
19.2 
9.2 
5.9 
2.0 
29.3 
215.0 
(55.0)
12.6
0.6
173.2 
(92.3)

18.6
(39.2)
0.2 
60.5 

9.2%
18.9%
–
28.1%

39.3%
45.1%
–
84.4%

41.8%
27.4%
–
69.2%

(4.7%)
30.6%
–
25.9%

42.6%
22.5%
–
65.1%

Total  
$m

179.7 
161.1 
115.6 
46.9 
29.2 
15.4 
13.5 
72.5 
633.9 
(175.2)
25.7
3.7 
488.1 
(212.2)

69.7 
(135.1)
3.0 
213.5 
(63.1)
150.4 
29.2%
27.1%
20.2%
76.5%

(1) Worldwide, including the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area.
(2) Worldwide, excluding the U.S. and Canada, comprises insurance and reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in more than one geographic area, but that 

specifically exclude the U.S. and Canada.

128

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

3. Investment return
The total investment return for the Group is as follows:

For the year ended 31 December 2017
Fixed maturity securities – AFS
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL
Equity securities – AFS
Hedge funds – at FVTPL
Other investments
Cash and cash equivalents
Total investment return

Net investment 
income and net  
other investment
income1
$m
28.6 
(1.0) 
–
1.1 
1.1 
1.9 
31.7 

Net realised  
gains (losses)  
and impairments  
 $m
(2.9) 
2.4 
0.8 
9.5 
(0.7) 
–
9.1 

Net change  
in unrealised  
gains/losses  
on AFS  
$m
2.1 
–
2.8 
–
–
–
4.9 

Total investment  
 return excluding  
 foreign exchange  
$m
27.8 
1.4 
3.6 
10.6 
0.4 
1.9 
45.7 

Net foreign  
exchange  
 gains (losses)  
$m
9.8 
–
–
–
(2.6) 
0.5 
7.7 

Total investment  
return including  
foreign exchange  
$m
37.6 
1.4 
3.6 
10.6 
(2.2) 
2.4 
53.4 

(1) Net unrealised gains/(losses) on our FVTPL investments are included within net investment income and net other investment income.

For the year ended 31 December 2016
Fixed maturity securities – AFS
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL
Equity securities – AFS
Hedge funds – at FVTPL
Other investments
Cash and cash equivalents
Total investment return

Net investment 
income and net  
other investment
income1
$m
28.4 
1.2 
0.3 
4.3 
1.4 
1.1 
36.7 

Net realised  
gains (losses)  
 and impairments  
$m
1.8 
–
(1.3) 
(0.8) 
(2.1) 
–
(2.4) 

Net change  
in unrealised  
gains/losses  
on AFS  
$m
3.7 
–
0.4 
–
–
–
4.1 

Total investment  
return excluding  
foreign exchange  
$m
33.9 
1.2 
(0.6) 
3.5 
(0.7) 
1.1 
38.4 

Net foreign  
exchange  
gains (losses)  
$m
(0.5) 
–
–
–
(0.2) 
(0.9) 
(1.6) 

Total investment  
return including  
foreign exchange  
$m
33.4 
1.2 
(0.6) 
3.5 
(0.9) 
0.2 
36.8 

(1) Net unrealised gains/(losses) on our FVTPL investments are included within net investment income and net other investment income.

Net realised gains (losses) and impairments includes impairment losses of $1.3 million (2016 – $3.5 million) recognised on fixed maturity 
securities and $nil (2016 – $0.4 million) recognised on equity securities held by the Group.

Refer to pages 114 to 115 in the risk disclosures section for the estimated fair values of the Group’s derivative instruments. Realised gains and 
losses on futures and options contracts are included in net realised gains (losses) and impairments.

Included in net investment income and net other investment income is $4.6 million (2016 – $4.5 million) of investment management, 
accounting and custodian fees.

4. Net insurance acquisition expenses

Insurance acquisition expenses
Changes in deferred insurance acquisition expenses
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded
Changes in deferred insurance acquisition expenses ceded
Total net insurance acquisition expenses

2017  
$m
115.9 
4.8 
(7.2) 
2.1 
115.6 

2016  
$m
129.4 
5.7 
(3.1) 
0.1 
132.1 

www.lancashiregroup.com

129

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
Notes to the accounts continued

5. Results of operating activities
Results of operating activities are stated after charging the following amounts:

Depreciation on owned assets
Operating lease charges
Auditors’ remuneration
 – Group audit fees
 – Other services
Total

2017  
$m
1.8 
3.4 

1.8 
–
7.0 

2016  
$m
2.3 
2.3 

1.8 
0.1 
6.5 

During 2017, KPMG provided non-audit services in relation to specified work over the distributable reserves and pre-appointment procedures 
on the first quarter 2017 earnings release. Fees for non-audit services provided in 2017 totalled twenty thousand dollars. During 2016, EY 
provided non-audit services in relation to taxation services. All fees paid to the Group’s auditors for non-audit services are approved by the 
Group’s Audit Committee.

6. Employee benefits

Wages and salaries
Pension costs
Bonus and other benefits
Total cash compensation
RSS – performance
RSS – ordinary
RSS – bonus deferral
RSS – Cathedral acquisition grant
Total equity based compensation
Total employee benefits

2017  
$m
27.6 
2.5 
10.1 
40.2 
(1.9) 
2.9 
2.1 
(3.5) 
(0.4) 
39.8 

2016  
$m
27.1 
3.1 
31.2 
61.4 
8.3 
1.2 
2.0 
(0.8) 
10.7 
72.1 

Equity based compensation
The Group’s equity based compensation scheme is its RSS. All outstanding and future RSS grants have an exercise period of ten years from  
the grant date.

The fair value of any TSR component of the nil-cost options is estimated using a stochastic model. For all other components the Black-Scholes 
model is used to estimate the fair value.

The following table lists the assumptions used in the stochastic model for the RSS awards granted during the years ended 31 December 2017 
and 2016:

Assumptions
Dividend yield
Expected volatility1
Risk-free interest rate2
Expected average life of options
Share price

2017
–
25.1%
0.1%
3 years
$8.60

2016
–
22.2%
0.5%
3 years
$8.85

(1) The expected volatility of LHL and comparator companies’ share prices are calculated based on the movement in the share prices over a period prior to the grant date, 

equal in length to the expected life of the award.

(2) The risk-free interest rate is consistent with three- year UK government bond yields on the date of grant.

The calculation of the equity based compensation expense assumes forfeitures due to employee turnover of 10.0 per cent per annum prior to 
vesting, with subsequent adjustments to reflect actual experience.

130

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

RSS – Performance
The performance RSS options vest after a three-year period and are dependent on certain performance criteria. A maximum of 75.0 per cent 
of the performance RSS options will vest only on the achievement of an RoE in excess of a required amount. A maximum of 25.0 per cent  
of the performance RSS options will vest only on the achievement of a TSR in excess of the 75th percentile of the TSR of a predefined 
comparator group. For all RSS options issued in 2012 and earlier the performance criteria was split as 50.0 per cent relating to RoE and  
50.0 per cent relating to TSR. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is  
paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according to the number of RSS options that vest.

Outstanding as at 31 December 2015
Granted
Exercised
Forfeited
Lapsed
Outstanding as at 31 December 2016
Granted
Exercised
Forfeited
Lapsed
Outstanding as at 31 December 2017

Exercisable as at 31 December 2016
Exercisable as at 31 December 2017

Weighted average remaining contractual life
Weighted average fair value at date of grant during the year
Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year

Total number of 
restricted stock
3,272,137
886,916
(499,296)
(72,024)
(224,576)
3,363,157
1,018,933
(509,524)
(156,461)
(257,894)
3,458,211

226,863
249,112

2017

2016

Total  
restricted stock
7.8 years
$7.56
$8.82

Total  
restricted stock
8.0 years
$7.60
$8.27

RSS – Ordinary
The ordinary RSS options were issued for the first time in 2016 and vest three years from the date of grant and do not have associated 
performance criteria for vesting. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is paid 
at the time of exercise. These awards will become exercisable in the first open period following the release of the Company’s 2018 year-end 
results after the Board meeting in February 2019.

Granted
Forfeited
Outstanding as at 31 December 2016
Granted
Forfeited
Outstanding as at 31 December 2017

Weighted average remaining contractual life
Weighted average fair value at date of grant during the year

Total number of 
restricted stock
688,714
(91,194)
597,520
699,251
(10,025)
1,286,746

2017

2016

Total  
restricted stock
8.7 years
$8.49

Total  
restricted stock
9.1 years
$8.85

www.lancashiregroup.com

131

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

6. Employee benefits continued
RSS – Bonus deferral
The bonus deferral RSS options vesting periods range from one to three years from the date of grant and do not have associated performance 
criteria for vesting. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is paid at the time  
of exercise.

Outstanding as at 31 December 2015
Granted
Exercised
Forfeited
Outstanding as at 31 December 2016
Granted
Exercised
Forfeited
Outstanding as at 31 December 2017
Exercisable as at 31 December 2016
Exercisable as at 31 December 2017

Number of  
employee  
restricted stock
435,275
270,752
(180,737)
(1,727)
523,563
244,523
(220,448)
–
547,638
80,576
78,295

Number of  
non-employee 
restricted stock
2,555
–
–
–
2,555
–
–
(2,555)
–
2,555
–

Total number of 
restricted stock
437,830
270,752
(180,737)
(1,727)
526,118
244,523
(220,448)
(2,555)
547,638
83,131
78,295

Weighted average remaining contractual life
Weighted average fair value at date of grant during  
the year
Weighted average share price at date of exercise during 
the year

2017

2016

Employee  
restricted stock
8.3 years

Non-employee  
restricted stock
–

Total  
restricted stock
8.3 years

Employee  
restricted stock
8.5 years

Non-employee  
restricted stock
0.1 years

Total  
restricted stock
8.5 years

$8.58

$8.73

–

–

$8.58

$8.73

$7.72

$8.24

–

–

$7.72

$8.24

RSS – Cathedral acquisition
The Cathedral acquisition RSS options vesting periods range from three to five years and are dependent on certain performance criteria.  
A maximum of 75.0 per cent of the Cathedral acquisition RSS options will vest on the achievement of a Cathedral combined ratio below a 
required amount. A maximum of 25.0 per cent of the Cathedral acquisition RSS options vest on the achievement of an LHL RoE in excess  
of a required amount. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is paid at the 
time of exercise. The first tranche of awards were exercisable in 2017.

Outstanding as at 31 December 2015
Forfeited
Outstanding as at 31 December 2016
Exercised
Forfeited
Lapsed
Outstanding as at 31 December 2017
Exercisable as at 31 December 2017

Weighted average remaining contractual life
Weighted average fair value at date of grant

132

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Total number of 
restricted stock
2,307,157
(950,907)
1,356,250
(400,166)
(556,768)
(29,838)
369,478
205,955

2017

2016

Total  
restricted stock
5.9 years
$13.01

Total  
restricted stock
6.9 years
$13.01

7. Financing costs

Interest expense on long-term debt
Net losses on interest rate swaps
Other financing costs
Total

2017  
$m
16.4
–
1.1
17.5

2016  
$m
15.6
1.0
1.6
18.2

Refer to note 17 for details of long-term debt and financing arrangements.

8. Tax
Bermuda
LHL, LICL and LUK have received an undertaking from the Bermuda government exempting them from all Bermuda local income, 
withholding and capital gains taxes until 31 March 2035. At the present time no such taxes are levied in Bermuda.

United Kingdom
LHL and its UK subsidiaries are subject to normal UK corporation tax on all their taxable profits.

Corporation tax charge for the period
Adjustments in respect of prior period corporation tax
Deferred tax credit for the period
Tax rate change adjustment
Adjustments in respect of prior period deferred tax
Total tax credit

Tax reconciliation1
(Loss) profit before tax
Corporation tax at 19.3% (2016 – 20.0%)
Non-taxable loss (income)
Adjustments in respect of prior period
Differences related to equity based compensation
Other expense permanent differences
Tax rate change adjustment
Unused tax losses not recognised for deferred tax
Utilisation of tax losses previously unrecognised for deferred tax
Total tax credit

(1) All tax reconciling balances have been classified as recurring items.

2017  
$m
3.3 
(2.3) 
(4.1) 
(0.6) 
1.4 
(2.3) 

2017  
$m
(72.9) 
(14.1) 
10.1 
(0.9) 
(0.6) 
3.8 
(0.6) 
–
–
(2.3) 

2016  
$m
2.7 
(2.4) 
(4.0) 
(0.8) 
0.6 
(3.9) 

2016  
$m
150.4 
30.1 
(34.4) 
(1.8) 
0.6 
3.1 
(0.8) 
0.6 
(1.3) 
(3.9) 

The current tax credit as a percentage of the Group’s loss (2016 – profit) before tax is negative 3.2 per cent (2016 – 2.6 per cent). Non-taxable 
(loss) income relates to (losses) profits of companies within the Group that are non-tax resident in the UK and the share of (loss) profit  
of associate.

Refer to note 10 for details of the tax expense related to the net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments that is included in 
accumulated other comprehensive loss within shareholders’ equity.

www.lancashiregroup.com

133

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

9. Cash and cash equivalents

Cash at bank and in hand
Cash equivalents
Total cash and cash equivalents

2017  
$m
107.0 
149.5 
256.5 

2016  
$m
122.4 
186.4 
308.8 

Cash equivalents have an original maturity of three months or less. The carrying amount of these assets approximates their fair value. Refer to 
note 17 for the cash and cash equivalent balances on deposit as collateral. Cash and cash equivalents includes managed cash of $188.1 million 
(31 December 2016 – $192.1 million).

10. Investments

As at 31 December 2017
Fixed maturity securities – AFS
 – Short-term investments
 – Fixed maturity funds
 – U.S. treasuries
 – Other government bonds
 – U.S. municipal bonds
 – U.S. government agency debt
 – Asset backed securities
 – U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities
 – Bank loans
 – Corporate bonds
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL
Equity securities – AFS
Hedge funds – at FVTPL
Other investments
Total investments

Cost or  
amortised cost  
$m

Unrealised  
gains  
$m

Unrealised  
losses  
$m

Estimated  
fair value  
$m

111.2 
31.2 
237.4 
71.2 
6.0 
71.2 
139.5 
142.4 
13.2 
0.2 
106.5 
520.1 
1,450.1 
25.7 
20.0 
144.6 
–
1,640.4 

–
–
0.1 
0.8 
–
–
4.9 
0.4 
0.2 
–
0.8 
3.6 
10.8 
–
3.2 
9.8 
–
23.8 

(0.1) 
(0.2) 
(1.8) 
(0.6) 
–
(0.7) 
(0.4) 
(1.8) 
(0.2) 
–
(0.6) 
(2.3) 
(8.7) 
–
–
(0.4) 
(0.5) 
(9.6) 

111.1 
31.0 
235.7 
71.4 
6.0 
70.5 
144.0 
141.0 
13.2 
0.2 
106.7 
521.4 
1,452.2 
25.7 
23.2 
154.0 
(0.5) 
1,654.6 

134

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

As at 31 December 2016
Fixed maturity securities – AFS
 – Short-term investments
 – Fixed maturity funds
 – U.S. treasuries
 – Other government bonds
 – U.S. municipal bonds
 – U.S. government agency debt
 – Asset backed securities
 – U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities
 – Bank loans
 – Corporate bonds
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL
Equity securities – AFS
Hedge funds – at FVTPL
Total investments

Cost or  
amortised cost  
$m

Unrealised  
gains  
$m

Unrealised  
losses  
$m

Estimated  
 fair value  
$m

5.3 
14.5 
307.8 
67.6 
1.0 
83.2 
111.1 
119.8 
14.6 
9.7 
120.8 
600.2 
1,455.6 
50.5 
20.8 
122.5 
1,649.4 

–
–
0.1 
0.1 
0.1 
–
0.3 
0.7 
0.1 
–
1.4 
1.7 
4.5 
1.1 
0.8 
7.4 
13.8 

–
–
(2.4) 
(1.1) 
–
(1.3) 
(1.2) 
(2.2) 
(0.4) 
(0.1) 
(0.6) 
(4.6) 
(13.9) 

–
(0.4) 
(0.5) 
(14.8) 

5.3 
14.5 
305.5 
66.6 
1.1 
81.9 
110.2 
118.3 
14.3 
9.6 
121.6 
597.3 
1,446.2 
51.6 
21.2 
129.4 
1,648.4 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss is in relation to the Group’s AFS fixed maturity and equity securities and is as follows:

Unrealised gains
Unrealised losses
Net unrealised foreign exchange (gains) losses on fixed maturity securities – AFS
Tax provision
Accumulated other comprehensive loss

2017  
$m
14.0 
(8.7) 
(6.9) 
0.1 
(1.5) 

2016  
$m
5.3 
(14.3) 
2.5 
0.1 
(6.4) 

Fixed maturity securities are presented in the risk disclosures section on page 120. Refer to note 17 for the investment balances in trusts in 
favour of ceding companies and on deposit as collateral.

The Group determines the estimated fair value of each individual security utilising the highest level inputs available. Prices for the Group’s 
investment portfolio are provided by a third-party investment accounting firm whose pricing processes and the controls thereon are subject  
to an annual audit on both the operation and the effectiveness of those controls. The audit reports are available to clients of the firm and the 
report is reviewed annually by management. In accordance with their pricing policy, various recognised reputable pricing sources are used 
including broker-dealers and pricing vendors. The pricing sources use bid prices where available, otherwise indicative prices are quoted  
based on observable market trade data. The prices provided are compared to the investment managers’ pricing. The Group has not made any 
adjustments to any pricing provided by independent pricing services or its third-party investment managers for either year ending 31 December.

The fair value of securities in the Group’s investment portfolio is estimated using the following techniques:

Level (i)
Level (i) investments are securities with quoted prices in active markets. A financial instrument is regarded as quoted in an active market if 
quoted prices are readily and regularly available from an exchange, dealer, broker, industry group, pricing service or regulatory agency and 
those prices represent actual and regularly occurring market transactions on an arm’s length basis. The Group determines securities classified 
as Level (i) to include highly liquid U.S. treasuries, certain highly liquid short-term investments and quoted equity securities.

www.lancashiregroup.com

135

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

10. Investments continued
Level (ii)
Level (ii) investments are securities with quoted prices in active markets for similar assets or liabilities or securities valued using other valuation 
techniques for which all significant inputs are based on observable market data. Instruments included in Level (ii) are valued via independent 
external sources using modeled or other valuation methods. Such methods are typically industry accepted standard and include:

 • broker-dealer quotes;
 • pricing models or matrix pricing;
 • present values;
 • future cash flows;
 • yield curves;
 • interest rates;
 • prepayment speeds; and
 • default rates.

Other similar quoted instruments or market transactions may be used.

The Group determines securities classified as Level (ii) to include short-term and fixed maturity investments and certain derivatives such as:

 • Short-term investments;
 • Fixed maturity funds;
 • Other government bonds;
 • U.S. municipal bonds;
 • U.S. government agency debt;
 • Asset backed securities;
 • U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities;
 • Non-agency mortgage backed securities;
 • Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities;
 • Bank loans;
 • Corporate bonds; and
 • OTC derivatives, such as options, forward foreign exchange contracts, interest rate swaps and credit default swaps.

136

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Level (iii)
Level (iii) investments are securities for which valuation techniques are not based on observable market data. The Group classifies hedge funds 
as Level (iii) assets as the valuation technique incorporates both observable and unobservable inputs.

The estimated fair values of the Group’s hedge funds are determined using a combination of the most recent NAVs provided by each fund’s 
independent administrator and the estimated performance provided by each hedge fund manager. Independent administrators provide 
monthly reported NAVs with up to a one-month delay in valuation. The most recent NAV available for each hedge fund is adjusted for the 
estimated performance, as provided by the fund manager, between the NAV date and the reporting date. Historically estimated fair values 
incorporating these performance estimates have not been significantly different from subsequent NAVs. Given the Group’s knowledge of  
the underlying investments and the size of the Group’s investment therein, we would not anticipate any material variance between estimated 
valuations and the final NAVs reported by the administrators.

The Group determines whether transfers have occurred between levels of the fair value hierarchy by re-assessing the categorisation at the end 
of each reporting period based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement as a whole.

The fair value hierarchy of the Group’s investment holdings is as follows:

As at 31 December 2017
Fixed maturity securities – AFS
 – Short-term investments
 – Fixed maturity funds
 – U.S. treasuries
 – Other government bonds
 – U.S. municipal bonds
 – U.S. government agency debt
 – Asset backed securities
 – U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities
 – Bank loans
 – Corporate bonds
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL
Equity securities – AFS
Hedge funds – at FVTPL
Other investments
Total investments

Level (i)  
$m

Level (ii)  
$m

Level (iii)  
 $m

Total  
$m

104.6 
–
235.7 
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
340.3 
–
23.2 
–
–
363.5 

6.5 
31.0 
–
71.4 
6.0 
70.5 
144.0 
141.0 
13.2 
0.2 
106.7 
521.4 
1,111.9 
25.7 
–
–
(0.5) 
1,137.1 

–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
154.0 
–
154.0 

111.1 
31.0 
235.7 
71.4 
6.0 
70.5 
144.0 
141.0 
13.2 
0.2 
106.7 
521.4 
1,452.2 
25.7 
23.2 
154.0 
(0.5) 
1,654.6 

www.lancashiregroup.com

137

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

10. Investments continued

As at 31 December 2016
Fixed maturity securities – AFS
 – Short-term investments
 – Fixed maturity funds
 – U.S. treasuries
 – Other government bonds
 – U.S. municipal bonds
 – U.S. government agency debt
 – Asset backed securities
 – U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities
 – Bank loans
 – Corporate bonds
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL
Equity securities – AFS
Hedge funds – at FVTPL
Total investments

Level (i)  
$m

Level (ii)  
$m

Level (iii)  
 $m

Total  
$m

4.0 
–
305.5 
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
309.5 
–
21.2 
–
330.7 

1.3 
14.5 
–
66.6 
1.1 
81.9 
110.2 
118.3 
14.3 
9.6 
121.6 
597.3 
1,136.7 
51.6 
–
–
1,188.3 

–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
129.4 
129.4 

5.3 
14.5 
305.5 
66.6 
1.1 
81.9 
110.2 
118.3 
14.3 
9.6 
121.6 
597.3 
1,446.2 
51.6 
21.2 
129.4 
1,648.4 

Hedge funds  
$m
156.0 
(30.3) 
3.7 
129.4 
149.7 
(136.5) 
11.4 
154.0 

There have been no transfers between Levels (i) and (ii), therefore no reconciliations have been presented.

The table below analyses the movements in hedge funds classified as Level (iii) investments:

As at 31 December 2015
Sales
Total net realised and unrealised gains recognised in profit or loss
As at 31 December 2016
Purchases
Sales
Total net realised and unrealised gains recognised in profit or loss
As at 31 December 2017

11. Interests in structured entities
A. Consolidated structured entities
The Group’s two consolidated structured entities are the EBT and the Orange Fund.

 • The Group provides capital contributions to the EBT to enable it to meet its obligations to employees under the equity based compensation 

plans. The Group has a contractual agreement which may require it to provide financial support to the EBT.

 • The Orange Fund was opened during 2017 and holds short duration high-quality cash equivalents and fixed maturity securities, and 

Lancashire Group companies are the only investors in the Orange Fund. The primary objectives of the fund are to preserve capital and 
provide liquidity to support the Group’s operations.

B. Unconsolidated structured entities in which the Group has an interest
As part of its investment activities, the Group invests in unconsolidated structured entities. As at 31 December 2017, the Group’s total interest 
in unconsolidated structured entities was $511.8 million (31 December 2016 – $431.5 million). The Group does not sponsor any of the 
unconsolidated structured entities.

138

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

A summary of the Group’s interest in consolidated and unconsolidated structured entities is as follows:

As at 31 December 2017
Fixed maturity securities
 – Asset backed securities
 – U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities
Total fixed maturity securities
Investment funds
 – Hedge funds
Total investment funds
Specialised investment vehicles
 – KHL (note 15)
Total

As at 31 December 2016
Fixed maturity securities
 – Asset backed securities
 – U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency mortgage backed securities
 – Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities
Total fixed maturity securities
Investment funds
 – Hedge funds
Total investment funds
Specialised investment vehicles
 – KHL (note 15)
Total

Orange  
Fund  
$m

8.1 
3.1 
–
–
11.2 

–
–

–
11.2 

Investments  
$m

Interest in 
associate  
$m

135.9 
137.9 
13.2 
0.2 
287.2 

154.0 
154.0 

–
441.2 

–
–
–
–
–

–
–

59.4 
59.4 

Investments  
$m

Interest in  
associate  
$m

110.2 
118.3 
14.3 
9.6 
252.4 

129.4 
129.4 

–
381.8 

–
–
–
–
–

–
–

49.7 
49.7 

Total  
$m

144.0 
141.0 
13.2 
0.2 
298.4 

154.0 
154.0 

59.4 
511.8 

Total  
$m

110.2 
118.3 
14.3 
9.6 
252.4 

129.4 
129.4 

49.7 
431.5 

The fixed maturity structured entities are created to meet specific investment needs of borrowers and investors which cannot be met from 
standardised financial instruments available in the capital markets. As such, they provide liquidity to the borrowers in these markets and 
provide investors with an opportunity to diversify risk away from standard fixed maturity securities. Whilst individual securities may differ  
in structure, the principles of the instruments are broadly the same and it is appropriate to aggregate the investments into the categories 
detailed above.

The risk that the Group faces in respect of the investments in structured entities is similar to the risk it faces in respect of other financial 
investments held on the consolidated balance sheet in that fair value is determined by market supply and demand. This is in turn driven by 
investor evaluation of the credit risk of the structure and changes in term structure of interest rates which change investors’ expectation of the 
cash flows associated with the instrument and, therefore, its value in the market. Risk management disclosures for these financial instruments 
and other investments is provided on pages 110 to 121. The total assets of these structured entities are not considered meaningful for the 
purpose of understanding the related risks and therefore have not been presented.

The maximum exposure to loss in respect of these structured entities would be the carrying value of the instruments that the Group holds as  
at 31 December 2017 and 31 December 2016. Generally, default rates would have to increase substantially from their current level before the 
Group would suffer a loss and this assessment is made prior to investing and regularly through the holding period for the security. The Group 
has not provided any other financial or other support in addition to that described above as at the reporting date, and there is no intention to 
provide support in relation to any other unconsolidated structured entities in the foreseeable future.

www.lancashiregroup.com

139

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

11. Interests in structured entities continued
As at 31 December 2017 the Group has a commitment of $100.0 million (31 December 2016 – $50.0 million) in respect of two credit facility 
funds. The Group, via the funds, provides collateral for revolving credit facilities purchased at a discount from financial institutions and is  
at risk for its portion of any defaults on those revolving credit facilities. The Group’s proportionate share of these revolving credit facilities 
purchased by the funds as at 31 December 2017 is $64.4 million (31 December 2016 – $37.5 million), which currently remains unfunded.  
The maximum exposure to the credit facility funds is $100.0 million and as at 31 December 2017 there have been no defaults under  
these facilities.

12. Losses and loss adjustment expenses

As at 31 December 2015
Net incurred losses for:
Prior years
Current year
Exchange adjustments
Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses
Net paid losses for:
Prior years
Current year
Paid losses and loss adjustment expenses
As at 31 December 2016
Net incurred losses for:
Prior years
Current year
Exchange adjustments
Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses
Net paid losses for:
Prior years
Current year
Paid losses and loss adjustment expenses
As at 31 December 2017

Losses and  
loss adjustment 
expenses  
$m
671.0 

Reinsurance 
recoveries  
$m
(83.9) 

Net losses and  
loss adjustment 
expenses  
$m
587.1 

(89.7) 
301.9 
(3.8) 
208.4 

139.4 
60.2 
199.6 
679.8 

(40.1) 
578.1 
18.8 
556.8 

231.1 
72.0 
303.1 
933.5 

3.9 
(73.6) 
1.4 
(68.3) 

(8.0) 
(7.5) 
(15.5) 
(136.7) 

(25.0) 
(177.6) 
(0.7) 
(203.3) 

(50.2) 
(5.7) 
(55.9) 
(284.1) 

(85.8) 
228.3 
(2.4) 
140.1 

131.4 
52.7 
184.1 
543.1 

(65.1) 
400.5 
18.1 
353.5 

180.9 
66.3 
247.2 
649.4 

Further information on the calculation of loss reserves and the risks associated with them is provided in the risk disclosures section from page 
107. The risks associated with general insurance contracts are complex and do not readily lend themselves to meaningful sensitivity analysis. 
The impact of an unreported event could lead to a significant increase in the Group’s loss reserves. The Group believes that the loss reserves 
established are adequate, however a 20.0 per cent increase in estimated losses would lead to a $186.7 million (31 December 2016 – $136.0 
million) increase in gross loss reserves. There was no change to the Group’s reserving methodology during the year. The split of losses and  
loss adjustment expenses between notified outstanding losses, ACRs assessed by management and IBNR is shown below:

As at 31 December
Outstanding losses
Additional case reserves
Losses incurred but not reported
Total

2017

$m
300.4 
186.5 
446.6 
933.5 

%
32.2 
20.0 
47.8 
100.0 

2016

$m
328.1 
144.5 
207.2 
679.8 

%
48.3 
21.3 
30.4 
100.0 

The Group’s reserve for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses as at 31 December 2017 and 2016 had an estimated duration of 
approximately two years.

140

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Claims development
The development of insurance liabilities is indicative of the Group’s ability to estimate the ultimate value of its insurance liabilities. The Group 
began writing insurance and reinsurance business in December 2005. With the acquisition of Cathedral in 2013, the Group assumed 
additional loss reserves relating to 2001 and subsequent years.

Accident year
Gross Group losses
Estimate of ultimate liability1
At end of accident year
One year later
Two years later
Three years later
Four years later
Five years later
Six years later
Seven years later
Eight years later
Nine years later
Ten years later

2007  
and prior  
$m

228.6 
163.2 
131.1 
122.0 
107.9 
105.0 
148.2 
146.4 
143.1 
142.4 
140.6 

2008  
$m

2009  
$m

2010  
$m

2011  
$m

2012  
 $m

2013  
$m

2014  
 $m

2015  
$m

2016  
$m

2017 
$m

Total  
$m

580.1 

298.5 
310.7 

276.0 
214.6 
196.2 

274.8 
226.7 
206.0 
196.5 

280.0 
259.8 
224.0 
224.4 
222.1 

250.3 
350.4 
338.8 
326.9 
313.3 
308.7 

397.0 
371.9 
447.0 
450.4 
460.0 
450.7 
452.6 

297.4 
209.4 
204.2 
235.8 
229.4 
231.4 
229.8 
229.6 

163.3 
107.8 
73.1 
66.0 
89.1 
81.7 
72.9 
90.8 
89.6 

444.6 
417.4 
377.5 
345.1 
340.8 
355.6 
350.9 
353.6 
352.5 
353.1 

Current estimate of cumulative 
liability
Paid
Total Group gross liability

140.6 
353.1 
(113.1) (341.1)
12.0 

27.5 

229.6 

452.6 

89.6 
310.7 
(60.2) (215.9) (421.4) (267.3) (200.0) (167.5) (153.5) (134.3)
176.4 
29.4 

308.7 

196.2 

222.1 

196.5 

13.7 

29.0 

41.4 

42.7 

31.2 

22.1 

580.1  3,079.8 
(72.0) (2,146.3)
933.5 
508.1 

(1) Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2017.

Accident year
Reinsurance
Estimate of ultimate recovery1
At end of accident year
One year later
Two years later
Three years later
Four years later
Five years later
Six years later
Seven years later
Eight years later
Nine years later
Ten years later

Current estimate of cumulative 
recovery
Paid
Total Group gross recovery

2007  
and prior  
$m

3.6 
6.2 
4.0 
3.5 
3.3 
3.1 
29.1 
29.2 
28.8 
27.8 
26.6 

2008  
$m

2009  
$m

2010  
$m

2011  
$m

2012  
 $m

2013  
$m

2014  
 $m

2015  
$m

2016  
$m

2017 
$m

Total  
$m

177.6 

73.1 
98.5 

15.3 
12.2 
12.6 

17.8 
14.1 
13.1 
11.5 

9.9 
8.9 
8.8 
8.0 
8.0 

48.9 
121.8 
122.0 
121.2 
121.2 
121.2 

56.2 
52.6 
92.4 
88.9 
103.3 
102.8 
106.1 

33.8 
23.6 
24.1 
33.5 
34.4 
34.6 
35.7 
36.2 

1.6 
1.3 
0.7 
0.7 
10.0 
7.0 
2.5 
2.5 
1.3 

40.7 
47.1 
43.1 
40.9 
38.1 
40.7 
39.8 
40.4 
40.9 
41.0 

26.6 
(7.3)
19.3 

41.0 
(39.0)
2.0 

1.3 
0.5
1.8 

36.2 
(34.4)
1.8 

106.1 
121.2 
(99.2) (117.8)
3.4 

6.9 

8.0 
(7.4)
0.6 

11.5 
(8.0)
3.5 

12.6 
(12.0)
0.6 

98.5 
(26.2)
72.3 

177.6 
(5.7)
171.9 

640.6 
(356.5)
284.1 

(1) Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2017.

www.lancashiregroup.com

141

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

12. Losses and loss adjustment expenses continued

Accident year
Net Group losses
Estimate of ultimate liability1
At end of accident year
One year later
Two years later
Three years later
Four years later
Five years later
Six years later
Seven years later
Eight years later
Nine years later
Ten years later

2007  
and prior  
$m

225.0 
157.0 
127.1 
118.5 
104.6 
101.9 
119.1 
117.2 
114.3 
114.6 
114.0 

2008  
$m

2009  
$m

2010  
$m

2011  
$m

2012  
 $m

2013  
$m

2014  
 $m

2015  
$m

2016  
$m

2017 
$m

Total  
$m

402.5 

225.4 
212.2 

260.7 
202.4 
183.6 

257.0 
212.6 
192.9 
185.0 

270.1 
250.9 
215.2 
216.4 
214.1 

201.4 
228.6 
216.8 
205.7 
192.1 
187.5 

340.8 
319.3 
354.6 
361.5 
356.7 
347.9 
346.5 

263.6 
185.8 
180.1 
202.3 
195.0 
196.8 
194.1 
193.4 

161.7 
106.5 
72.4 
65.3 
79.1 
74.7 
70.4 
88.3 
88.3 

403.9 
370.3 
334.4 
304.2 
302.7 
314.9 
311.1 
313.2 
311.6 
312.1 

Current estimate of cumulative 
liability
Paid
Total Group net liability

114.0 
312.1 
(105.8) (302.1)
10.0 

8.2 

193.4 

346.5 

88.3 
212.2 
(60.7) (181.5) (322.2) (149.5) (192.6) (159.5) (141.5) (108.1)
104.1 
27.6 

187.5 

214.1 

183.6 

185.0 

25.5 

38.0 

11.9 

42.1 

21.5 

24.3 

402.5  2,439.2 
(66.3) (1,789.8)
649.4 
336.2 

(1) Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2017.

The inherent uncertainty in reserving gives rise to favourable or adverse development on the established reserves. The total favourable 
development on net losses and loss adjustment expenses, excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations, was as follows:

2007 accident year and prior
2008 accident year
2009 accident year
2010 accident year
2011 accident year
2012 accident year
2013 accident year
2014 accident year
2015 accident year
2016 accident year
Total favourable development

2017  
$m
0.6 
(0.5) 
0.1 
1.8 
8.8 
5.0 
3.5 
9.2 
20.3 
16.3 
65.1 

2016  
$m
(0.4) 
1.6 
(18.0) 
3.2 
9.9 
13.5 
(1.6) 
19.9 
57.7 
–
85.8 

Despite some adverse development on prior accident year property and energy claims in 2017, the overall favourable development was 
primarily due to general IBNR releases across most lines of business due to a lack of reported claims. Experience in 2016 was similar in terms 
of releases, offset partially by some adverse development on prior accident year energy and marine claims.

In September 2017, hurricanes Harvey, Irma and Maria made landfall in the Caribbean and U.S., causing significant damage and destruction 
to property. These events were followed by wildfires in California during October 2017 and December 2017. Management’s current best 
estimates in relation to each of these events are shown in the table below.

The Group’s estimated ultimate net losses, after reinstatement premiums, for these significant events are as follows:

Change in insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses
Change in insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable
Change in reinstatement premiums
Net ultimate losses as at 31 December 2017

142

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Harvey  
$m
66.3 
(18.5) 
(3.3) 
44.5 

Irma  
$m
108.9 
(55.1) 
(1.7) 
52.1 

Maria  
$m
78.5 
(43.1) 
(2.3) 
33.1 

Combined 
California Wildfires  
$m
75.9 
(41.4) 
(0.4) 
34.1 

13. Insurance, reinsurance and other receivables
All receivables are considered current other than $53.7 million (31 December 2016 – $58.4 million) of inwards premiums receivable related  
to multi-year contracts. The carrying value approximates fair value due to the short-term nature of the receivables. There are no significant 
concentrations of credit risk within the Group’s receivables.

14. Provision for deferred tax

Equity based compensation
Claims equalisation reserves
Syndicate underwriting profits
Syndicate participation rights
Other temporary differences
Tax losses carried forward
Net deferred tax liability

2017  
$m
(2.9) 
8.3 
0.1 
12.7 
(1.2) 
(0.5) 
16.5 

2016  
$m
(3.8) 
8.1 
2.7 
12.8 
(0.9) 
(0.2) 
18.7 

Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that realising the related tax benefit through future taxable profits is likely. It is anticipated 
that sufficient taxable profits will be available within the Group in 2017 and subsequent years to utilise the deferred tax assets recognised when 
the underlying temporary differences reverse.

A deferred tax asset of $10.9 million (31 December 2016 – $11.4 million) has not been recognised in relation to unused tax losses carried 
forward in LHL, because at present the related tax benefit is not expected to be realised through future taxable profits. For the years ended 
31 December 2017 and 2016, the Group had no uncertain tax positions.

Changes to the UK main rate of corporation tax have been enacted under the Finance Act 2015 and Finance Act 2016 reducing the rate to 
19.0 per cent from 1 April 2017 and to 17.0 per cent from 1 April 2020.

All deferred tax assets and liabilities are classified as non-current.

15. Investment in associate
The Group holds a 10.0 per cent interest in the preference shares of each segregated account of KHL, a company incorporated in Bermuda. 
KHL’s operating subsidiary, KRL, is authorised by the BMA as a Special Purpose Insurer. KRL commenced writing insurance business on 
1 January 2014. As at 31 December 2017, the carrying value of the Group’s investment in KHL was $59.4 million (31 December 2016 – $49.7 
million). The Group’s share of comprehensive loss for KHL for the period was $9.4 million (2016 – $5.1 million income). Key financial 
information for KHL is as follows:

Assets
Liabilities
Shareholders’ equity
Gross premium earned
Comprehensive (loss) income

2017  
$m
736.4 
141.9 
594.5 
71.7 
(94.3) 

2016  
$m
506.5 
9.2 
497.3 
54.2 
51.1 

The Group has the power to participate in operational and financial policy decisions of KHL and KRL through the provision of essential 
technical information by KCML and has therefore classified its investment in KHL as an investment in associate.

Refer to note 22 for details of transactions between the Group and its associate.

www.lancashiregroup.com

143

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

16. Intangible assets

Net book value as at 31 December 2017 and 2016

Syndicate 
participation  
rights  
$m
82.6 

Goodwill  
$m
71.2 

Total  
$m
153.8 

Syndicate participation rights and goodwill are deemed to have an indefinite life as they are expected to have value in use that does not 
diminish over the course of time. Consequently, the carrying value is not amortised but tested annually for impairment.

For the purpose of impairment testing, intangible assets are allocated to the Group’s CGUs, in accordance with the manner in which 
management operates and monitors the business. The Syndicate participation rights and goodwill have therefore been allocated to  
the Lloyd’s CGU.

When testing for impairment, the recoverable amount of the Lloyd’s CGU is determined based on value in use. Value in use is calculated  
using projected cash flows based on the financial projections of the CGU. These are approved by management and cover a three year period. 
The most significant assumptions used to derive the projected cash flows include an assessment of business prospects, projected loss ratios, 
outwards reinsurance expenditure and investment returns. A pre-tax discount rate of 6.2 per cent (2016 – 6.9 per cent) has been used to 
discount the projected cash flows, which reflects a combination of factors including the Group’s expected cost of equity and cost of borrowing. 
The growth rate used to extrapolate the cash flows is 3.0 per cent (2016 – 3.0 per cent) based on historical growth rates and management’s 
best estimate of future growth rates.

The results of this exercise indicate that the recoverable amount exceeds the intangible assets’ carrying value for both the syndicate 
participation rights and the goodwill and would not be sensitive to any reasonably possible changes in assumptions. Therefore no impairment 
has been recognised during the years ended 31 December 2017 and 2016.

17. Long-term debt and financing arrangements
Long-term debt
On 5 October 2012, the Group issued $130.0 million 5.70 per cent senior unsecured notes due 2022 pursuant to a private offering to U.S. 
Qualified Institutional Buyers. Interest on the principal is payable semi-annually. The notes were listed and admitted to trading on the LSE  
on 16 October 2012.

On 15 December 2005, the Group issued $97.0 million and €24.0 million in aggregate principal amount of floating rate subordinated loan 
notes. The U.S. dollar subordinated loan notes are repayable on 15 December 2035. Interest on the principal is based on a set margin,  
3.70 per cent, above the three-month LIBOR and is payable quarterly. The loan notes were issued via a trust company.

The Euro subordinated loan notes are repayable on 15 June 2035. Interest on the principal is based on a set margin, 3.70 per cent, above the 
EURIBOR and is payable quarterly. On 21 October 2011, the CSX admitted to the official list the LHL U.S. dollar and Euro subordinated loan 
notes due 2035.

In 2013, the Group assumed loan notes, issued by CCHL and listed on the ISE, as part of the Cathedral acquisition. The loan notes acquired 
are set out as follows:

 • €12.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 18 November 2004 and repayable in September 2034, paying interest quarterly 

based on a set margin, 3.75 per cent, above the three-month EURIBOR;

 • $10.0 million floating rate subordinated note loan issued on 26 November 2004 and repayable in September 2034, paying interest quarterly 

based on a set margin, 3.75 per cent, above the three-month LIBOR;

 • $25.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 13 May 2005 and repayable in June 2035, paying interest quarterly based on a 

set margin, 3.25 per cent, above the three-month LIBOR; and

 • $25.0 million floating rate subordinated loan note issued on 18 November 2005 and repayable in December 2035, paying interest quarterly 

based on a set margin, 3.25 per cent, above the three-month LIBOR.

The Group has the option to redeem its senior unsecured notes and all of its subordinated loan notes, in whole or in part, prior to the 
respective maturity dates.

The terms of the $130.0 million senior unsecured notes include standard default and cross-default provisions which require certain covenants 
to be adhered to. These include the following:

 • a maximum debt-to-capital ratio of 30.0 per cent, where the subordinated loan notes are included as both total consolidated debt and total 

consolidated capital in this calculation.

144

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

There are no such covenants for either the $97.0 million and €24.0 million in aggregate floating rate subordinated loan notes or the loan 
notes issued by CCHL.

As at all reporting dates the Group was in compliance with all covenants under these facilities.

The carrying values of the notes are shown below:

As at 31 December
Long-term debt $130.0 million
Long-term debt $97.0 million
Long-term debt €24.0 million
Long-term debt €12.0 million
Long-term debt $10.0 million
Long-term debt $25.0 million
Long-term debt $25.0 million
Carrying value

2017  
$m
130.0
97.0
28.8
13.1
10.0
23.7
23.7
326.3

2016  
$m
130.0
97.0
25.3
11.2
10.0
23.7
23.7
320.9

The Group is exposed to cash flow interest rate risk and currency risk on its long-term debt. Further information is provided in the risk 
disclosures section on page 117.

The fair value of the long-term debt is estimated as $369.3 million (31 December 2016 – $354.8 million). The fair value measurement is 
classified within Level (ii) of the fair value hierarchy. The fair value is estimated by reference to similar financial instruments quoted in  
active markets.

The interest accrued on the long-term debt was $2.3 million (31 December 2016 – $2.0 million) at the balance sheet date and is included in 
other payables.

Refer to note 7 for details of the interest expense for the year included in financing costs.

Interest rate swaps
The Group hedges a portion of its floating rate borrowings using interest rate swaps to transfer floating to fixed rate. These instruments are 
held at estimated fair value. Refer to the risk disclosures section from page 116 for further details. The Group has the right to net  
settle these instruments.

The net fair value position owed by the Group on the swap agreements is $2.0 million (31 December 2016 – $3.7 million). Further information 
is provided on pages 114 to 116. Cash settlements are completed on a quarterly basis and the total of the next cash settlements in the first 
quarter of 2018 on these instruments is $0.3 million. The net impact from cash settlements and changes in estimated fair value are included  
in financing costs.

The interest rate swaps are held at estimated fair value, priced using observable market inputs, and are therefore classified as Level (ii) 
securities in the fair value hierarchy.

Refer to note 7 for the net impact from cash settlement and changes in estimated fair value included in financing costs.

Letters of credit
As both LICL and LUK are non-admitted insurers or reinsurers throughout the U.S., the terms of certain contracts require them to provide 
LOCs to policyholders as collateral. The following LOCs have been issued:

As at 31 December
Issued to third parties

LOCs are required to be fully collateralised.

2017  
$m
31.0

2016  
$m
29.4

www.lancashiregroup.com

145

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

17. Long-term debt and financing arrangements continued
LHL and LICL had the following facilities in place:

 • a $300.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility with a $75.0 million loan sub-limit that has been in place since 24 March 2016 and 

will expire on 24 March 2021. There was no outstanding debt under this facility as at 31 December 2017 and 2016; and

 • a $350.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility with a $75.0 million loan sub-limit that had been in place since 5 April 2012 and was 

replaced on 24 March 2016 by the $300.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility.

The existing facility is available for the issue of LOCs to ceding companies. The facility is also available for LICL to issue LOCs to LUK to 
collateralise certain insurance balances.

The terms of the $300.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility include standard default and cross-default provisions that are broadly 
consistent with the previous facility, which require certain covenants to be adhered to. These include the following:

 • an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least B++;
 • a maximum debt-to-capital ratio of 30.0 per cent, where the subordinated loan notes are excluded from this calculation;
 • a maximum indebtedness regarding the subordinated loan notes of $250.0 million; and
 • a maximum indebtedness regarding the Syndicate 2010 and 3010 catastrophe facilities of $150.0 million.

A $130.0 million syndicated uncollateralised facility has been in place since 3 October 2017 and will expire on 31 December 2018. It is 
available for utilisation by LICL and guaranteed by LHL for FAL purposes. As at 31 December 2017 $130.0 million of LOCs were issued  
under this facility.

The terms of the $130.0 million syndicated uncollateralised facility includes standard default and cross-default provisions and require certain 
covenants to be adhered to. These include the following:

 • an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least B++;
 • a maximum debt-to-capital ratio of 30.0 per cent, where the subordinated loan notes are excluded from this calculation;
 • a maximum indebtedness regarding the subordinated loan notes of $250.0 million; and
 • maintenance of a minimum net worth requirement.

As at all reporting dates the Group was in compliance with all covenants under these facilities.

Syndicate bank facilities
As at 31 December 2017 and 2016, Syndicate 2010 had in place an $80.0 million catastrophe facility with Barclays Bank plc. The facility is 
available to assist in paying claims and the gross funding of catastrophes for Syndicate 2010. Up to $40.0 million can be utilised by way of an 
LOC and up to $40.0 million by way of an RCF to assist Syndicate 2010’s gross funding requirements. For 2018, up to $80.0 million can be 
utilised by way of an LOC or an RCF to assist Syndicate 2010’s gross funding requirements.

As at 31 December 2016, Syndicate 3010 had in place a $40.0 million catastrophe facility with Barclays Bank plc. The facility was available to 
assist in paying claims and the gross funding of catastrophes for Syndicate 3010. Up to $20.0 million could be utilised by way of an LOC and  
up to $20.0 million by way of an RCF to assist Syndicate 3010’s gross funding requirements. This facility was not renewed for the 2017 year.

There are no balances outstanding under either of the Syndicates’ bank facilities as at 31 December 2017 or 2016. The Syndicates’ bank 
facilities are not available to the Group other than through its participation on the Syndicates it supports.

Trusts and restricted balances
The Group has several trust arrangements in place in favour of policyholders and ceding companies in order to comply with the security 
requirements of certain reinsurance contracts and/or the regulatory requirements of certain jurisdictions.

In 2012, LICL entered into an MBRT to collateralise its reinsurance liabilities associated with U.S. domiciled clients. As at and for the years 
ended 31 December 2017 and 2016, LICL had been granted authorised or trusteed reinsurer status in all states. The MBRT is subject to the 
rules and regulations of the aforementioned states and the respective deeds of trust. These rules and regulations include minimum capital 
funding requirements, investment guidelines, capital distribution restrictions and regulatory reporting requirements.

As at and for the years ended 31 December 2017 and 2016, the Group was in compliance with all covenants under its trust facilities.

146

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

The Group is required to hold a portion of its assets as FAL to support the underwriting capacities of Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010.  
FAL are restricted in their use and are only drawn down to pay cash calls to Syndicates supported by the Group. FAL requirements are  
formally assessed twice a year and any funds surplus to requirements may be released at that time. See page 125 for more information 
regarding FAL requirements.

In addition to the FAL, certain cash and investments held by Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 are only available for paying the Syndicates’ 
claims and expenses. See page 125 for more information regarding the capital requirements for Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010.

The following cash and cash equivalents and investment balances were held in trust, other collateral accounts in favour of third parties, or are 
otherwise restricted:

As at 31 December
MBRT accounts
FAL
Syndicate accounts
In favour of LOCs
In trust accounts for policyholders
In favour of derivative contracts
Total

18. Share capital
Authorised common shares of $0.50 each
As at 31 December 2017 and 2016

Allocated, called up and fully paid
As at 31 December 2017 and 2016

Own shares
As at 31 December 2015
Shares distributed
Shares donated to trust
As at 31 December 2016
Shares distributed
Shares donated to trust
As at 31 December 2017

2017

2016

Cash and cash 
equivalents  
$m
50.7
18.4
21.0
5.4
0.8
3.0
99.3

Fixed maturity 
securities  
$m
132.4
132.5
78.3
35.7
24.6
0.3
403.8

Equity  
securities  
$m
–
–
–
–
–
–
–

Total 
$m
183.1
150.9
99.3
41.1
25.4
3.3
503.1

Cash and cash 
equivalents  
$m
5.6
13.5
26.8
6.2
3.7
3.8
59.6

Fixed maturity 
securities  
$m
35.1
254.1
75.9
29.4
21.4
0.3
416.2

Equity  
securities  
 $m
–
1.4
–
–
–
–
1.4

Number
3,000,000,000

Number
201,341,918

Total number  
of own shares
3,144,060 
(680,033) 

–
2,464,027 
(1,130,800) 

–
1,333,227 

$m
12.3 
(6.6) 
3.5 
9.2 
(9.9) 
12.8 
12.1 

Number held  
 in treasury
1,841,526 
–

(426,468) 
1,415,058 
–

(1,415,058) 

–

$m
18.1 
–
(4.1) 
14.0 
–

(14.0) 

–

Number held  
 in trust
1,302,534 
(680,033) 
426,468 
1,048,969 
(1,130,800) 
1,415,058 
1,333,227 

Total 
$m
40.7
269.0
102.7
35.6
25.1
4.1
477.2

$m
1,500

$m
100.7

$m
30.4 
(6.6) 
(0.6) 
23.2 
(9.9) 
(1.2) 
12.1 

The number of common shares in issue with voting rights (allocated share capital less shares held in treasury) as at 31 December 2017 was 
201,341,918 (31 December 2016 – 199,926,860).

Share repurchases
At the AGM held on 3 May 2017, LHL’s shareholders approved a renewal of the Repurchase Programme authorising the repurchase  
of a maximum of 20,134,191 shares, with such authority to expire on the conclusion of the 2018 AGM or, if earlier, 15 months from  
the date the resolution approving the Repurchase Programme was passed. There were no share repurchases during either 2017 or 2016.

During the year ended 31 December 2017, 1,415,058 shares (2016 – 426,468 shares) were donated to the EBT at a market value of 
$12.8 million (2016 – $3.5 million).

In 2017, the trustees of the EBT distributed 1,130,800 shares (2016 – 680,033 shares). There were no unsettled balances in relation to EBT 
purchases at either balance sheet date.

www.lancashiregroup.com

147

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

18. Share capital continued
Dividends
The Board of Directors have authorised the following dividends:

Type
Final
Interim
Special
Final
Interim

19. Other reserves
Other reserves consist of the following:

As at 31 December 2015
Shares donated to the trust
Distributed by trust
Equity based compensation – exercises
Equity based compensation – expense
As at 31 December 2016
Shares donated to the trust
Distributed by trust
Equity based compensation – exercises
Equity based compensation – expense
As at 31 December 2017

Per share amount
$0.10
$0.05
$0.75
$0.10
$0.05

Record date
26 Feb 2016
5 Aug 2016
18 Nov 2016
24 Feb 2017
11 Aug 2017

Payment date
23 Mar 2016
31 Aug 2016
14 Dec 2016
22 Mar 2017
6 Sep 2017

$m
19.8
10.0
149.1
19.9
10.0

Contributed 
surplus  
$m
839.6 
(0.6) 
(9.5) 
10.0 
–
839.5 
(1.2) 
(13.8) 
14.6 
–
839.1 

Equity based 
compensation  
$m
41.2 
–
–

(10.0) 
10.9 
42.1 
–
–

(14.6) 
(0.4) 
27.1 

Total other  
reserves  
$m
880.8 
(0.6) 
(9.5) 
–
10.9 
881.6 
(1.2) 
(13.8) 

–
(0.4) 
866.2 

20. Commitments and contingencies
A. Lease commitments
The Group has payment obligations in respect of operating leases for certain items of office equipment and office space. Operating lease 
expenses for the year were $3.4 million (2016 – $2.3 million).

Future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating leases are as follows:

Due in less than one year
Due between one and five years
Due in more than five years
Total

2017  
$m
3.6 
10.0 
28.3 
41.9 

2016  
$m
3.0 
10.2 
28.1 
41.3 

During 2014, the Group entered into a new lease agreement for larger office premises in the UK and assigned the leases in relation to the 
existing office premises in the UK to a third party who assumed responsibility for payments. Under the terms of the lease assignment the 
Group retains liability for lease payments in the event that the assignee and the assignee’s guarantor fail to meet their obligations under  
the assignment agreements. The new lease agreement contains a break date of April 2029 and is guaranteed by LHL.

B. Credit facility fund
At as 31 December 2017 the Group has a commitment of $100.0 million (31 December 2016 – $50.0 million) relating to two credit facility 
funds (refer to note 11).

C. Legal proceedings and regulations
The Group operates in the insurance industry and is subject to legal proceedings in the normal course of business. While it is not practicable 
to estimate or determine the final results of all pending or threatened legal proceedings, management does not believe that such proceedings 
(including litigation) will have a material effect on its results and financial position.

148

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

21. Earnings per share
The following reflects the profit and share data used in the basic and diluted earnings per share computations:

(Loss) profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders of LHL

2017  
$m
(71.1) 

2016  
$m
153.8 

Basic weighted average number of shares
Dilutive effect of RSS
Diluted weighted average number of shares

(Loss) earnings per share
Basic
Diluted

2017  
Number  
 of shares

2016  
Number  
of shares
199,723,434  198,565,378 
2,901,049 
201,503,802  201,466,427 

1,780,368 

2017
($0.36)
($0.36)

2016
$0.77
$0.76

Equity based compensation awards are only treated as dilutive when their conversion to common shares would decrease earnings per share  
or increase loss per share from continuing operations. Unvested restricted shares without performance criteria are therefore included in the 
number of potentially dilutive shares. Incremental shares from ordinary restricted share options where relevant performance criteria have not 
been met are not included in the calculation of dilutive shares.

22. Related party disclosures
The consolidated financial statements include LHL and the entities listed below:

Name
Subsidiaries1
LICL
KCML2
ORANGE FUND
KCMMSL
LIHL
LIMSL
LISL
LUK
LMSCL
CCHL
CCL
CCL 1998
CCL 1999
CCSL
CUL
Associate
KHL
Other controlled entities
LHFT
EBT

Principal Business

Domicile

General insurance business
Insurance management services
Investment fund
Support services
Holding company
Insurance mediation activities
Support services
General insurance business
Support services
Investment company
Holding company
Lloyd’s corporate member
Non trading
Support services
Lloyd’s managing agent

Holding company

Trust
Trust

Bermuda
Bermuda
United States
United Kingdom
United Kingdom
United Kingdom
United Kingdom
United Kingdom
Canada
United Kingdom
United Kingdom
United Kingdom
United Kingdom
United Kingdom
United Kingdom

Bermuda

United States
Jersey

(1) Unless otherwise stated, the Group owns 100 per cent of the ordinary share capital and voting rights in its subsidiaries listed below.
(2) 92.7 per cent owned by the Group.

www.lancashiregroup.com

149

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsNotes to the accounts continued

22. Related party disclosures continued
The Group has issued subordinated loan notes via a trust vehicle – LHFT, refer to note 17. The Group effectively has 100.0 per cent of the 
voting rights in LHFT. These rights are subject to the property trustee’s obligations to seek the approval of the holders of LHFT’s preferred 
securities in case of default and other limited circumstances where the property trustee would enforce its rights. While the ability of the Group 
to influence the actions of LHFT is limited by the trust agreement, LHFT was set up by the Group with the sole purpose of issuing the 
subordinated loan notes, and is in essence controlled by the Group, and is therefore consolidated.

The EBT was established to assist in the administration of the Group’s employee equity based compensation schemes. While the Group does 
not have legal ownership of the EBT and the ability of the Group to influence the actions of the EBT is limited by the trust deed, the EBT was 
set up by the Group with the sole purpose of assisting in the administration of these schemes, and is in essence controlled by the Group, and is 
therefore consolidated.

The Group has a Loan Facility Agreement (the ‘Facility’) with RBC Cees Trustee Limited, the trustee of the EBT. The Facility is an interest 
free revolving credit facility under which the trustee can request advances on demand, within the terms of the Facility, up to a maximum 
aggregate amount of $80.0 million. The Facility may only be used by the trustee for the purpose of achieving the objectives of the EBT. During 
the year ended 31 December 2017, the Group had made advances of $6.0 million (2016 – $nil) to the EBT under the terms of the Facility.

During the year ended 31 December 2017, the Group donated 1,415,058 treasury shares (2016 – 426,468) to the EBT at the prevailing market 
rate. The total value of the treasury share donation was $12.8 million (2016 – $3.5 million).

LICL holds $245.3 million (31 December 2016 – $290.8 million) of cash and cash equivalents, fixed maturity securities and accrued interest  
in trust for the benefit of LUK relating to intra-group reinsurance agreements. In addition, LICL is required to provide 85.0 per cent of the 
required FAL to support the underwriting activities of Syndicate 2010 and 3010 and holds $109.2 million (31 December 2016 – $230.0 million) 
of cash and cash equivalents and fixed maturity securities in FAL in relation to intra-group reinsurance agreements.

The senior management team shareholding in KCML represents a minority interest of 7.3 per cent. This investment represents the non-
controlling interest listed in the Group’s consolidated balance sheet. During the year ended 31 December 2017 dividends of $0.6 million  
(31 December 2016 – $0.5 million) were paid to minority interest holders.

As at 31 December 2017 and 2016, Mr Alex Maloney, a director of LHL, had a 1.2 per cent interest in KCML. During the year ended 
31 December 2017 Mr Maloney received a dividend of $0.1 million (31 December 2016 – $0.1 million) in relation to his interest in KCML.

Mr Maloney and his spouse acquired 100.0 per cent of the shares in Nameco on 7 November 2016. Nameco provides capacity to a number of 
Lloyd’s syndicates including Syndicate 2010 which is managed by CUL. Nameco has provided $0.2 million of capacity to Syndicate 2010 for the 
2018 year of account (2017 year of account – $0.2 million). Mr Maloney receives a proportionate share of the underwriting results of Syndicate 
2010 to which he is contractually entitled through his participation.

Key management compensation
Remuneration for key management, the Group’s Executive and Non-Executive Directors, was as follows:

For the year ended 31 December
Short-term compensation
Equity based compensation
Directors’ fees and expenses
Total

2017  
$m
2.9 
0.2 
2.1 
5.2 

2016  
$m
3.2 
3.3 
2.2 
8.7 

Non-Executive Directors do not receive any benefits in addition to their agreed fees and expenses and do not participate in any of the Group’s 
incentive, performance or pension plans.

150

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Transactions with associate
In 2013, KCML entered into an underwriting services agreement with KRL and KHL to provide various services relating to underwriting, 
actuarial, premium payments and relevant deductions, acquisition expenses and receipt of claims. For the year ended 31 December 2017, the 
Group recognised $11.7 million (2016 – $10.6 million) of service fees and profit commissions in other income in relation to this agreement.

During 2017, the Group committed an additional $57.5 million (31 December 2016 – $25.8 million) of capital to KHL. During 2017, KHL 
returned $38.4 million (31 December 2016 – $28.7 million) of capital to the Group.

Refer to note 15 for further details on the Group’s investment in associate.

Transactions with subsidiary of KHL
During 2017, the Group entered into a reinsurance agreement with KRL. The following balances are included in the Group’s consolidated 
financial statements:

Consolidated balance sheet
Reinsurance recoveries

Consolidated statement of comprehensive (loss) income
Outwards reinsurance premiums
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded

2017  
$m
22.1 

2017  
$m
3.8 
22.1 
0.1 

23. Subsequent events
Dividend
On 14 February 2018 the Board of Directors declared the payment of an ordinary dividend of $0.10 per common share to shareholders of 
record on 23 February 2018, with a settlement date of 21 March 2018. The ordinary dividend payable will be approximately $20.0 million.  
An amount equivalent to the dividend accrues on all RSS options and is paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according to the number of  
RSS options that vest.

www.lancashiregroup.com

151

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statementsShareholder information 

Annual General Meeting 
The Company’s AGM is scheduled for 2 May 2018. Notice of this 
year’s AGM and forms of proxy and direction accompany this Annual 
Report. If you have any queries regarding the notice or return of the 
proxy please contact Chris Head, Company Secretary, at Lancashire 
Holdings Limited, 29th Floor, 20 Fenchurch Street, London EC3M 
3BY, United Kingdom, Tel: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000 and email: 
chris.head@lancashiregroup.com.  

Further information 
Lancashire Holdings Limited is registered in Bermuda under 
company number EC 37415 and has its registered office at  
Power House, 7 Par-la-Ville Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda. 

Further information about the Group including this Annual Report, 
press releases and the Company’s share price is available on our 
website at www.lancashiregroup.com. Please address any enquiries  
to info@lancashiregroup.com. 

Note regarding forward-looking statements 
Some of the statements in this document include forward-looking 
statements which reflect the Directors’ current views with respect  
to financial performance, business strategy, plans and objectives of 
management for future operations (including development plans 
relating to the Group’s products and services). These statements 
include forward-looking statements both with respect to the Group 
and the sectors and industries in which the Group operates. 
Statements containing the words “believes”, “anticipates”, “plans”, 
“projects”, “forecasts”, “guidance”, “intends”, “expects”, “estimates”, 
“predicts”, “may”, “can”, “likely”, “will”, “seeks”, “should” or, in each 
case, their negative or comparable terminology and similar statements 
are of a future or forward-looking nature. All forward-looking 
statements address matters that involve known and unknown risks  
and uncertainties. Accordingly, there are or will be important factors 
that could cause the actual results, performance or achievements  
of the Group to be materially different from future results, 
performance or achievements expressed or implied by such  
forward-looking statements.  

These factors include, but are not limited to: the actual development 
of losses and expenses impacting estimates for hurricanes Harvey, 
Irma and Maria and the earthquakes in Mexico, that occurred in  
the third quarter of 2017 and the wildfires which impacted parts of 
California during 2017, the impact of complex and unique causation 
and coverage issues associated with attribution of losses to wind or 
flood damage or other perils such as fire or business interruption 
relating to such events; potential uncertainties relating to reinsurance 
recoveries, reinstatement premiums and other factors inherent in  
loss estimations, the Group’s ability to integrate its business and 
personnel, the successful retention and motivation of the Group’s  
key management, the increased regulatory burden facing the Group, 
the number and type of insurance and reinsurance contracts that  
the Group writes or the Group may write; the Group’s ability to 
successfully implement its business strategy during ‘soft’ as well as 
‘hard’ markets; the premium rates which may be available at the time 
of such renewals within its targeted business lines; the possible low 
frequency of large events; potentially unusual loss frequency; the 
impact that the Group’s future operating results, capital position  

and rating agency and other considerations may have on the 
execution of any capital management initiatives or dividends; the 
possibility of greater frequency or severity of claims and loss activity 
than the Group’s underwriting, reserving or investment practices  
have anticipated; the reliability of, and changes in assumptions  
to, catastrophe pricing, accumulation and estimated loss models; 
increased competition from existing alternative capital providers and 
insurance-linked funds and collateralised special purpose insurers and 
the related demand and supply dynamics as contracts come up for 
renewal; the effectiveness of its loss limitation methods; the potential 
loss of key personnel; a decline in the Group’s operating subsidiaries’ 
rating with A.M.Best, S&P Global Ratings, Moody’s or other rating 
agencies; increased competition on the basis of pricing, capacity, 
coverage terms or other factors; cyclical downturns of the industry; 
the impact of a deteriorating credit environment for issuers of fixed 
maturity investments; the impact of swings in market interest rates, 
currency exchange rates and securities prices; changes by central 
banks regarding the level of interest rates; the impact of inflation or 
deflation in relevant economies in which the Group operates; the 
effect, timing and other uncertainties surrounding future business 
combinations within the insurance and reinsurance industries; the 
impact of terrorist activity in the countries in which the Group writes 
risks; a rating downgrade of, or a market decline in, securities in its 
investment portfolio; changes in governmental regulations or tax  
laws in jurisdictions where the Group conducts business; Lancashire 
or its Bermudian subsidiaries becoming subject to income taxes in  
the United States or the Bermudian subsidiaries becoming subject  
to income taxes in the United Kingdom; the inapplicability to the 
Group of suitable exclusions from the UK CFC regime; any change  
in UK government policy which impacts the CFC regime or other tax 
changes; and the impact of ‘Brexit’ (following the UK’s notification  
to the European Council under Article 50 of the Treaty on European 
Union on 29 March 2017) and future negotiations regarding the  
UK’s relationship with the European Union on the Group’s  
business, regulatory relationships, underwriting platforms or  
the industry generally.  

Any estimates relating to loss events involve the exercise of 
considerable judgement and reflect a combination of ground-up 
evaluations, information available to date from brokers and insureds, 
market intelligence, initial and/or tentative loss reports and other 
sources. Judgements in relation to loss arising from natural catastrophe 
and man-made events are influenced by complex factors. The Group 
cautions as to the preliminary nature of the information used to 
prepare such estimates as subsequently available information may 
contribute to an increase in these types of losses. 

These forward-looking statements speak only as at the date of  
this document. The Company expressly disclaims any obligation or 
undertaking (save as required to comply with any legal or regulatory 
obligations including the rules of the LSE) to disseminate any updates 
or revisions to any forward-looking statement to reflect any changes  
in the Group’s expectations or circumstances on which any such 
statement is based. All subsequent written and oral forward-looking 
statements attributable to the Group or individuals acting on behalf of 
the Group are expressly qualified in their entirety by this paragraph. 
Prospective investors should specifically consider the factors identified 
in this document which could cause actual results to differ before 
making an investment decision. 

152 
152

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
Glossary 

ABS 
Asset backed securities 

Accident year loss ratio 
The accident year loss ratio is calculated using the accident year 
ultimate liability revalued at the current balance sheet date, 
divided by net premiums earned 

Active Underwriter 
The individual at a Lloyd’s syndicate with principal authority to 
accept insurance and reinsurance risk on behalf of the syndicate 

Additional case reserves (ACR) 
Additional reserves deemed necessary by management 

AFS 
Available for sale 

Aggregate 
Accumulations of insurance loss exposures which result from 
underwriting multiple risks that are exposed to common causes  
of loss 

AGM 
Annual General Meeting 

AIM 
A sub-market of the LSE 

AIR 
AIR Worldwide 

A.M. Best Company (A.M. Best)  
A.M. Best is a full-service credit rating organisation dedicated  
to serving the financial services industries, focusing on the 
insurance sector  

Best Lancashire Assessment of Solvency over Time (BLAST) 
The Group’s economic internal capital model  

BMA 
Bermuda Monetary Authority 

Board of Directors, Board 
Unless otherwise stated refers to the LHL Board of Directors 

Book value per share (BVS) 
Calculated by dividing the value of the total shareholders’ equity by 
the sum of all common voting shares outstanding 

BREEAM 
Building Research Establishment Environmental  
Assessment Method 

BSCR 
Bermuda Solvency Capital Requirement 

BSX 
Bermuda Stock Exchange 

CCSL 
Cathedral Capital Services Limited 

Ceded 
To transfer insurance risk from a direct insurer to a reinsurer 
and/or from a reinsurer to a retrocessionaire 

CEND 
Confiscation, Expropriation, Nationalisation and Deprivation 

CEO 
Chief Executive Officer 

CFC 
Controlled Foreign Company 

CFO 
Chief Financial Officer 

CGU 
Cash generating unit 

CMBS 
Commercial mortgage backed securities 

The Code 
UK Corporate Governance Code published by the UK FRC 

Combined ratio 
Ratio, in per cent, of the sum of net insurance losses, net 
acquisition expenses and other operating expenses to net 
premiums earned 

Consolidated financial statements 
Includes the independent auditors’ report, consolidated primary 
statements, accounting policies, risk disclosures and related notes 

Consolidated primary statements 
Includes the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, 
consolidated balance sheet, consolidated statement of changes in 
shareholders’ equity and the statement of consolidated cash flows 

Coverholder at Lloyd’s 
A coverholder is a company or partnership authorised by a 
managing agent to enter into a contract or contracts of insurance 
to be underwritten by the members of a syndicate managed by it  
in accordance with the terms of a binding authority 

CRO 
Chief Risk Officer 

CSX 
Cayman Islands Stock Exchange 

CUL 
Cathedral Underwriting Limited 

CUO 
Chief Underwriting Officer 

Cathedral; Cathedral Group 
Refers to CCL and all direct and indirect subsidiaries of CCL 

D&F 
Direct and facultative (re)insurance 

CCHL 
Cathedral Capital Holdings Limited 

CCL 
Cathedral Capital Limited 

CCL 1998 
Cathedral Capital (1998) Limited 

CCL 1999 
Cathedral Capital (1999) Limited 

Deferred acquisition costs  
Costs incurred for the acquisition or the renewal of insurance 
policies (e.g. brokerage and premium taxes) which are deferred 
and amortised over the term of the insurance contracts to which 
they relate 

DEFRA 
Department for Environment, Food and Rural Affairs 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

153 
153

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
Glossary continued 

Delegated authorities 
Arrangements under which a Managing Agent or (re)insurer 
delegates its authority to another to enter into contracts of 
insurance on its behalf 

Facultative reinsurance 
A reinsurance risk that is placed by means of a separately 
negotiated contract as opposed to one that is ceded under  
a reinsurance treaty 

Diluted Earnings Per Share 
Calculated by dividing the net profit for the year attributable to 
shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares 
outstanding during the year plus the weighted average number  
of common shares that would be issued on the conversion of  
all potentially dilutive equity based compensation awards into 
common shares under the treasury stock method 

Diluted Operating Earnings Per Share 
Calculated by dividing the net operating (loss) income for the year 
attributable to shareholders by the weighted average number of 
common shares outstanding during the year plus the weighted 
average number of common shares that would be issued on the 
conversion of all potentially dilutive equity based compensation 
awards into common shares under the treasury stock method 

Directors’ fees and expenses 
Unless otherwise stated includes fees and expenses of all Directors 
across the Group 

Dividend yield 
Calculated by dividing the annual dividends per share by the share 
price on the last day of the given year 

Duration 
Duration is the weighted average maturity of a security’s cash flows, 
where the present values of the cash flows serve as the weights. The 
effect of the convexity, or sensitivity, of the portfolio’s response to 
changes in interest rates is also factored in to the calculation 

Earnings per share (EPS)  
Calculated by dividing net profit for the year attributable to 
shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares 
outstanding during the year, excluding treasury shares and shares 
held by the EBT 

EBT 
Lancashire Holdings Employee Benefit Trust 

ECA 
Economic Capital Assessment 

EEA 
European Economic Area 

ERM 
Enterprise Risk Management 

EURIBOR 
The Euro Interbank Offered Rate 

Excess of loss  
Reinsurance or insurance that indemnifies the reinsured  
or insured against all or a specified portion of losses on an 
underlying insurance policy in excess of a specified amount 

Expense ratio 
Ratio, in per cent, of other operating expenses to net  
premiums earned 

EY 
Ernst & Young LLP 

FAL 
Funds at Lloyd’s 

FCA 
Financial Conduct Authority 

FPSO 
Floating production storage and offloading 

FRC 
Financial Reporting Council 

FSMA 
The Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (as amended from 
time to time) 

FTE 
Full-Time Employee 

Fully converted book value per share (FCBVS) 
Calculated by dividing the value of the total shareholders’ equity 
plus the proceeds that would be received from the exercise of  
all dilutive equity compensation awards, by the sum of all shares, 
including equity compensation awards assuming all are exercised 

FVTPL 
Fair value through profit or loss 

G10 
Belgium, Canada, Germany, France, Italy, Japan, the Netherlands, 
Sweden, the United Kingdom, and the United States 

GHG 
Greenhouse Gas 

Gross premiums written 
Amounts payable by the insured, excluding any taxes or duties 
levied on the premium, including any brokerage and commission 
deducted by intermediaries  

The Group or the Lancashire Group 
LHL and its subsidiaries 

ICM 
International Care Ministries 

IFRIC 
International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee 

IFRS 
International Financial Reporting Standard(s) 

ILS 
Insurance Linked Securities 

Incurred but not reported (IBNR)  
These are anticipated or likely losses that may result from insured 
events which have taken place, but for which no losses have yet 
been reported. IBNR also includes a reserve for possible adverse 
development of previously reported losses 

Industry loss warranty (ILW) 
A type of reinsurance or derivative contract through which  
one party will purchase protection based on the total loss arising 
from an event to the entire insurance industry rather than their 
own losses 

154 
154

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
Internal Audit Charter 
Is a formal written document that sets out the mission,  
scope, responsibilities, authority, professional standards and  
the relationship with the external auditors / regulatory bodies of 
the internal audit function (“internal audit”) with the Company 
and its subsidiaries 

International Accounting Standard(s) (IAS) 
Standards, created by the IASB, for the preparation and 
presentation of financial statements 

International Accounting Standards Board (IASB)  
An international panel of accounting experts responsible for 
developing IAS and IFRS 

IRR 
Internal rate of return 

IRRC 
Investment Risk and Return Committee 

ISA 
International Standards on Auditing (UK and Ireland) 

ISE 
Irish Stock Exchange 

KCML 
Kinesis Capital Management Limited 

KCMMSL 
KCM Marketing Services Limited  

KHL  
Kinesis Holdings I Limited 

Kinesis 
The Group’s third-party capital management division 
encompassing KCML, KCMMSL and the management of KHL  
and KRL 

KPMG 
KPMG LLP, a UK limited liability partnership 

KRL (Kinesis Re) 
Kinesis Reinsurance I Limited 

Lancashire companies 
Refers to the Group excluding Cathedral and Kinesis 

Lancashire Foundation or Foundation 
The Lancashire Foundation is a charity registered in England  
and Wales 

LHFT 
Lancashire Holdings Financing Trust I Limited 

LHL (The Company) 
Lancashire Holdings Limited 

LIBOR 
London Interbank Offered Rate 

LICL 
Lancashire Insurance Company Limited 

LIHL 
Lancashire Insurance Holdings (UK) Limited 

LIMSL 
Lancashire Insurance Marketing Services Limited 

LISL 
Lancashire Insurance Services Limited 

Listing Rules  
The listing rules made by the FCA under part VI of FSMA  
(as amended from time to time) 

Lloyd’s 
The Society of Lloyd’s 

LMSCL 
Lancashire Management Services (Canada) Limited 

LOC 
Letter of credit 

Losses 
Demand by an insured for indemnity under an insurance contract 

LSE 
London Stock Exchange 

LUK 
Lancashire Insurance Company (UK) Limited 

M&A 
Mergers and acquisitions 

MBRT 
Multi-beneficiary reinsurance trust 

MBS 
Mortgage backed securities 

Moody’s investors services (Moody’s) 
Moody’s Corporation is the parent company of Moody’s Investors 
Service, which provides credit ratings and research covering debt 
instruments and securities, and Moody’s Analytics, which offers 
software, advisory services and research for credit and economic 
analysis and financial risk management 

MSF 
Médecins Sans Frontières 

Names 
An individual member underwriting with unlimited liability.  
Since 6 March 2003 no person has been admitted as a new  
member to underwrite on an unlimited basis 

Nameco 
Nameco (No. 801) Ltd 

NAV 
Net asset value 

NBS 
New Bridge Street (a trading name of Aon Hewitt Limited) 

Net acquisition cost ratio 
Ratio, in per cent, of net acquisition expenses to net  
premiums earned 

Net loss ratio 
Ratio, in per cent, of net insurance losses to net premiums earned 

Net operating (loss)/ profit 
(Loss)/profit after tax attributable to Lancashire excluding 
realised gains and losses, net of impairments, foreign exchange 
gains and losses and tax. Lancashire believes the reporting of an 
adjusted net operating profit available helps the understanding of 
results by highlighting the underlying profitability of the Group’s 
core insurance and reinsurance business 

www.lancashiregroup.com 
www.lancashiregroup.com

155 
155

OverviewStrategyPerformanceGovernanceFinancial  statements 
Glossary continued 

Net premiums written 
Net premiums written is equal to gross premiums written less 
outwards reinsurance premiums written  

Orange Fund 
A Series of Payden Active Cash Management, LLC 

ORSA 
Own Risk and Solvency Assessment 

OTC 
Over the counter 

PML 
Probable maximum loss. The Group’s exposure to certain peak 
zone elemental losses 

PRA 
Prudential Regulation Authority 

SATEC 
SATEC Underwriting, a privately owned insurance underwriting 
agency operating at national and international level in specialty 
classes of business. SATEC Underwriting is a coverholder at Lloyd’s 

SCR 
Solvency Capital Requirement 

SHARP 
Lancashire’s in house aggregation system 

Syndicate 2010 
Lloyd’s Syndicate 2010, managed by CUL. The Group provides 
capital to support 57.8 per cent of the stamp 

Syndicate 3010 
Lloyd’s Syndicate 3010, managed by CUL. The Group provides 
capital to support 100.0 per cent of the stamp 

Pro-rata/proportional  
Reinsurance or insurance where the reinsurer or insurer shares  
a proportional part of the original premiums and losses of the 
reinsured or insured 

The syndicates 
Syndicate 2010 and 3010 

TOBA 
Terms of business agreements 

RCF 
Revolving credit facility 

RDS 
Realistic Disaster Scenarios 

Retrocession 
The reinsurance of a reinsurance account  

Return on Equity (RoE) 
The IRR of the change in FCBVS in the period plus  
accrued dividends 

Risk Free Rate of Return (RFRoR) 
Being the 13 week U.S. Treasury bill rate, unless otherwise stated 

RMBS 
Residential mortgage backed securities 

RMS 
Risk Management Solutions 

RPI 
Renewal Price Index 

RRC 
Risk and Return Committee 

RSC 
Reinsurance Security Committee 

RSS 
Restricted share scheme 

Total Investment Return 
Total investment return measures investment income and net 
realised and unrealised gains and losses produced by the Group’s 
managed investment portfolio 

Total Shareholder Return (TSR) 
The IRR of the increase/(decrease) in share price in the period, 
measured in U.S. dollars, adjusted for dividends 

Treaty reinsurance 
A reinsurance contract under which the reinsurer agrees to offer 
and to accept all risks of a certain size within a defined class 

UK 
United Kingdom 

UMCC 
Underwriting and Marketing Conference Call 

Unearned premiums  
The portion of premium income that is attributable to periods 
after the balance sheet date that is deferred and amortised to 
future accounting periods 

UNL 
Ultimate net loss 

USCR 
Ultimate solvency capital requirement 

U.S. 
United States of America 

S&P global ratings (S&P) 
S&P Global Ratings is a worldwide insurance rating and 
information agency whose ratings are recognised as an ideal 
benchmark for assessing the financial strength of insurance  
related organisations 

U.S. GAAP 
Accounting principles generally accepted in the United States 

Value at Risk (VaR) 
A measure of the risk of loss of a specific portfolio of  
financial assets 

156 
156

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

 
Contact information 

Head office 
Lancashire Holdings Limited 
29th Floor  
20 Fenchurch Street  
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom 

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000  
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4077 

Registered office  
Lancashire Holdings Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950  
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951 

Bermuda office 
Lancashire Insurance Company Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950  
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951 

UK office 
Lancashire Insurance Company 
(UK) Limited 
29th Floor 
20 Fenchurch Street  
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom 

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000  
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4077 

Cathedral 
Cathedral Capital Limited 
29th Floor 
20 Fenchurch Street 
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom 

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7170 9000  
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7170 9001 

157

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2017

Kinesis 
Kinesis Capital Management Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950  
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951 

Legal counsel to the Company 
As to English and U.S. law: 
Willkie Farr & Gallagher (UK) LLP 
City Point 
1 Ropemaker Street 
London EC2Y 9AW 
United Kingdom 

As to Bermuda law: 
Conyers Dill & Pearman Limited 
Clarendon House 
2 Church Street 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda 

Auditors 
KPMG LLP 
15 Canada Square 
London E14 5GL 
United Kingdom 

Registrar 
Link Market Services (Jersey) Limited 
12 Castle Street 
St Helier  
Jersey JE2 3RT 
Channel Islands 

Depositary 
Link Market Services Trustees Limited 
The Registry 
34 Beckenham Road 
Beckenham 
Kent BR3 4TU 
United Kingdom 

www.lancashiregroup.com